MINI Countryman (2020) - Automotive

Countryman (2020) - Automotive MINI - Free user manual and instructions

Find the device manual for free Countryman (2020) MINI in PDF.

📄 352 pages English EN Download 💬 AI Question
Notice MINI Countryman (2020) - page 10
Pick your language and provide your email: we'll send you a specifically translated version.

User questions about Countryman (2020) MINI

0 question about this device. Answer the ones you know or ask your own.

Ask a new question about this device

The email remains private: it is only used to notify you if someone responds to your question.

No questions yet. Be the first to ask one.

Download the instructions for your Automotive in PDF format for free! Find your manual Countryman (2020) - MINI and take your electronic device back in hand. On this page are published all the documents necessary for the use of your device. Countryman (2020) by MINI.

USER MANUAL Countryman (2020) MINI

text_image LINK: CONTENT & A-Z YBZ 631

OWNER'S MANUAL. MINI COUNTRYMAN.

MINI Countryman (2020) - 1

MINI Countryman (2020) - 2

natural_image Stylized green tree-shaped object placed on a burlap sack against a plain wall (no text or symbols)

WELCOME TO MINI.

OWNER'S MANUAL. MINI COUNTRYMAN.

Thank you for choosing a MINI.

The more familiar you are with your vehicle, the better control you will have on the road. We therefore strongly suggest:

Read this Owner's Manual before starting off in your new MINI. It contains important information on vehicle operation that will help you make full use of the technical features available in your MINI. The manual also contains information designed to enhance operating reliability and road safety, and to contribute to maintaining the value of your MINI.

Any updates made after the editorial deadline can be found in the appendix of the printed Owner's Manual for the vehicle.

Get started now. We wish you driving fun and inspiration with your MINI.

TABLE OF CONTENTS

NOTES

Information....10

QUICK REFERENCE

Entering....20

Set-up and use....24

On the road....27

AT A GLANCE

Cockpit....38

Central Information Display (CID)....42

General settings....47

Owner's Manual media....56

CONTROLS

Opening and closing....60

Seats, mirrors, and steering wheel....81

Transporting children safely....93

Driving....99

Displays....124

Lights....140

Safety....146

Driving stability control systems....166

Driving comfort.... 171

Climate control....191

Interior equipment....200

Storage compartments....208

Cargo area....211

i DRIVING TIPS

Things to remember when driving....222

Saving fuel....227

ENTERTAINMENT

General information.... 236

Tone....238

Radio....240

Audio....248

COMMUNICATION

Telephone....254

MINI Connected....258

MOBILITY

Refueling....264

Fuel....266

Wheels and tires....268

Engine compartment....289

Engine oil....292

Coolant....296

Maintenance....298

Replacing components.... 300

Breakdown assistance.... 310

Care....319

REFERENCE

Technical data.... 326

Appendix....329

License Texts and Certifications....330

Everything from A to Z....338

Reprinting, including excerpts, only with the written consent of BMW AG, Munich.

US English ID5 VI/19, 07 19 490

Printed on environmentally friendly paper, bleached without chlorine, suitable for recycling.

MINI Countryman (2020) - REFERENCE - 1

natural_image Three wooden pencils with colored erasers placed on a wooden surface (no text or symbols visible)

NOTES

Information 10

Information

Using this Owner's Manual

Orientation

The fastest way to find information on a particular topic is by using the index.

An initial overview of the vehicle is provided in the first chapter.

Updates made after the editorial deadline

Due to updates after the editorial deadline, differences may exist between the printed Owner's Manual and the Integrated Owner's Manual in the vehicle.

Notes on updates can be found in the appendix of the printed Owner's Manual for the vehicle.

Additional sources of information

Service center

A service center will be glad to answer questions at any time.

Internet

Vehicle information and general information on MINI, e.g., on technology, are available on the Internet: www.mini.jp.

Vehicle information and general information on MINI, e.g., on technology, are available on the Internet: www.miniusa.com.

MINI Motorer's Guide app

The Owner's Manual is available in many countries as an app for iOS or Android in the respective Store.

MINI Driver's Guide Web

Driver's Guide Web shows the most suitable information for the selected vehicle. If possible, only equipment and functions that are actually installed in the vehicle will be explained. Driver's Guide Web can be displayed in any current browser.

Symbols and displays

Symbols in the Owner's Manual

Sym- Meaning bol

Precautions that must be followed in order to avoid the possibility of injury to yourself and to others as well as serious damage to the vehicle.

Measures that can be taken to help protect the environment.

"..." Control Display texts used to select individual functions.

Action steps

Action steps to be carried out are presented as a numbered list. The steps must be carried out in the defined order.

  1. First action step.

  2. Second action step.

Enumerations

Enumerations without mandatory order or alternative possibilities are presented as a list with bullet points.

- First possibility.

- Second possibility.

Symbols on vehicle components

This symbol on a vehicle component indicates that further information on the component is available in the Owner's Manual.

Vehicle features and options

This Owner's Manual describes all models and all standard, country-specific and optional equipment that is offered in the model series. Therefore, this Owner's Manual also describes and illustrates features and functions that are not available in a vehicle, for example because of the selected optional features or the country-specific version.

This also applies to safety-related functions and systems.

When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

For any options and equipment not described in this Owner's Manual, refer to the Supplementary Owner's Manuals.

Your dealer's service center is happy to answer any questions that you may have about the features and options applicable to your vehicle.

Status of the Owner's Manual

Basic information

The manufacturer of your vehicle pursues a policy of constant development that is conceived to ensure that our vehicles continue to embody the highest quality and safety standards. In rare cases, therefore, the features described in this Owner's Manual may differ from those in your vehicle.

Updates made after the editorial deadline

Due to updates after the editorial deadline, differences may exist between the printed Owner's Manual and the Integrated Owner's Manual in the vehicle.

Notes on updates can be found in the appendix of the printed Owner's Manual for the vehicle.

For Your Own Safety

Manufacturer

The manufacturer of this MINI is Bayerische Motoren Werke Aktionengesellschaft, BMW AG.

Intended use

Heed the following when using the vehicle:

  • Owner's Manual.
  • Information on the vehicle. Do not remove stickers.
  • Technical vehicle data.
  • The traffic, speed, and safety laws where the vehicle is driven.
    – Vehicle documents and statutory documents.

Warranty

Your vehicle is technically configured for the operating conditions and registration requirements applying in the country of first delivery, also known as homologation. If your vehicle is to be operated in a different country it might be necessary to adapt your vehicle to potentially differing operating conditions and registration requirements. If your vehicle does not comply with

the homologation requirements in a certain country you may not be able to lodge warranty claims for your vehicle there. Further information on warranty is available from a service center.

Maintenance and repairs

Advanced technology, for instance the use of modern materials and high-performance electronics, requires suitable maintenance and repair work.

The manufacturer of your vehicle recommends that you entrust corresponding procedures to a MINI dealer's service center. If you choose to use another service facility, the manufacturer of your vehicle recommends use of a facility that performs work, e.g., maintenance and repair, according to MINI specifications with properly trained personnel, referred to in the Owner's Manual as "another qualified service center or repair shop".

If work is performed improperly, for instance maintenance and repair, there is a risk of subsequent damage and related safety risks.

Improperly performed work on the vehicle paint can lead to a failure or malfunction of components, e.g., the radar sensors, and thereby result in a safety risk.

Parts and accessories

The manufacturer of your vehicle recommends the use of parts and accessory products approved by the manufacturer of the MINI.

Approved parts and accessories, and advice on their use and installation are available from a MINI dealer's service center.

MINI parts and accessories were tested by the manufacturer of the MINI for their safety and suitability in MINI vehicles.

The manufacturer of your vehicle warrants genuine MINI parts and accessories.

The manufacturer of your vehicle does not evaluate whether each individual product from another manufacturer can be used with MINI vehicles without presenting a safety hazard, even if a country-specific official approval was issued. The manufacturer of your vehicle does not evaluate whether these products are suitable for MINI vehicles under all usage conditions.

California Proposition 65 Warning

For vehicles sold in California, the law requires vehicle manufacturers to provide the following warning:

Warning

Engine exhaust and a wide variety of Automobile components and parts, including components found in the interior furnishings in a vehicle, contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects and reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. Battery posts, terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds. Batteries also contain other chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer. Wash your hands after handling. Used engine oil contains chemicals that have caused cancer in laboratory animals. Always protect your skin by washing thoroughly with soap and water. For more information go to www.P65Warnings.ca.gov/passenger-vehicle.

Warning

Operating, servicing and maintaining a passenger vehicle or off-highway motor vehicle can expose you to chemicals including engine exhaust, carbon monoxide, phthalates, and lead, which are known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. To minimize exposure, avoid breathing exhaust, do not idle the engine except as necessary, service your vehicle in a well-ventilated area and wear gloves or wash your hands frequently when servicing your vehicle. For more information go to www.P65Warnings.ca.gov/passenger-vehicle.

Service and warranty

We recommend that you read this publication thoroughly. Your vehicle is covered by the following warranties:

  • New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
    – Rust Perforation Limited Warranty.
  • Federal Emissions System Defect Warranty.
  • Federal Emissions Performance Warranty.
  • California Emission Control System Limited Warranty.

Detailed information about these warranties is listed in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models or in the Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models.

Your vehicle has been specifically adapted and designed to meet the particular operating conditions and homologation requirements in your country and continental region in order to deliver the full driving pleasure while the vehicle is operated under those conditions. If you wish to operate your vehicle in another country or region,

you may be required to adapt your vehicle to meet different prevailing operating conditions and homologation requirements. You should also be aware of any applicable warranty limitations or exclusions for such country or region. In such case, please contact Customer Relations for further information.

Maintenance

Maintain the vehicle regularly to sustain the road safety, operational reliability and the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.

Specifications for required maintenance measures:

  • MINI Maintenance system.
    – Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models.
    – Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models.

If the vehicle is not maintained according to these specifications, this could result in damaging the vehicle. Such damage is not covered by the MINI New Vehicle Limited Warranty.

Data memory

General information

Electronic control devices are installed in the vehicle. Electronic control units process data they receive from vehicle sensors, self-generate or exchange with each other. Some control units are necessary for the vehicle to function safely or provide assistance during driving, for instance driver assistance systems. Furthermore, control units facilitate comfort or infotainment functions.

Information about stored or exchanged data can be requested from the manufacturer of the vehicle, in a separate booklet, for example.

Personal reference

Each vehicle is marked with a unique vehicle identification number. Depending on the country, the vehicle owner can be identified with the vehicle identification number, license plate and corresponding authorities. In addition, there are other options to track data collected in the vehicle to the driver or vehicle owner, for instance via utilized services.

Operating data in the vehicle

Control units process data to operate the vehicle.

For example, this includes:

  • Status messages for the vehicle and its individual components, e.g., wheel rotational speed, wheel speed, deceleration, transverse acceleration, engaged safety belt indicator.
  • Ambient conditions, e.g., temperature, rain sensor signals.

The processed data is only processed in the vehicle itself and generally volatile. The data is not stored beyond the operating period.

Electronic components, e.g. control units and ignition keys, contain components for storing technical information. Information about the vehicle condition, component usage, maintenance requirements events or faults can be stored temporarily or permanently.

This information generally records the state of a component, a module, a system, or the environment, for instance:

  • Operating states of system components, for instance, fill levels, tire inflation pressure, battery status.
  • Malfunctions and faults in important system components, for instance lights and brakes.

  • Responses by the vehicle to special situations such as airbag deployment or engagement of the driving stability control systems.

  • Information on vehicle-damaging events.

The data is required to perform the control unit functions. Furthermore, it also serves to recognize and correct malfunctions, and helps the vehicle manufacturer to optimize vehicle functions.

The majority of this data is volatile and is only processed within the vehicle itself. Only a small share of data is stored in event or fault memories based on an event.

When servicing, for instance during repairs, service processes, warranty cases, and quality assurance measures, this technical information can be read out from the vehicle together with the vehicle identification number.

A dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop can read out the information. The socket for OBD On-board Diagnosis required by law in the vehicle is used to read out the data.

The data is collected, processed, and used by the relevant organizations in the service network. The data documents technical conditions of the vehicle, helps with the identification of the fault, compliance with warranty obligations and quality improvement.

Furthermore, the manufacturer has product monitoring duties to meet in line with product liability law. To fulfill these duties, the vehicle manufacturer needs technical data from the vehicle. The data from the vehicle can also be used to check customer claims for warranty and guaranty.

Fault and event memories in the vehicle can be reset when a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop performs repair or servicing work.

Data entry and data transfer into the vehicle

General information

Depending on the vehicle equipment, comfort and individual settings can be stored in the vehicle and modified or reset at any time.

For example, this includes:

  • Settings for the seat and steering wheel positions.
    – Suspension and climate control settings.

If necessary, data can be transferred to the entertainment and communication system of the vehicle, for instance via smartphone.

This includes the following depending on the respective equipment:

  • Multimedia data such as music, films or photos for playback in an integrated multimedia system.
  • Address book data for use in conjunction with an integrated hands-free system or an integrated navigation system.
  • Entered navigation destinations.
  • Data on the use of Internet services.

This data can be stored locally in the vehicle or is found on a device that has been connected to the vehicle, e.g., a smartphone, USB stick or MP3 player. If this data is stored in the vehicle, it can be deleted at any time.

This data is only transmitted to third parties upon personal request as part of the use of online services. The transmission depends on the selected settings for the use of the services.

Incorporation of mobile devices

Depending on the vehicle equipment, mobile devices connected to the vehicle, for instance smartphones, can be controlled via the vehicle control elements. The sound and picture from the mobile device can be played back and displayed through the multimedia system. Certain information is transferred to the mobile device at the same time. Depending on the type of incorporation, this includes, for instance position data and other general vehicle information. This optimizes the way in which selected apps, for instance navigation or music playback, work.

There is no further interaction between the mobile device and the vehicle, such as active access to vehicle data.

How the data will be processed further is determined by the provider of the particular app being used. The extent of the possible settings depends on the respective app and the operating system of the mobile device.

Services

General information

If the vehicle has a wireless network connection, this enables data to be exchanged between the vehicle and other systems. The wireless network connection is realized via an in-vehicle transmitter and receiver unit or via personal mobile devices brought into the vehicle, for instance smartphones. This wireless network connection enables 'online functions' to be used. These include online services and apps supplied by the vehicle manufacturer or by other providers.

Services from the vehicle manufacturer

Where online services from the vehicle manufacturer are concerned, the corresponding functions are described in the appropriate place, for instance the Owner's Manual or manufacturer's website. The relevant legal information pertaining to data protection is provided there too. Personal data may be used to perform online services. Data is exchanged over a secure con-

nection, for instance with the IT systems of the vehicle manufacturer intended for this purpose.

Any collection, processing, and use of personal data above and beyond that needed to provide the services must always be based on a legal permission, contractual arrangement or consent. It is also possible to activate or deactivate the data connection as a whole. That is, with the exception of functions and services required by law such as Assist systems.

Services from other providers

When using online services from other providers, these services are the responsibility of the relevant provider and subject to their data privacy conditions and terms of use. The vehicle manufacturer has no influence on the content exchanged during this process. Information on the way in which personal data is collected and used in relation to services from third parties, the scope of such data, and its purpose, can be obtained from the relevant service provider.

Event Data Recorder EDR

This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder EDR. The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle's systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time, typically 30 seconds or less.

The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record such data as:

- How various systems in your vehicle were operating.

  • Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were fastened.
  • How far, if at all, the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal.
  • How fast the vehicle was traveling.

This data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.

EDR data is recorded by your vehicle only if a nontrivial crash situation occurs; no data is recorded by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no personal data, for instance name, gender, age, and crash location, are recorded.

However, other parties, such as law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash investigation.

To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access to the vehicle or the EDR.

Vehicle identification number

Engine compartment
MINI Countryman (2020) - Vehicle identification number - 1

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical component with no visible text or symbols

The vehicle identification number can be found in the engine compartment, on the right-hand side of the vehicle.

Windshield

MINI Countryman (2020) - Windshield - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's front wheel and side panel, showing no visible text or symbols

The vehicle identification number can also be found behind the windshield.

Reporting safety defects

For US customers

The following only applies to vehicles owned and operated in the US.

If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration NHTSA, in addition to notifying MINI of North America, LLC, P.O. Box 1227, Westwood, New Jersey 07675-1227, Telephone 1-800-831-1117.

If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign.

However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or MINI of North America, LLC.

To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain

other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov

For Canadian customers

Canadian customers who wish to report a safety-related defect to Transport Canada, Defect Investigations and Recalls, may call the toll-free hotline 1-800-333-0510. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety.

MINI Countryman (2020) - For Canadian customers - 1

natural_image Two painted oysters with striped and red stripes mounted on a dark wooden wall next to a green chair (no text or symbols visible)

MINI Countryman (2020) - For Canadian customers - 2

QUICK REFERENCE

Entering 20

Set-up and use 24

On the road 27

Entering

Opening and closing

Buttons on the vehicle key

MINI Countryman (2020) - Buttons on the vehicle key - 1

text_image 1 2 3 4

1 Unlocking
2 Locking
3 Unlocking the tailgate
With automatic tailgate operation: open the tailgate
4 Panic mode

Unlocking the vehicle

MINI Countryman (2020) - Unlocking the vehicle - 1

Press the button on the vehicle key.

Depending on the settings, either only the driver's door or all vehicle access points are unlocked.

If only the driver's door is unlocked, press the button on the vehicle key again to unlock the other vehicle access points.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Unlocking the vehicle - 2

Press and hold the button on the vehicle key after unlocking.

The windows and the glass sunroof are opened, as long as the button on the vehicle key is pressed.

Locking the vehicle

MINI Countryman (2020) - Locking the vehicle - 1

Press the button on the vehicle key.

All vehicle access points are locked.

Buttons for the central locking system

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's dashboard knob showing the number 6 and angle 60 (no text or symbols beyond basic design)

Buttons for the central locking system.

Locking

MINI Countryman (2020) - Locking - 1

Pressing the button locks the vehicle if the front doors are closed.

Unlocking

MINI Countryman (2020) - Unlocking - 1

Pressing the button unlocks the vehicle.

Panic mode

You can trigger the alarm system if you find yourself in a dangerous situation.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Panic mode - 1

Press the button on the vehicle key and hold for at least 3 seconds.

To switch off the alarm: press any button.

Comfort Access

Concept

The vehicle can be accessed without operating the vehicle key.

Carrying the vehicle key with you, e.g., in your pants pocket, is sufficient.

The vehicle automatically detects the vehicle key when it is in close proximity or in the car's interior.

Unlocking the vehicle
MINI Countryman (2020) - Concept - 1

natural_image Simple diagram of a hand holding a car with an arrow pointing to the handle (no text or symbols)

On the driver's or front passenger's door handle, press the button.

Locking the vehicle
MINI Countryman (2020) - Concept - 2

natural_image Simple diagram of a hand holding a circular object with an arrow pointing to it (no text or symbols)

On the driver's or front passenger's door handle, press the button.

Opening and closing the tailgate with no-touch activation

Concept

The tailgate can be opened and closed with no-touch activation using the vehicle key you are carrying.

Performing the foot movement

  1. Stand in the middle behind the vehicle at approx. one arm's length away from the rear of the vehicle.
  2. Wave a foot under the vehicle in the direction of travel and immediately pull it back.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Performing the foot movement - 1

natural_image Close-up of a person's lower body and arm with a sensor icon overlay (no text or symbols)

Tailgate

Without automatic tailgate: unlocking
MINI Countryman (2020) - Tailgate - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car rear bumper with a white arrow pointing upward (no text or symbols)
  • Unlock the vehicle and then press the button on the outside of the tailgate.
  • Press and hold the button on the vehicle key for approx. 1 second.

Depending on the setting, the doors may also be unlocked.

With automatic tailgate: Opening

MINI Countryman (2020) - With automatic tailgate: Opening - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's rear bumper with a white arrow pointing upward (no text or symbols)
  • Unlock the vehicle and press the button on the tailgate.
  • Press and hold the button on the vehicle key for approx. 1 second.

Depending on the setting, the doors may also be unlocked.

Without automatic tailgate: Closing

Closing the tailgate manually.

With automatic tailgate: Closing

MINI Countryman (2020) - With automatic tailgate: Closing - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's front panel with an arrow pointing to the car icon (no text or symbols)

Press the button on the inside of the tailgate.

Displays and control elements

In the vicinity of the steering wheel

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 1

text_image 3 2 1 4

1 Low beams, fog lights
2 High beams, headlight flasher, turn signal
3 Instrument cluster
4 Wiper system

Indicator/warning lights

Instrument cluster

The indicator/warning lights can light up in a variety of combinations and colors.

Several of the lights are checked for proper functioning and light up temporarily when the engine is started or the ignition is switched on.

Driver's door

MINI Countryman (2020) - Driver's door - 1

text_image 1 2 3

1 Safety switch
2 Power windows
3 Exterior mirrors

All around the selector lever

MINI Countryman (2020) - All around the selector lever - 1

text_image 1 2 3

1 Selector lever
2 Controller with buttons
3 Parking brake

Central Information Display (CID)

Concept

The Central Information Display (CID) combines the functions of a multitude of switches. These functions can be operated via the Controller.

Controller

General information

The buttons can be used to open the menus directly. The Controller can be used to select menu items and enter the settings.

Buttons on the Controller

Button Function

MENUPress once: calls up the main menu. Press twice: open recently used menus.
BACKOpens the previous display.
OPTIONOpens the Options menu.
AUDIOOpen the Audio menu.
TELOpens the Phone menu.

Set-up and use

Seats, mirrors, and steering wheel

Manually adjustable seats
MINI Countryman (2020) - Seats, mirrors, and steering wheel - 1

text_image 1 2 3 4

1 Forward/backward
2 Thigh support
3 Height
4 Backrest tilt

Electrically adjustable seats
MINI Countryman (2020) - Seats, mirrors, and steering wheel - 2

text_image 1 4 3 2

1 Memory function
2 Lumbar support
3 Backrest tilt
4 Forward/backward, height, seat tilt

Adjusting the head restraint

Height
MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting the head restraint - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a white plastic object with directional arrows indicating flow or movement (no text or symbols)
  • To raise: push the head restraint up.
  • To lower: press the button, arrow 1, and push the head restraint down.

Adjusting the exterior mirrors
MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting the head restraint - 2

text_image 1 2 3

1 Adjusting
2 Selecting a mirror, Automatic Curb Monitor
3 Folding in and out

Adjusting the steering wheel

In four directions

MINI Countryman (2020) - In four directions - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car dashboard with a white arrow pointing to the left side of the keyhole (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Fold the lever down.
  2. Move the steering wheel to the preferred height and angle to suit your seating position.
  3. Fold the lever back up.

Memory function

Concept

The following settings can be stored and, if necessary, retrieved using the memory function:

  • Seat position.
  • Exterior mirror position.

Storing

  1. Switch on the ignition.
  2. Set the desired position.
  3. SET the button. The LED in the button lights up.
  4. Press the desired button 1 or 2 on the seat while the LED is illuminated. The LED goes out.

Calling up settings

The stored position is called up automatically.

Press the desired button 1 or 2.

The procedure stops when a seat adjustment switch or one of the memory buttons is pressed.

Once underway, adjustment of the seat position on the driver's side is disabled after a short while.

Infotainment

Radio

Control elements

MINI Countryman (2020) - Control elements - 1

text_image 1 2 3 4 BAND MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 5

1 Changing the waveband
2 Changing the entertainment source
3 Sound output on/off, volume
4 Changing the station/track
5 Programmable memory buttons

Pairing the mobile phone

After the mobile phone is paired once with the vehicle, the mobile phone can be operated using the Central Information Display (CID), the steering wheel buttons and spoken instructions.

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Mobile devices"
  4. "Connect new device"
    The vehicle's Bluetooth name is displayed on the Control Display.

  5. To perform additional steps on the mobile phone, refer to the mobile phone owner's manual: e.g., search for or connect the Bluetooth device or a new device.

The Bluetooth name of the vehicle appears on the mobile phone display. Select the Bluetooth name of the vehicle.

  1. Depending on the mobile device, a control number is displayed or the control number must be entered.

- Compare the control number displayed on the Control Display with the control number on the display of the device.

Confirm the control number on the device and on the Control Display.

- Enter and confirm the same control number on the device and via the Central Information Display (CID).

The device is connected and displayed in the device list.

The mobile phone is connected and will appear at the top of the list of mobile phones.

Using the phone

Accepting a call

Incoming call can be accepted via the Central Information Display (CID) or the button on the steering wheel.

Via the Central Information Display (CID)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Via the Central Information Display (CID) - 1

"Accept"

Via the button on the steering wheel

MINI Countryman (2020) - Via the button on the steering wheel - 1

Press the button.

Dialing a number

  1. "Communication"
  2. "Dial number"

  3. Select the numbers individually.

  4. Select the symbol.

On the road

Driving

Starting and stopping the engine

Ignition on/off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Ignition on/off - 1

- On: press the Start/Stop button.

Most of the indicator/ warning lights light up for a varied length of time.

  • Off: press the Start/Stop button again. All indicator lights go out.
  • Radio-ready state: when the ignition is switched off, press the ON/OFF button on the radio or when the engine is running, press the Start/Stop button. Some electronic systems/power consumers remain ready for operation.

Start/stop engine

Steptronic transmission: starting

  1. Depress the brake pedal.
  2. Engage selector lever position P or N.
  3. Press the Start/Stop button.

Manual transmission: starting

  1. Depress the brake pedal.
  2. Press on the clutch pedal and shift to neutral.
  3. Press the Start/Stop button.

Steptronic transmission: switching off

  1. When the vehicle is stationary, apply the parking brake.
  2. Engage selector lever position P.

  3. Press the Start/Stop button.

Manual transmission: switching off

  1. With the vehicle at a standstill, press the Start/Stop button.
  2. Shift into first gear or reverse.
  3. Set the parking brake.

Auto Start/Stop function

Steptronic transmission: switches the engine off automatically while stationary to save fuel. The engine starts automatically when the brake pedal is released.

Manual transmission: switches the engine off automatically while stationary to save fuel. As soon as the clutch pedal is depressed, the engine starts automatically.

Parking brake

Setting

MINI Countryman (2020) - Setting - 1

Pull the switch.

The LED and indicator light light up.

Releasing

MINI Countryman (2020) - Releasing - 1

Manual transmission: press the switch while the brake pedal is pressed.

Steptronic transmission: press the switch while the brake is pressed or selector lever position P is set.

The LED and indicator light go out.

The parking brake is released.

Manual transmission

Shifting

When shifting into 5th or 6th gear, push the gearshift lever to the right in order to

prevent inadvertent shifting into the 3rd or 4th gear.

Reverse gear

Select only when the vehicle is stationary.

To overcome the resistance push the gear-shift lever dynamically to the left and engage reverse gear with a forward shifting movement.

Steptronic transmission

Selector lever positions

Parking position P.

R is reverse.

Neutral N.

Drive mode D.

Engage selector lever position P or R only when the vehicle is stationary.

To prevent the vehicle from creeping after you select a drive mode or reverse, maintain pressure on the brake pedal until you are ready to start.

Selector lever lock

A lock prevents an inadvertent change from selector lever position P to another selector lever position and, depending on the transmission version, inadvertent switching to selector lever position P or R.

To release the lock: with the brake pedal depressed, press the button on the front or side of the selector lever.

Steptronic transmission, Sport and manual mode

MINI Countryman (2020) - Steptronic transmission, Sport and manual mode - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car gear shift lever mechanism with a white arrow indicating the direction (no text or symbols visible)

Sport program:

Press the selector lever to the left from selector lever position D.

Manual mode:

- To shift down: press the selector lever forward.

- To shift up: pull the selector lever rearwards.

High beams, headlight flasher, turn signal, roadside parking light

High beams, headlight flasher

MINI Countryman (2020) - High beams, headlight flasher - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with directional arrows indicating left and right control buttons (no text or symbols)

Push the lever forward or pull it backward.

- High beams on, arrow 1.

The high beams light up when the low beams are switched on.

- High beams off/headlight flasher, arrow 2.

Turn signal

MINI Countryman (2020) - Turn signal - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a car's seatbelt and dashboard with directional arrows indicating movement (no text or symbols)
  • On: press the lever past the resistance point.
  • Off: lightly tap the lever to the resistance point.
  • Off: press the lever past the resistance point in the opposite direction.
  • Triple turn signal activation: lightly tap the lever up or down.
  • Brief signaling: press the lever to the resistance point and hold it there for as long as you want the turn signal to flash.

Canada: roadside parking light

MINI Countryman (2020) - Canada: roadside parking light - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a vehicle's left-hand side with bidirectional arrow indicating speed or direction (no text or symbols)

To illuminate the vehicle on one side.

  • On: with the ignition switched off, press the lever either up or down past the resistance point for approx. 2 seconds.
  • Off: briefly press the lever to the resistance point in the opposite direction.

Lights and lighting

Light functions

Symbol Function

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Function - 1

Front fog lights.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Function - 2

Automatic headlight control.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Function - 3

Lights off.

Daytime running lights.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Function - 4

Parking lights.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Function - 5

Low beams.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Function - 6

Instrument lighting.

Wiper system

Switching the wipers on/off and brief wipe

Switching on

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 1

text_image Car interior control panel with numbered directional arrows indicating vehicle movement or flow direction

Press the lever up until the desired position is reached.

- Resting position of the wipers: position 0.

  • Rain sensor: position 1.
  • Normal wiper speed: position 2.
  • Fast wiper speed: position 3.

Brief wipe and switching off
MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 2

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with a rotary switch and directional arrow (no text or symbols visible)

Press the lever down.

  • Switching off: press the lever down until it reaches its standard position.
  • Brief wipe: press the lever down from the standard position.

Rain sensor

Activating/deactivating
MINI Countryman (2020) - Rain sensor - 1

text_image Car interior control panel with numbered directional arrows indicating vehicle positions or movement

To activate: press the lever up once from its standard position, arrow 1.

To deactivate: press the lever back into the standard position.

Set interval or sensitivity of the rain sensor
MINI Countryman (2020) - Rain sensor - 2

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with directional arrows indicating traffic flow (no text or symbols visible)

Turn the thumbwheel on the wiper lever.

Cleaning the windshield
MINI Countryman (2020) - Rain sensor - 3

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and control panel (no visible text or symbols)

Pull the lever.

Canada: wiper system

Switching the wipers on/off and brief wipe

Switching on
MINI Countryman (2020) - Canada: wiper system - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and directional arrow indicator (no text or symbols)

Tap up the lever or press it past the resistance point.

  • Normal wiper speed: tap up once.
  • Fast wiper speed: tap up twice or tap once beyond the resistance point.

Brief wipe and switching off
MINI Countryman (2020) - Canada: wiper system - 2

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with a USB port and directional arrow (no text or symbols visible)

Press the lever down.

  • To switch off fast wipe: press down twice.
  • To switch off normal wipe: press down once.
  • Brief wipe: press down once.

Rain sensor

Activating/deactivating
MINI Countryman (2020) - Rain sensor - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with a white connector and directional arrow (no text or symbols visible)

Press the button on the wiper lever.

Set interval or sensitivity of the rain sensor
MINI Countryman (2020) - Rain sensor - 2

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and air vent (no visible text or symbols)

Turn the thumbwheel on the wiper lever.

Cleaning the windshield
MINI Countryman (2020) - Rain sensor - 3

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and directional arrow indicator (no text or symbols)

Pull the lever.

Climate control

Air conditioner

Button Function
MINI Countryman (2020) - Air conditioner - 1
Temperature.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Air conditioner - 2
Air conditioning.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Air conditioner - 3
Recirculated-air mode.

Button Function
MINI Countryman (2020) - Air conditioner - 4

Controls the air flow, manual.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Air conditioner - 5

Controls the air distribution manually.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Air conditioner - 6

Windshield defroster.

Automatic climate control

Button Function
MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 1

Temperature.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 2

Air conditioning.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 3

Maximum cooling.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 4

AUTO program.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 5

Recirculated-air mode.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 6

Automatic recirculated-air control AUC/recirculated-air mode.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 7

Controls the air flow, manual.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 8

Air distribution, manual.

Button Function
MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 9

Defrosts and defogs the windows.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 10

Windshield defroster.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 11

Rear window defroster.

Refueling

Refueling

Fuel cap

  1. To open the fuel filler flap, press on the rear edge, arrow. The fuel filler flap opens.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Fuel cap - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's side panel with a white arrow pointing left (no text or symbols)
  1. Turn the fuel cap counterclockwise.

  2. Place the fuel cap in the bracket attached to the fuel filler flap.

Gasoline

For the best fuel efficiency, the gasoline should be sulfur-free or very low in sulfur content.

Refuel only with unleaded gasoline without metallic additives.

Information on the recommended fuel grade can be found in the Owner's Manual.

Wheels and tires

Tire inflation pressure specifications

MINI Countryman (2020) - Wheels and tires - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's side panel showing the front wheel and side door (no visible text or symbols)

The tire inflation pressure values can be found on the sign on the door pillar.

Checking the tire inflation pressure

Regularly check the tire inflation pressure and correct it as needed:

- At least twice a month.

- Before embarking on an extended trip.

After correcting the tire inflation pressure

Reinitialize the Flat Tire Monitor. Reset the Tire Pressure Monitor.

Electronic oil measurement

Requirements

A current measured value is available after approx. 30 minutes of driving. During a shorter trip, the status of the last, sufficiently long trip is displayed.

Displaying the engine oil level

On the radio:

  1. MENU the button.

  2. "Vehicle Info"

  3. "Vehicle status"

  4. "Engine oil level"

The engine oil level is displayed.

Adding engine oil

General information

Switch off the ignition and safely park the vehicle before engine oil is added.

Adding

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adding - 1

natural_image Simple diagram showing a circular object with a diagonal line and an arrow pointing upward, no text or symbols present.

Only add engine oil when the message is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Observe the quantity to be added in the message.

Take care not to add too much engine oil. Observe recommended engine oil types.

Providing assistance

Hazard warning flashers

MINI Countryman (2020) - Hazard warning flashers - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and dashboard (no visible text or symbols)

The button is located above the Control Display.

Breakdown assistance

MINI Roadside Assistance

This service can be reached around the clock in many countries.

  1. "MINI Connected"
  2. "MINI Assist"
  3. "MINI Roadside Assistance"

The contact to the MINI Roadside Assistance is established.

A telephone number is displayed, if needed. Select to dial the telephone number on a connected mobile phone.

MINI Countryman (2020) - MINI Roadside Assistance - 1

natural_image Interior of a rustic metal shelving unit with various kitchenware and storage items (no visible text or labels)

MINI Countryman (2020) - MINI Roadside Assistance - 2

AT A GLANCE

Cockpit 38

Central Information Display (CID) 42

General settings 47

Owner's Manual media 56

Cockpit

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for

instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

In the vicinity of the steering wheel

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 1

text_image 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13

1 Power windows 77

2 Exterior mirror operation 90

3 Buttons of the central locking system 65

4 Lights

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 2

Front fog lights 143

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 3

Light switch 140

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 4

Lights off

Daytime running lights 142

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 5

Parking lights 140

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 6

Low beams 140

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 7

Automatic headlight control 141

Cornering light 142

High-beam Assistant 142

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 8

Instrument lighting 144

5 Steering wheel buttons, left

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 9

Camera-based cruise control on/off 171

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 10

Cruise control on/off 178

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 11

Cruise control: to store the speed

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 12

Pausing, continuing cruise control

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 13

Cruise control: increase speed

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 14

Cruise control: reduce speed

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 15

Camera-based cruise control: reduce distance

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 16

Camera-based cruise control: increase distance

6 Steering column stalk, left

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 17

Turn signal 106

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 18

High beams, head-light flasher 106

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 19

High-beam Assistant 142

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 20

Canada: roadside parking light 141

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 21

Onboard Computer 134

7 Instrument cluster 124

8 Steering column stalk, right

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 22

Wipers 107

Wiper on Canadian models 111

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 23

Rain sensor 108

Rain sensor on Canadian models 112

Cleaning windows 109

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 24

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 25

Rear window wiper in Canadian models 109

Rear window wiper 109

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 26

Clean the rear window 109

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 27

9 Steering wheel buttons, right

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 28

Telephone 254

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 29

Confirm the selection 134

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 30

Selection back 134

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 31

Selection next 134

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 32

Increase volume

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 33

Reduce volume

10 Horn, entire surface

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the steering wheel - 34

12 Unlocking the hood 290

13 Operate the tailgate 69

11 Adjusting the steering wheel 92

In the vicinity of the center console

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the center console - 1

text_image Interior view of a car dashboard with numbered parts for identification and function

1 Hazard warning system 310

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the center console - 2

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the center console - 3

Intelligent Safety 157

2 Control Display 42
3 Radio/Multimedia
4 Glove compartment 208
5 Climate control 191

6 PDC Park Distance Con-

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the center console - 4

trol 180

Rearview camera 183

Parking assistant 186

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the center console - 5

Auto Start/Stop func-

tion 102

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the center console - 6

Start/stop the engine and

switch the ignition on/

off 99

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the center console - 7

DSC Dynamic Stability Control

166

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the center console - 8

MINI Driving Modes

switch 168

7 Steptronic transmission selector lever 116

Manual transmission selector lever 115

8 Controller with buttons 44

9 Parking brake 105

In the vicinity of the roofliner

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the vicinity of the roofliner - 1

text_image 1 SOS 2 PASS AIRBAG OFF 3 6 5 4 3

1 Emergency Request, SOS 311

4 Ambient light 144

2 Indicator light, front-seat passenger airbag 149

5 Panoramic glass sunroof 79

3 Reading lights 144

6 Interior lights 144

Central Information Display (CID)

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Concept

The Central Information Display (CID) combines the functions of a multitude of switches. These functions can be operated via the Controller.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Operating the integrated information systems and communication devices while driving can distract from traffic. It is possible to lose control of the vehicle. There is a risk of accident. Only use the systems or devices when the traffic situation allows. As warranted, stop and use the systems and devices while the vehicle is stationary.

Input and display

Letters and numbers

Depending on the menu, you can switch between entering upper and lower case letters, numbers and characters:

Symbol Function

abc or ABCChange between capital and lower-case letters.
Insert blank space.
Use voice activation.
OK Confirm entry.

Without navigation system

MINI Countryman (2020) - Without navigation system - 1

MINI Countryman (2020) - Without navigation system - 2

MINI Countryman (2020) - Without navigation system - 3

lect the symbol.

Entry comparison

When entering names and addresses, the choice is narrowed down with every letter entered and letters may be added automatically.

Entries are continuously compared with data stored in the vehicle.

Only those letters are offered during entry for which data is available.

Activating/deactivating the functions

Several menu items are preceded by a checkbox. The checkbox indicates whether the function is activated or deactivated. Selecting the menu item activates or deactivates the function.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating/deactivating the functions - 1

Function is activated.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating/deactivating the functions - 2

Function is deactivated.

Status information

General information

The status field can be found in the upper area of the Control Display. Status information is displayed in the form of symbols.

Radio

Symbol Meaning

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 1

HD Radio station is being received.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 2

Satellite radio is switched on.

Telephone

Symbol Meaning

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 1

Incoming or outgoing call.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 2

Missed call.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 3

Signal strength of cellular network.

Symbol flashes: network search.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 4

Cellular network is not available.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 5

Roaming is active.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 6

SMS text message received.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 7

Message received.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 8

Reminder.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 9

Sending not possible.

Entertainment

Symbol Meaning

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 1

Bluetooth audio.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 2

USB audio interface.

Other symbols

Symbol Meaning

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 1

Check Control message.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 2

The sound output has been switched off.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 3

Checking the current vehicle position.

Control elements

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)

1 Control Display

2 Controller with buttons

Control Display

General information

To clean the Control Display, follow the care instructions, refer to page 322.

In the case of very high temperatures on the Control Display, for instance due to intense solar radiation, the brightness may be reduced down to complete deactivation.

Once the temperature is reduced, for instance through shade or air conditioning, the normal functions are restored.

Safety information

NOTICE

Objects in the area in the front of the Control Display can shift and damage the Control Display. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not place objects in the area in front of the Control Display.

Switching on/off automatically

The Control Display is switched on automatically after unlocking.

In certain situations, the Control Display is switched off automatically, for instance if no operation is performed on the vehicle for several minutes.

Switching on/off manually

The Control Display can also be switched off manually.

  1. Press the button.

  2. "Turn off control display"

Press the Controller or any button on the Controller to switch it back on again.

Controller

General information

The buttons can be used to open the menus directly. The Controller can be used to select menu items and enter the settings.

Operation

- Turn to switch between menu items, for example.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Operation - 1

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical knob with circular arrows indicating rotation or cycle (no text or symbols)

- Press to select a menu item, for example.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Operation - 2

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical control knob with a white arrow pointing downward (no text or symbols visible)

- Tilt in two directions to switch between displays, for example.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Operation - 3

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical control knob with directional arrows indicating rotation or movement (no text or symbols)

Buttons on the Controller

Button Function

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button Function - 1

Press once: calls up the main menu.

Press twice: open recently used menus.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button Function - 2

Opens the previous display.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button Function - 3

Opens the Options menu.

Button Function

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button Function - 1

Open the Audio menu.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button Function - 2

Opens the Phone menu.

Operating via the Controller

Opening the main menu

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening the main menu - 1

Press the button.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening the main menu - 2

natural_image Circular diagram with icons representing transportation modes (car, globe, phone, music) and a central car silhouette, no readable text or symbols.

The main menu is displayed.

All Central Information Display (CID) functions can be called up via the main menu.

Selecting menu items

Highlighted menu items can be selected.

  1. Turn the Controller until the desired menu item is highlighted.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Selecting menu items - 1

natural_image Circular diagram with icons representing transportation modes (car, globe, phone, music) and data sources (map, email, chat) around a central car silhouette (no text or symbols)
  1. Press the Controller.

Changing between displays

After a menu item is selected, for instance "System settings", a new display appears.

- Move the Controller to the left.

The current display closes and the previous display is shown.

- Press the button. The previous display re-opens.

- Move the Controller to the right. The new display opens.

An arrow indicates that additional displays can be opened.

Opening recently used menus

The recently used menus can be displayed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening recently used menus - 1

Press the button twice.

Opening the Options menu

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening the Options menu - 1

Press the button.

The "Options" menu is displayed.

The menu consists of various areas:

- Control options for the selected main menu, for instance for "Media/Radio". - If applicable, further operating options for the selected menu, for instance "Save station".

Changing settings

Settings, such as brightness, can be entered. Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Displays"
  4. "Control display"
  5. "Brightness at night"

  6. Turn the Controller until the desired setting is displayed.

  7. Press the Controller.

Entering letters and numbers

Input

  1. Turn the Controller: select letters or numbers.
  2. OK confirm entry.

Deleting

Symbol Function

←Press the Controller: delete letters or number.
←orABCHold the Controller down: delete all letters or numbers.

Using alphabetical lists

For alphabetical lists with more than 30 entries, the letters for which there is an entry are displayed at the left edge.

  1. Turn the Controller to the left or right quickly.
    All letters for which there are entries are displayed on the left edge.
  2. Select the first letter of the desired entry.
    The first entry of the selected letter is displayed.

Programmable memory buttons

General information

The Central Information Display (CID) functions can be stored on the programmable memory buttons and called up directly, for

instance radio stations, phone numbers, and menu entries.

Settings are stored for the driver profile currently used.

Storing a function

  1. Select the function via the Central Information Display (CID).
  2. Press and hold the desired button, until a signal sounds.

Executing a function

1...6 Press the button. The function will work immediately.

This means, for instance that the number is dialed when a phone number is selected.

Displaying the key assignment

Touch buttons with finger. Do not wear gloves or use objects.

The button assignment is displayed at the top edge of screen.

Deleting the button assignments

  1. Press buttons 1 and 6 simultaneously for approx. 5 seconds.

  2. "OK"

General settings

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Language

Setting the language

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. If necessary, "Language"
  4. "Language:"
  5. Select the desired setting.

The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Time

Setting the time

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Date and time"
  4. "Time:"

  5. Turn the Controller until the desired hours are displayed.

  6. Press the Controller.
  7. Turn the Controller until the desired minutes are displayed.
  8. Press the Controller.

Setting the time format

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Date and time"
  4. "Time format:"
  5. Select the desired setting.

The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Date

Setting the date

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Date and time"
  4. "Date:"
  5. Turn the Controller until the desired day is displayed.
  6. Press the Controller.
  7. Make the settings for the month and year.

Setting the date format

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Date and time"
  4. "Date format:"
  5. Select the desired setting.

The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Setting the units of measurement

You can set the units of measurement for some values, for example, consumption, distances and temperature.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Units"
  4. Select the desired menu item.
  5. Select the desired setting.

The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Activating/deactivating the display of the current vehicle position

Concept

If vehicle tracking has been activated, the current vehicle position can be displayed in the MINI Connected app.

Activating/deactivating

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. "Vehicle tracking"
  4. "Vehicle tracking"
  5. Select the desired setting.

Activating/deactivating popup windows

For some functions, popup windows are displayed automatically on the Control Display. Some of these popup windows can be activated or deactivated.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Pop-ups"
  4. Select the desired setting.

The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Control Display

Brightness

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Displays"
  4. "Control display"
  5. "Brightness at night"
  6. Turn the Controller until the desired brightness is set.
  7. Press the Controller.

The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Depending on the light conditions, the brightness settings may not be clearly visible.

Screensaver

If no entries are made via the Central Information Display (CID), a screensaver can be displayed after an adjustable time.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. Select the desired setting.

  2. "My MINI"

  3. "System settings"
  4. "Displays"
  5. "Control display"
  6. "Screensaver"

The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Messages

Concept

The menu centrally displays all messages arriving in the vehicle in list form.

General information

The following messages can be displayed:

  • Traffic messages.
  • Check Control messages.
  • Service requirements messages.
  • Messages from the vehicle manufacturer.

Messages are additionally displayed in the status field.

Retrieving messages

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "Notifications"
  2. Select the desired message.

The respective menu is opened, where the message is displayed.

Deleting messages

All messages, except Check Control messages or messages from the vehicle manufacturer, can be deleted from the list.

Check Control messages or messages from the vehicle manufacturer are displayed as long as they are relevant.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "Notifications"
  2. Select the desired message.

  3. Press the button.

  4. "Delete this notification" or "Delete all notifications"

Adjusting

The following settings can be adjusted:

  • Select the applications, from which messages will be permitted.
  • Sort the messages according to date or priority.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Notifications"
  4. Select the desired setting.

Data protection

Data transfer

Concept

The vehicle offers various functions which require data to be transferred to MINI or a service provider. The data transfer can be deactivated for some functions.

General information

With data transfer deactivated, the respective function cannot be used.

Only make these settings while stationary.

Activating/deactivating

Follow the instructions on the Control Display.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "System settings"

  3. "Data privacy"

  4. Select the desired setting.

Deleting personal data in the vehicle

Concept

Depending on the usage, the vehicle stores personal data, such as stored radio stations. This personal data can be permanently deleted via the Central Information Display (CID).

General information

Depending on the vehicle equipment, the following data is deleted:

- Driver profile settings.

- Stored radio stations.

- Stored programmable memory buttons.

- Travel and Onboard Computer information.

- Phone book.

Altogether, the deletion of the data can take up to 15 minutes.

Functional requirement

Data can only be deleted while stationary.

Deleting data

Note and follow the instructions on the Control Display.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. Switch on the ignition.

  2. "My MINI"

  3. "System settings"

  4. "Data privacy"

  5. "Delete personal data"

  6. "Delete personal data"

  7. "OK"

  8. Exit and lock the vehicle.

The deletion process takes 15 minutes to complete.

If not all data was deleted, repeat the deletion.

Canceling deletion

Start the engine to cancel deletion of the data.

Connections

Concept

Various connection types are available for using mobile devices in the vehicle. The connection type to select depends on the mobile device and the desired function.

General information

The following overview shows possible functions and the suitable connection types for them. The scope of functions depends on the mobile device.

Function Connec- tion type
Making calls via the hands-free system.Bluetooth.
Using phone functions via the Central Information Dis-play (CID).
Playing music from the smartphone or the audio player.Bluetooth or USB.
USB storage device:USB.
Playing music.

The following connection types require one-time pairing with the vehicle:

- Bluetooth.

Paired devices are automatically recognized later on and connected to the vehicle.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Operating the integrated information systems and communication devices while driving can distract from traffic. It is possible to lose control of the vehicle. There is a risk of accident. Only use the systems or devices when the traffic situation allows. As warranted, stop and use the systems and devices while the vehicle is stationary.

Compatible devices

General information

Malfunctions may occur with devices not listed or deviating software versions.

Displaying the vehicle identification number and software part number

When looking for compatible devices, you may have to state the vehicle identification number and the software part number.

These numbers can be displayed in the vehicle.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Mobile devices"
  4. "Settings"
  5. "Bluetooth® info"
  6. "System information"

Bluetooth connection

Functional requirements

  • Compatible device, refer to page 51, with Bluetooth interface.
  • The vehicle key is in the vehicle.
  • The device is ready for operation.
  • Bluetooth is activated on the device and in the vehicle, refer to page 51.
  • Bluetooth presettings, such as visibility, may be required on the device; refer to the owner's manual of the device.

Switching on Bluetooth

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Mobile devices"

  4. "Settings"

  5. "Bluetooth®"

Pairing the mobile device with the vehicle

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Mobile devices"
  4. "Connect new device"
  5. Select the functions for which the device will be used:

  6. "Telephone"

  7. "Bluetooth® audio"

The vehicle's Bluetooth name is displayed on the Control Display.

  1. On the mobile device, search for Bluetooth devices in the vicinity.

The Bluetooth name of the vehicle appears on the mobile device display.

Select the Bluetooth name of the vehicle.

  1. Depending on the mobile device, a control number is displayed or the control number must be entered.

- Compare the control number displayed on the Control Display with the control number on the display of the device.

Confirm the control number on the device and on the Control Display.

- Enter and confirm the same control number on the device and via the Central Information Display (CID).

The device is connected and displayed in the device list.

If connection was not successful: Frequently Asked Questions, refer to page 52.

Frequently Asked Questions

All requirements are met and all required steps were completed in the specified order. Despite that, the mobile device does not function as expected.

In this case, the following explanations can help:

Why could the mobile phone not be paired or connected?

- There are too many Bluetooth devices connected to the mobile phone or vehicle.

In the vehicle, delete Bluetooth connections with other devices.

Delete all known Bluetooth connections from the device list on the mobile phone and start a new device search.

- The mobile phone is in power-save mode or has only a limited remaining battery life.

Charge the mobile phone.

Why does the mobile phone no longer react?

- The applications on the mobile phone do not function anymore.

Switch the mobile phone off and on again.

- Possibly too high or too low ambient temperatures for mobile phone operation.

Do not subject the mobile phone to extreme ambient temperatures.

Why can phone functions not be used via the Central Information Display (CID)?

- The mobile phone may not be properly configured, for instance as Bluetooth audio device.

Connect the mobile phone with the telephone function.

Why are no or not all phone book entries displayed or why are they incomplete?

  • Transmission of the phone book entries is not yet complete.
  • It is possible that only the phone book entries of the mobile phone or the SIM card are transmitted.
  • It may not be possible to display phone book entries with special characters.
  • It may not be possible to transmit contacts from social networks.
  • The number of phone book entries to be stored is too high.
  • Data volume of the contact too large, for instance due to stored information such as notes.
    Reduce the data volume of the contact.

- A mobile phone is only connected as an audio source.

Reconfigure the mobile phone and connect it with the telephone function.

How can the phone connection quality be improved?

- The strength of the Bluetooth signal on the mobile phone can be adjusted, depending on the mobile phone.

If all points in this list have been checked and the required function is still not available, contact the hotline, a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

USB connection

General information

Mobile devices with a USB port are connected to the USB interface.

  • Mobile phones.
  • Audio devices with USB port, for instance MP3 players.
  • USB storage devices.

Common file systems are supported. FAT32 and exFAT are the recommended formats.

A connected USB storage device will be supplied with charge current via the USB interface if the device supports this. Follow the maximum charge current of the USB interface.

USB interfaces with data transfer can be used to play the music files via USB Audio.

Follow the following when connecting:

  • Do not use force when plugging the connector into the USB interface.
  • Use a flexible adapter cable.

- Protect the USB storage device against mechanical damage.

- Due to the large number of USB storage devices available on the market, it cannot be guaranteed that every device is operable on the vehicle.

- Do not expose USB storage devices to extreme environmental conditions, such as very high temperatures; refer to the owner's manual of the device.

- Due to the many different compression techniques, proper playback of the media stored on the USB storage device cannot be guaranteed in all cases.

- To ensure proper transmission of the stored data, do not charge a USB storage device via the onboard socket, when it is connected to the USB interface.

- Depending on how the USB storage device is being used, settings may be required on the USB storage device, refer to the owner's manual of the device.

Not compatible USB media:

  • USB hard drives.
  • USB hubs.
  • USB memory card readers with multiple slots.
  • HFS-formatted or NTFS-formatted USB storage devices.
  • Devices such as fans or lamps.

Functional requirement

Compatible device, refer to page 51, with USB interface.

Connecting the device

Connect the USB storage device using a suitable adapter cable to a USB interface, refer to page 206.

The USB storage device is connected to the vehicle and displayed in the device list.

Managing mobile devices

General information

  • After one-time pairing, the devices are automatically recognized and reconnected when the ignition is switched on.
  • The data stored on the SIM card or in the mobile phone is transferred to the vehicle after recognition.
  • For some devices, certain settings may be necessary, for instance authorization, see owner's manual of the device.

Displaying the device list

All devices paired and/or connected with the vehicle are displayed in the device list.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "System settings"

  3. "Mobile devices"

A symbol indicates, for which function a device is used.

Symbol Function

"Telephone"

"Bluetooth® audio"

Configuring the device

Functions can be activated or deactivated for paired and connected devices.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "System settings"

  3. "Mobile devices"

  4. Select the desired device.

  5. Select the desired setting.

If a function is assigned to a device, the function will be deactivated where appropriate for a device that is already connected and the device will be disconnected.

Disconnecting the device

The device's connection to the vehicle is disconnected.

The device remains paired and can be connected again, refer to page 54.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "System settings"

  3. "Mobile devices"

  4. Select device.

  5. "Disconnect device"

Connecting the device

A disconnected device can be reconnected. Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "System settings"

  3. "Mobile devices"

  4. Select device.

  5. "Connect device"

The functions that were assigned to the device before disconnecting are assigned to the device when it is reconnected. The functions may be deactivated on a device already connected.

Deleting the device

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Mobile devices"
  4. Select device.
  5. "Delete device"

The device is disconnected and removed from the device list.

Owner's Manual media

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

General information

You can use the following media formats to call up the content in the Owner's Manual:

- Printed Owner's Manual, refer to page 56.

Printed Owner's Manual

Concept

The printed Owner's Manual describes all standard, country-specific, and optional features offered with the series.

General information

The Owner's Manual for Navigation, Entertainment, and Communication can be obtained as a printed book from the service center.

Supplementary Owner's Manuals

Also follow the Supplementary Owner's Manuals, which are included in addition to the onboard literature.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Supplementary Owner's Manuals - 1

natural_image Close-up of a wooden pencil resting on a green book, with blurred background (no text or symbols visible)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Supplementary Owner's Manuals - 2

CONTROLS

Opening and closing 60

Seats, mirrors, and steering wheel 81

Transporting children safely 93

Driving 99

Displays 124

Lights 140

Safety 146

Driving stability control systems 166

Driving comfort 171

Climate control 191

Interior equipment 200

Storage compartments 208

Cargo area 211

Opening and closing

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Vehicle key

General information

The vehicle is supplied with two vehicle keys with integrated key.

Each vehicle key contains a replaceable battery, refer to page 63.

Depending on the equipment and country version, various settings, refer to page 74, can be configured for the button functions.

A personal driver profile, refer to page 73, for each vehicle key is stored in the vehicle.

To provide information on maintenance requirements, the service data is stored in the vehicle key, refer to page 298.

To prevent possible locking in of the vehicle key, take the vehicle key with you when exiting the vehicle.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

People or animals in the vehicle can lock the doors from the inside and lock themselves in. In this case, the vehicle cannot be opened from the outside. There is a risk

of injury. Take the vehicle key with you so that the vehicle can be opened from the outside.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

Unlocking from the inside is only possible with special knowledge.

Persons who spend a lengthy time in the vehicle while being exposed to extreme temperatures are at risk of injury or death. Do not lock the vehicle from the outside when there are people in it.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

Unattended children or animals in the vehicle can cause the vehicle to move and endanger themselves and traffic, for instance due to the following actions:

  • Pressing the Start/Stop button.
  • Releasing the parking brake.
  • Opening and closing the doors or windows.
  • Engaging selector lever position N.
  • Using vehicle equipment.

There is a risk of accidents or injuries. Do not leave children or animals unattended in the vehicle. Take the vehicle key with you when exiting and lock the vehicle.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

text_image 1 2 3 4

1 Unlocking
2 Locking
3 Unlocking the tailgate

With automatic tailgate operation: open the tailgate

4 Panic mode

Unlocking

MINI Countryman (2020) - Unlocking - 1

Press the button on the vehicle key.

Depending on the settings, refer to page 74, the following access points are unlocked.

  • Driver's door and fuel filler flap.
    Press the button on the vehicle key again to unlock the other vehicle access points.
  • All doors, tailgate, and fuel filler flap.
    In addition, the following functions are executed:
  • Unlocking is confirmed by the turn signals and the horn. This function must be activated in the settings, refer to page 74.
  • The settings stored in the driver profile, refer to page 73, are applied.
  • The driver's seat is set to the last position saved in the driver's profile. This function must be activated in the settings, refer to page 74.

  • The interior lights, refer to page 144, and the MINI logo projection are switched on, provided that the interior lights were not switched off manually.

  • Depending on the settings, the welcome light and headlight courtesy delay feature, refer to page 141, are switched on.
  • Exterior mirrors folded through convenient closing are folded open.
  • The alarm system, refer to page 75, is switched off.

The light functions may depend on the ambient brightness.

Convenient opening

MINI Countryman (2020) - Convenient opening - 1

Press and hold the button on the vehicle key after unlocking.

The windows and the glass sunroof are opened, as long as the button on the vehicle key is pressed.

Locking

  1. Close the driver's door.
  2. Press the button on the vehicle key.

The following functions are executed:

  • All doors, the tailgate, and the fuel filler flap are locked.
  • Locking is confirmed by the turn signals and the horn. This function must be activated in the settings, refer to page 74.
  • The alarm system, refer to page 75, is switched on.

If the engine or ignition is still switched on when you lock the vehicle, the vehicle horn honks twice. In this case, the engine or ignition must be switched off by means of the Start/Stop button.

With Comfort Access: convenient closing

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

With convenient closing, body parts can be jammed. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement of the doors is clear during convenient closing.

Closing

MINI Countryman (2020) - Closing - 1

Press and hold the button on the vehicle key in the area close to the vehicle.

The windows and the glass sunroof are closed, as long as the button on the vehicle key is pressed.

The exterior mirrors are folded in.

Switch on interior lights and courtesy light

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switch on interior lights and courtesy light - 1

Press the button on the vehicle key with the vehicle locked.

The MINI logo projection is also switched on.

These functions are not available if the interior lights were switched off manually.

The light functions may depend on the ambient brightness.

After locking, wait 10 seconds before pressing the button again.

Tailgate

General information

To avoid locking the vehicle key in the vehicle, do not place the remote control in the cargo area.

Depending on the equipment and country version, it is possible to specify whether the tailgate can be activated with the vehicle key and how the vehicle doors will respond to this. To perform settings, refer to page 74.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Body parts can be jammed when operating the tailgate. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement of the tailgate is clear during opening and closing.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

NOTICE

The tailgate swings back and up when it opens. There is a risk of damage to property. Make sure that the area of movement of the tailgate is clear during opening and closing.

MINI Countryman (2020) - NOTICE - 1

NOTICE

Sharp-edged or pointed objects can hit the windows and heat conductors while driving. There is a risk of damage to property. Cover the edges and ensure that pointed objects do not hit the windows.

Opening

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening - 1

Press and hold the button on the vehicle key for approx. 1 second.

Without automatic tailgate operation:

The tailgate is unlocked and can be swung upward.

With automatic tailgate operation:

The tailgate opens automatically.

Panic mode

You can trigger the alarm system if you find yourself in a dangerous situation.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Panic mode - 1

- Press the button on the vehicle key and hold for at least 3 seconds.

- Briefly press the button on the vehicle key three times in succession.

To switch off the alarm: press any button.

Replacing the battery

  1. Remove the integrated key from the vehicle key, refer to page 65.
  2. Slide the integrated key into the opening and raise the cover. The battery compartment is accessible.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Replacing the battery - 1

natural_image 3D rendered diagram of a mechanical component with an arrow indicating direction (no text or symbols)
  1. Slide the integrated key in the cover of the battery compartment and raise the cover.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Replacing the battery - 2

natural_image Cross-sectional diagram of a mechanical device with a handle and internal component (no text or symbols)
  1. Push battery in the direction of the arrow using a pointed object and lift it out.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Replacing the battery - 3

natural_image 3D rendered mechanical component with a white arrow indicating a specific part (no text or symbols present)
  1. Insert a type CR 2032 battery with the positive side facing up.
  2. Insert lid and cover.
  3. Push the integrated key into the vehicle key until it engages.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Replacing the battery - 4

Have old batteries disposed of by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair

shop or take them to a collection point.

Additional vehicle keys

Additional vehicle keys are available from a service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Loss of vehicle keys

A lost vehicle key can be blocked and replaced by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Malfunction

General information

A Check Control message is displayed. Vehicle key recognition by the vehicle may malfunction under the following circumstances:

- The battery of the vehicle key is discharged. For replacing the battery, refer to page 63.

- Interference of the radio connection from transmission towers or other equipment with high transmitting power.

- Shielding of the vehicle key due to metal objects.

Do not transport the vehicle key together with metal objects.

- Interference of the radio connection from mobile phones or other electronic devices in direct proximity to the vehicle key.

Do not transport the vehicle key together with electronic devices.

- Interference of radio transmission by a charging process of mobile devices, for instance charging of a mobile phone.

In the case of interference, the vehicle can be unlocked and locked from the outside with the integrated key, refer to page 64.

Starting the engine via emergency detection of the Vehicle key

MINI Countryman (2020) - Starting the engine via emergency detection of the Vehicle key - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car interior showing a light-colored brake lever and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)

It is not possible to start the engine if the vehicle key has not been detected.

Proceed as follows in this case:

  1. Hold the vehicle key against the mark on the steering column as shown. Pay attention to the display in the instrument cluster.

  2. If the vehicle key is detected:

Start the engine within 10 seconds.

If the vehicle key is not recognized, slightly change the position of the vehicle key and repeat the procedure.

Frequently Asked Questions

What precautions can be taken to be able to open a vehicle with an accidentally locked in vehicle key?

- The options provided by the Remote Services of the MINI Connected app include the ability to lock and unlock a vehicle.

This requires an active MINI Connected contract and the MINI Connected app must be installed on a smartphone.

- Unlocking the vehicle can be requested via the MINI Connected Call Center.

An active MINI Connected contract is required.

Integrated key

General information

The driver's door can be locked and unlocked without the vehicle key using the integrated key.

Safety information

Warning

Unlocking from the inside is only possible with special knowledge.

Persons who spend a lengthy time in the vehicle while being exposed to extreme temperatures are at risk of injury or death. Do not lock the vehicle from the outside when there are people in it.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

NOTICE

The door lock is permanently joined with the door. The door handle can be moved. When pulling the door handle with the integrated key inserted, paint or the integrated key can be damaged. There is a risk of damage to property. Remove the integrated key before pulling the outside door handle.

Removing

MINI Countryman (2020) - Removing - 1

text_image 1 MINI 2

Press the button, arrow 1, and pull out the integrated key, arrow 2.

Locking/unlocking via the door lock

  1. Remove lid on the door lock.

To do this, slide the integrated key into the opening from below and remove the lid.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Locking/unlocking via the door lock - 1

natural_image Close-up of a black cylindrical object with a circular shadow and an arrow pointing to it, against a dark gradient background (no text or symbols)
  1. Unlock or lock the door lock using the integrated key.

The other doors must be unlocked or locked from the inside.

Alarm system

The alarm system is not switched on if the vehicle is locked with the integrated key. The alarm system is triggered when the door is opened, if the vehicle has been unlocked via the door lock.

Buttons for the central locking system

General information

In the event of a severe accident, the vehicle is automatically unlocked. The hazard warning system and interior lights come on.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's head panel with a circular dial and pointer (no text or symbols visible)

Buttons for the central locking system.

Locking

MINI Countryman (2020) - Locking - 1

Press the button with the front doors closed.

- The fuel filler flap remains unlocked. - The vehicle is not secured against theft when locking.

Unlocking

MINI Countryman (2020) - Unlocking - 1

Press the button.

Opening

  • Press button to unlock the doors together, and then pull the door handle above the armrest.
  • Front doors: pull the door handle on the door to open the door. The other doors remain locked.
  • Back doors: pull twice on the door handle on the door to be opened; the first time unlocks the door, the second time opens it. The other doors remain locked.

Comfort Access

Concept

The vehicle can be accessed without operating the vehicle key.

Carrying the vehicle key with you, e.g., in your pants pocket, is sufficient.

The vehicle automatically detects the vehicle key when it is in close proximity or in the car's interior.

General information

Comfort Access supports the following functions:

  • Unlocking and locking the vehicle.
  • Convenient closing.
  • Open the tailgate.
  • Opening/closing the tailgate with no-touch activation.

This function must be activated in the settings, refer to page 74.

This function is not available in vehicles with a trailer hitch or with a rear luggage rack preparation.

Functional requirements

  • To lock the vehicle, the vehicle key must be outside of the vehicle near the doors.
  • The next unlocking and locking cycle is not possible until after approx. 2 seconds.

Unlocking

MINI Countryman (2020) - Unlocking - 1

natural_image Abstract black-and-white graphic with a curved arrow and dot, no text or symbols present

On the driver's or front passenger's outer door handle, press the button.

Depending on the settings, refer to page 74, only the driver's door and the fuel filler flap may be unlocked. Unlike when unlocking with the vehicle key, pressing the button on the outer door handle again does not unlock the other vehicle access points. Rather, the vehicle is locked again.

If the vehicle was locked automatically after driving off or with the button of the central locking system from the inside, note the following: if a door on a locked vehicle is opened from the inside with the door opener, pressing the button on the outer door handle will first lock the vehicle again. To unlock, the button on the outer door handle must be pressed again.

Locking

MINI Countryman (2020) - Locking - 1

natural_image Simple diagram of a hand holding a pen with an arrow pointing to it, set against a dark gradient background (no text or symbols)

On the driver's or front passenger's outer door handle, press the button.

Convenient closing

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

With convenient closing, body parts can be jammed. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement of the doors is clear during convenient closing.

Closing

MINI Countryman (2020) - Closing - 1

natural_image Abstract black-and-white graphic with a curved arrow and dot, no text or symbols present

Press and hold down the button on the driver's or front passenger's outer door handle.

In addition to locking, the windows and glass sunroof will be closed.

The exterior mirrors are folded in.

To open the tailgate

General information

If the tailgate is opened via Comfort Access, locked doors are not unlocked.

To avoid locking the vehicle key in the vehicle, do not place the vehicle key in the cargo area.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Body parts can be jammed when operating the tailgate. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement of the tailgate is clear during opening and closing.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

NOTICE

The tailgate swings back and up when it opens. There is a risk of damage to property. Make sure that the area of movement of the tailgate is clear during opening and closing.

MINI Countryman (2020) - NOTICE - 1

NOTICE

Sharp-edged or pointed objects can hit the windows and heat conductors while driving. There is a risk of damage to property. Cover the edges and ensure that pointed objects do not hit the windows.

Opening

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening - 1

natural_image Side view of a car's rear bumper with a white arrow pointing to the side panel (no text or symbols visible)

Press button next on tailgate.

Without automatic tailgate operation:

The tailgate is unlocked and can be swung upward.

With automatic tailgate operation:

The tailgate opens automatically.

Opening and closing the split doors with no-touch activation

Concept

The tailgate can be opened and closed with no-touch activation using the vehicle key you are carrying. Two sensors detect a forward-directed foot motion in the central rear area and the tailgate is opened or closed.

This function is not available in vehicles with a trailer hitch or with a rear luggage rack preparation.

General information

To avoid locking the vehicle key in the vehicle, do not place the vehicle key in the cargo area.

If the vehicle key is in the sensor area, the tailgate may open or close inadvertently if you unintentionally move your foot or if a foot movement is detected.

The sensor has an approximate range of 5 ft/1.50 m extending from the rear of the vehicle.

If the tailgate is opened with no-touch activation, locked doors are not unlocked.

Contactless opening and closing of the tailgate must be activated in the settings.

Safety information

Warning

During no-touch activation, vehicle parts may be touched, such as the hot exhaust gas system. There is a risk of injury. When moving your foot, make sure you have a firm stance and do not touch the vehicle.

Warning

Body parts can be jammed when operating the tailgate. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement of the tailgate is clear during opening and closing.

NOTICE

The tailgate swings back and up when it opens. There is a risk of damage to property. Make sure that the area of movement of the tailgate is clear during opening and closing.

Adjusting

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "Vehicle settings"

  3. "Doors/Key"

  4. "Tailgate"

  5. Select the desired setting:

  6. "Open by foot movement"
    Contactless opening of the tailgate is switched on or off.

  7. "Close by foot movement"

Contactless closing of the tailgate is switched on or off.

Performing the foot movement

  1. Stand in the middle behind the vehicle at approx. one arm's length away from the rear of the vehicle.
  2. Wave a foot under the vehicle in the direction of travel and immediately pull it back. With this movement, the leg must pass through the ranges of both sensors.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Performing the foot movement - 1

natural_image Side view of a person's lower body with a car and sensor waves overlay (no text or symbols)

Opening

Perform the foot movement described earlier.

Before the opening, the hazard warning system flashes.

If touchless closing is switched on:

Moving a foot again will stop the opening process.

The subsequent foot movement will close the tailgate again.

Closing

Perform the foot movement described earlier.

Before closing, the hazard warning system flashes and an acoustic signal sounds.

Moving a foot again will stop the closing process.

When the touchless opening is switched on: the subsequent foot movement will open the tailgate again.

Malfunction

Vehicle key recognition by the vehicle may malfunction under the following circumstances:

- The battery of the vehicle key is discharged. For replacing the battery, refer to page 63.

- Interference of the radio connection from transmission towers or other equipment with high transmitting power.

- Shielding of the vehicle key due to metal objects.

Do not transport the vehicle key together with metal objects.

- Interference of the radio connection from mobile phones or other electronic devices in direct proximity to the vehicle key.

Do not transport the vehicle key together with electronic devices.

Wet or snowy conditions may disrupt the locking request recognition function on the door handles.

In the case of a malfunction, unlock and lock the vehicle using the buttons of the vehicle key or use the integrated key, refer to page 64.

Tailgate

General information

To avoid locking the vehicle key in the vehicle, do not place the remote control in the cargo area.

Depending on the equipment and country version, it is possible to specify whether the tailgate can be activated with the vehicle key and how the vehicle doors will respond to this. To perform settings, refer to page 74.

Safety information

Warning

Body parts can be jammed when operating the tailgate. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement of the tailgate is clear during opening and closing.

NOTICE

The tailgate swings back and up when it opens. There is a risk of damage to property. Make sure that the area of movement of the tailgate is clear during opening and closing.

NOTICE

Sharp-edged or pointed objects can hit the windows and heat conductors while driving. There is a risk of damage to property. Cover the edges and ensure that pointed objects do not hit the windows.

Without automatic tailgate operation

Opening from the outside
MINI Countryman (2020) - Without automatic tailgate operation - 1

natural_image Side view of a car's rear bumper with a white arrow pointing to the side panel (no text or symbols)

- Without Comfort Access: unlock vehicle.

With Comfort Access: unlock the vehicle or have the vehicle key with you.

Press button next on tailgate.

- Press and hold the button on the

MINI Countryman (2020) - Without automatic tailgate operation - 2

vehicle key for approx. 1 second.

Depending on the setting, the doors may also be unlocked. Unlocking with the vehicle key, refer to page 62.

The tailgate is unlocked and can be swung upward.

Opening from the inside

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening from the inside - 1

With Steptronic transmission:

With the vehicle stationary, pull the

button in the storage compartment of the driver's door upwards.

If the vehicle is locked, selector lever position P must be engaged first.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening from the inside - 2

With manual transmission:

With the vehicle stationary, pull the

button in the storage compartment of the driver's door upwards twice in quick succession.

Closing
MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening from the inside - 3

natural_image Top-down view of a car's rear intake frame with illuminated windows (no text or symbols visible)

Recessed grips on the interior trim of the tailgate can be used to conveniently pull down the tailgate.

With automatic tailgate operation

Opening

Adjusting the opening height

You can set how far the tailgate should open.

When adjusting the opening height, ensure that there is a clearance of at least 4 in/10 cm above the tailgate.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "Vehicle settings"

  3. "Doors/Key"

  4. "Tailgate"

  5. Monitor the tailgate and set the desired opening height.

From the outside

MINI Countryman (2020) - From the outside - 1

natural_image Side view of a car's rear bumper with a white arrow pointing to the side panel (no text or symbols visible)

- Without Comfort Access: unlock vehicle. With Comfort Access: unlock the vehicle or have the vehicle key with you. Press the button on tailgate's exterior.

- Press and hold the button on the vehicle key for approx. 1 second.

Depending on the setting, the doors may also be unlocked. Unlocking using the vehicle key, refer to page 62.

If the vehicle is stationary, the tailgate opens automatically to the adjusted opening height.

From the inside

MINI Countryman (2020) - From the inside - 1

With Steptronic transmission:

Pull button in the storage compa- of the driver's door upward.

If the vehicle is locked, selector lever position P must be engaged first.

MINI Countryman (2020) - From the inside - 2

With manual transmission:

With the vehicle stationary, pull the button in the storage compartment of the driver's door upwards twice in quick succession.

If the vehicle is stationary, the tailgate opens automatically to the adjusted opening height.

Interruption of the opening procedure

The opening procedure is interrupted in the following situations:

  • When the vehicle starts moving.
  • By pressing the button on the outside of the tailgate. Pressing again closes the tailgate.
  • By pressing the button on the inside of the tailgate. Pressing again closes the tailgate.
  • By pressing the button on the vehicle key. Pressing again continues the opening motion.
  • By pressing or pulling the button in the storage compartment of the driver's door. Pulling again continues the opening motion.

Closing

From the outside

Press the button on tailgate's exterior.

From the inside

MINI Countryman (2020) - From the inside - 1

Press and hold the button in the storage compartment of the driver's door.

The vehicle key must be located in the car's interior for this function.

An acoustic signal sounds before the tailgate is closed.

From inside the tailgate

Without Comfort Access:

MINI Countryman (2020) - From inside the tailgate - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car inside a rectangular button with an upward arrow, symbolizing speed or speed (no text or symbols present)

Press the button on the inside of the tailgate.

With Comfort Access:

MINI Countryman (2020) - From inside the tailgate - 2

text_image Diagram of a car interior control panel with icons for car, lock, and directional arrows labeled 1 and 2

- Press button on the inside of the tailgate, arrow 1.

- Press button, arrow 2.

The vehicle will be locked after closing the tailgate. The driver's door must be closed for this purpose and the vehicle key must be outside of the vehicle in the area of the tailgate.

Interruption of the closing procedure

The closing procedure is interrupted in the following situations:

  • If the vehicle starts off with a jerky movement.
  • By pressing the button on the outside of the tailgate. Pressing again closes the tailgate.
  • By pressing the button on the inside of the tailgate. Pressing again closes the tailgate.
  • By releasing the button in the storage compartment of the driver's door. Pressing again and holding continues the closing motion.

Malfunction

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

With manual operation of a blocked tailgate, it can release itself unexpectedly from the blockage. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Do not operate the tailgate manually if it is blocked. Have it checked by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Manual operation

Operate the unlocked tailgate manually with a slow and smooth motion.

To close the tailgate fully, press down lightly only. Closing occurs automatically.

Driver profiles

Concept

In the driver profiles, individual settings for several drivers can be stored and called up again when required.

General information

There are three driver profiles with which personal vehicle settings can be stored. Every vehicle key has been assigned one of these driver profiles.

If the vehicle is unlocked using the vehicle key, the assigned personal driver profile will be activated. All settings stored in the driver profile are automatically applied.

If several drivers use their own vehicle keys, the vehicle will apply the personal settings as it is being unlocked. These settings are also restored, if the vehicle has been used in the meantime by a person with a different vehicle key.

Changes to the settings are automatically stored in the driver profile currently activated.

Functional requirements

For the system to be able to identify the driver profile associated to a particular driver, the detected vehicle key must be clearly allocated to the driver.

This is the case when:

  • The driver is only carrying his or her own vehicle key.
  • The driver unlocks the vehicle.
  • The driver gets into the vehicle through the driver's door.

Adjusting

The settings for the following systems and functions are stored in the active profile.

The scope of storable settings depends on country and equipment.

  • Unlocking and locking.
  • Lights.
  • Radio.
  • Instrument cluster.
  • Programmable memory buttons.
  • Volumes, tone.
  • Control Display.
  • Climate control.
  • PDC Park Distance Control.
  • Rearview camera.
  • MINI Driving Modes.
  • Intelligent Safety.
  • Driver's seat position, exterior mirror position.
    Both the positions saved via the seat memory and the last position set are saved.

System limits

A clear assignment between the vehicle key and driver may not be possible in the following cases, for example.

  • The passenger unlocks the vehicle with his or her own vehicle key, but another person is driving.
  • The driver unlocks the vehicle via Comfort Access and has multiple vehicle keys with him or her.
  • The driver changes, but the vehicle is not locked and unlocked.
  • Multiple vehicle keys are located outside of the vehicle.

Adjusting

General information

Depending on the package and country version, various settings are available for the vehicle key functions.

These settings are stored for the driver profile, refer to page 73, currently used.

Unlocking

Doors

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. "Doors/Key"
  4. "Driver's door" or "All doors"
  5. Select the desired setting:

- "Driver's door only"

Only the driver's door and the fuel filler flap are unlocked. Pressing again unlocks the entire vehicle.

- "All doors"

The entire vehicle is unlocked.

Tailgate

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. "Doors/Key"
    4.

The text next to the symbol indicates the current setting.

  1. Select the desired setting:

- "Tailgate"

Depending on your vehicle's optional features, the tailgate is either unlocked or opened.

- "Tailgate and door(s)"

Depending on your vehicle's optional features, the tailgate is either unlocked or opened and the doors unlocked.

- "Tailgate opens after unlocking"

The vehicle must be unlocked before the tailgate can be used with the vehicle key.

- "Button lock"

It is not possible to use the tailgate via the vehicle key.

Depending on the vehicle equipment and country version, this setting may not be offered.

Automatic locking

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. "Doors/Key"
  4. Select the desired setting:

- "Lock automatically"

The vehicle locks automatically after a while if no door is opened after un-locking.

- "Lock after starting to drive"

The vehicle locks automatically after you drive off.

Automatic unlocking

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. "Doors/Key"
  4. "Unlock at end of trip"

After the engine is switched off by pressing the Start/Stop button, the

locked vehicle is automatically unlocked.

Confirmation signals from the vehicle

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "Vehicle settings"

  3. "Doors/Key"

  4. Deactivate or activate the desired confirmation signals.

- "Flash for lock/unlock" Unlocking is signaled by two flashes, locking by one.

- With alarm system: "Acoustic signal for lock/unlock" Unlocking is signaled by one honk of the horn.

Alarm system

General information

When the vehicle is locked, the vehicle alarm system reacts to the following changes:

  • Unauthorized opening of a door, the hood or the tailgate.
  • Movements in the car's interior.
  • Changes in the vehicle tilt, for instance, during attempts at stealing a wheel or when towing the vehicle.
  • Disconnected battery voltage.
  • Improper use of the socket for Onboard Diagnosis.
  • Locking the vehicle while a device is connected to the socket for the OBD Onboard-Diagnosis. For socket for the OBD Onboard Diagnosis, refer to page 299.

The alarm system signals these changes visually and acoustically:

- Acoustic alarm:

Depending on local regulations, the acoustic alarm may be suppressed.

- Visual alarm:

By flashing the exterior lighting.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image 3D rendered object with a white arrow pointing upward, no visible text or symbols

Indicator light on the interior mirror.

Switching on/off

When you unlock and lock the vehicle, either with the vehicle key or via Comfort Access, the alarm system is switched off and on at the same time.

Opening the doors with the alarm system switched on

The alarm system is triggered when a door is opened if the door was unlocked using the integrated key in the door lock.

Switching off the alarm, refer to page 76.

Opening the tailgate with the alarm system switched on

The tailgate can be opened even when the alarm system is switched on.

After the tailgate is closed, it is locked and monitored again provided the doors are locked. The hazard warning system flashes once.

Panic mode

You can trigger the alarm system if you find yourself in a dangerous situation.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Panic mode - 1

- Press the button on the vehicle key and hold for at least 3 seconds.

- Briefly press the button on the vehicle key three times in succession.

To switch off the alarm: press any button.

Signals of the indicator lights

- The indicator light flashes briefly every 2 seconds:

The alarm system is switched on.

- Indicator light flashes for approx.

10 seconds, then it flashes briefly every 2 seconds:

Interior motion sensor and tilt alarm sensor are not active, as doors, hood, or tailgate are not correctly closed. Correctly closed access points are secured.

When the still open access points are closed, the interior motion sensor and tilt alarm sensor will be switched on.

- The indicator light goes out after un-locking:

The vehicle has not been tampered with.

- The indicator light flashes after unlocking until the engine ignition is switched on, but no longer than approx. 5 minutes:

An alarm has been triggered.

Tilt alarm sensor

The tilt of the vehicle is monitored.

The alarm system responds in situations such as attempts to steal a wheel or when the vehicle is towed.

Interior motion sensor

The windows and the glass sunroof must be closed for the system to function properly.

Avoiding unintentional alarms

General information

The tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor can trigger an alarm, although no unauthorized action occurred.

Possible situations for an unwanted alarm:

  • In automatic vehicle washes.
  • In duplex garages.
  • During transport on trains carrying vehicles, at sea or on a trailer.
  • With animals in the vehicle.
  • When the vehicle is locked after start of fueling.

The tilt alarm sensor and the interior motion sensor can be switched off in such situations.

Switching off the tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching off the tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor - 1

Press the button on the vehicle key within 10 seconds as soon as the vehicle is locked.

The indicator light lights up for approx. 2 seconds and then continues to flash.

The tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor are switched off until the vehicle is locked again.

Switching off the alarm

  • Unlock the vehicle with the vehicle key.
  • Unlock the vehicle with the integrated remote control or switch on the ignition using the emergency detection of remote control, refer to page 63.
  • With Comfort Access: if you have the vehicle key with you, unlock the vehicle

using the button on the driver's side or passenger side door.

Power windows

General information

If an accident of a certain severity occurs, the windows are automatically closed except a gap.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

When operating the windows, body parts and objects can be jammed. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the area of movement of the windows is clear during opening and closing.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's side panel with control buttons and a battery (no visible text or symbols)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 2

Power windows.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 3

Safety switch.

Opening

- P is the switch to the resistance point.

The window opens while the switch is being held.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening - 1

the switch beyond the resist- point.

The window opens automatically. Pressing the switch again stops the motion.

Convenient opening with the vehicle key, refer to page 61.

Closing

MINI Countryman (2020) - Closing - 1

he switch to the resistance t.

The window closes while the switch is being held.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Closing - 2

the switch beyond the resist- e point.

The window closes automatically if the door is closed. Pulling the switch again stops the motion.

Convenient closing with the vehicle key, refer to page 62.

Closing via Comfort Access, refer to page 67.

Jam protection system

Concept

The jam protection prevents objects or body parts becoming jammed between the door frame and window while a window is being closed.

General information

If resistance or a blockage is detected while a window is being closed, the closing action is interrupted.

The window opens slightly.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Accessories on the windows such as antennas can impact jam protection. There is a risk of injury. Do not install accessories in the area of movement of the windows.

Closing without the jam protection system

In case of danger from the outside or if ice might prevent normal closing, proceed as follows:

  1. The switch past the resistance point and hold it there.

The window closes with limited jam protection. If the closing force exceeds a specific threshold, closing is interrupted.

  1. the switch past the resistance point again within approx. 4 seconds and hold it there.

The window closes without jam protection.

Safety switch

General information

The safety switch can be used to prevent children, for instance from opening and closing the rear windows using the switches in the rear.

If an accident of a certain severity occurs, the safety function is switched off automatically.

Switching on/off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off - 1

Press the button.

The LED lights up if the safety function is switched on.

Malfunction

General information

In certain situations a window can only be operated to a limited extent.

- After a power failure during the opening or closing process, the a window can only be operated to a limited extent. The system must be initialized in this case.

- The power window motors are equipped with overheating protection. If a window is opened and closed several times within a short period of time, the overheating protection switches the motor off temporarily. Depending on the degree of overheating, it may only be possible to close the window or it may not be possible to operate it at all.

In this case: allow the power window motor to cool down.

Initializing the system

The system can be initialized when the vehicle is stationary and the engine is running.

During initialization, the affected window closes without jam protection.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Initializing the system - 1

Warning

When operating the windows, body parts and objects can be jammed. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property.

Make sure that the area of movement of the windows is clear during opening and closing.

  1. Open the affected window completely.

  2. the switch to the resistance point and hold.

The window closes.

  1. Continue holding the switch pulled to the resistance point.

The window opens and closes once or twice after approx. 15 seconds, depending on the vehicle's equipment.

  1. Release switch.

Panoramic glass sunroof

General information

In the event of a severe accident, the glass sunroof is automatically closed.

Safety information

Warning

Body parts can be jammed when operating the glass sunroof. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement of the glass sunroof is clear during opening and closing.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Top-down view of a car dashboard with two illuminated buttons and control knobs (no visible text or symbols)

Tilting the glass sunroof

MINI Countryman (2020) - Tilting the glass sunroof - 1

Press back the switch up to or beyond the resistance point and release it.

The glass sunroof is raised.

Opening glass sunroof

When the glass sunroof is closed

MINI Countryman (2020) - When the glass sunroof is closed - 1

Press the switch back beyond the resistance point and release it twice.

The glass sunroof is opened.

Pressing the switch again

stops the motion.

With the glass sunroof completely raised

MINI Countryman (2020) - With the glass sunroof completely raised - 1

- Slide switch back to the resistance point and hold.

The glass sunroof is opened as long as the switch is pressed.

- Press the switch back beyond the resistance point and release it.

The glass sunroof is opened.

Pressing the switch again stops the motion.

Comfort position

In some models, the wind noises in the car's interior are lowest when the glass sunroof is not fully open. In these models, the automatic function initially only opens the glass sunroof up to this comfort position.

Pressing the switch again opens the glass sunroof fully.

Closing glass sunroof

With the glass sunroof open

MINI Countryman (2020) - With the glass sunroof open - 1

- Slide switch forward to the resistance point and hold. The glass sunroof is closed as long as the switch is pressed and stops in the raised position.

- Press the switch forward beyond the resistance point and release it.

The glass sunroof is closed and stops in the raised position.

Pressing the switch again stops the motion.

- Press the switch forward beyond the resistance point and release it twice.

The glass sunroof is closed.

Pressing the switch again stops the motion.

With the glass sunroof completely raised

MINI Countryman (2020) - With the glass sunroof completely raised - 1

Press the switch forward beyond the resistance point and release it.

The glass sunroof is closed.

Jam protection system

Concept

The jam protection prevents objects or body parts from becoming jammed between the roof and glass sunroof while the glass sun-roof is closing.

General information

If resistance or a blockage is detected while the glass sunroof is being closed, the closing action is interrupted.

The glass sunroof opens slightly.

Closing without the jam protection system

If there is an external danger, proceed as follows:

MINI Countryman (2020) - Closing without the jam protection system - 1

  1. Push the switch forward past the resistance point and hold it.

The glass sunroof closes with limited jam protection. If the closing force exceeds a specific threshold, closing is interrupted.

  1. Push the switch forward again past the resistance point and hold until the glass sunroof closes without jam protection. Make sure that the closing area is clear.

Initializing after a power interruption

After a power failure during the opening or closing process, the glass sunroof can only be operated to a limited extent. The system must be initialized in this case. MINI recommends having this work performed only by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Seats, mirrors, and steering wheel

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Sitting safely

An ideal seating position that meets the needs of the occupants can make a vital contribution to relaxed, fatigue-free driving. In the event of an accident, the correct seating position plays an important role. Follow the information in the following chapters:

  • Seats, refer to page 81.
  • Safety belts, refer to page 85.
  • Head restraints, refer to page 87.
  • Airbags, refer to page 146.

Front seats

Safety information

Warning

Seat adjustments while driving can lead to unexpected movements of the seat. Vehicle control could be lost. There is a risk of accident. Only adjust the seat on the driver's side when the vehicle is stationary.

Warning

With a backrest inclined too far to the rear, the efficacy of the safety belt can no longer be ensured. There is a risk of sliding under the safety belt in an accident. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Adjust the seat prior to starting the trip. Adjust the backrest so that it is in the most upright position as possible and do not adjust again while driving.

Warning

There is a risk of jamming when moving the seats. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the area of movement of the seat is clear prior to any adjustment.

Manually adjustable seats

Overview
MINI Countryman (2020) - Manually adjustable seats - 1

text_image 1 2 3 4

1 Forward/backward
2 Thigh support
3 Height
4 Backrest tilt

Forward/backward

MINI Countryman (2020) - Forward/backward - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's seatbelt mechanism with white arrow indicating direction (no text or symbols)

Pull the lever and slide the seat in the desired direction.

After releasing the lever, move the seat forward or back slightly making sure it engages properly.

Height

MINI Countryman (2020) - Height - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car interior showing a seatbelt with white arrows indicating direction (no text or symbols)

Pull the lever up or press it down as often as needed to reach the desired height.

Backrest tilt

MINI Countryman (2020) - Backrest tilt - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing the seatbelt and dashboard (no text or symbols visible)

Pull the lever, and apply your weight to the backrest or lift it off, as necessary.

Lumbar support

The curvature of the seat backrest can be adjusted in a way that it supports the lumbar region of the spine. The lower back and the spine are supported for upright posture.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Lumbar support - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's wheel and dashboard with directional arrows indicating motion (no text or symbols)

Turn the wheel in order to increase or decrease the curvature.

Electrically adjustable seats

General information

The current seat position can be stored using the memory function, refer to page 89.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

text_image 1 4 3 2

1 Memory function
2 Lumbar support
3 Backrest tilt
4 Forward/backward, height, seat tilt

Forward/backward

MINI Countryman (2020) - Forward/backward - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car door handle with buttons and a zipper, showing white arrows pointing to the zipper (no text or symbols visible)

Push switch forward or backward.

Height

MINI Countryman (2020) - Height - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car door handle with white arrows indicating left and right motion (no text or symbols)

Push switch up or down.

Seat tilt

MINI Countryman (2020) - Seat tilt - 1

natural_image Close-up of a camera mode dial with directional arrows indicating rotation (no text or symbols)

Move switch up or down.

Backrest tilt

MINI Countryman (2020) - Backrest tilt - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's side panel with directional arrows indicating rotation or change (no text or symbols)

Move switch forward or backward.

Lumbar support

Concept

The curvature of the seat backrest can be adjusted in a way that it supports the lumbar region of the spine. The lower back and the spine are supported for upright posture.

Adjusting

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting - 1

- Press the front/rear section of the button:

The curvature is increased/decreased.

- Press the upper/lower section of the button:

The curvature is shifted up/down.

Thigh support

MINI Countryman (2020) - Thigh support - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's head and neck assembly with directional arrows indicating motion (no text or symbols)

Pull the lever at the front of the seat and adjust the thigh support.

Front seat heating

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car air conditioning dashboard with three rotary gauges and control buttons (no readable text or symbols)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 2

Seat heating

Switching on

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 1

Press the button once for each temperature level.

The maximum temperature is reached when three LEDs are lit.

If the trip is continued within approx.

15 minutes after a stop, seat heating is activated automatically with the temperature selected last.

When GREEN Mode is activated, refer to page 228, the heating output is reduced.

Switching off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching off - 1

Press and hold the button until the LEDs go out.

Rear seats

Safety information

Warning

There is a risk of jamming when folding down the center armrest in the rear. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement of the center armrest is clear during folding down.

Warning

Unexpected movements of the rear seat backrest while driving may occur due to unintentional unlocking of the rear seat backrests by the straps. There is a risk of injury. Do not fasten any objects to the straps for unlocking the rear backrests.

Forward/backward

General information

The rear seat is divided at a ratio of 60 to 40. The left seat is connected to the center section.

Adjusting

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car seatbelt with an arrow pointing to the lower side (no text or symbols visible)

Pull the lever and slide the seat in the desired direction.

After releasing the lever, move the seat forward or back slightly making sure it engages properly.

Backrest tilt

MINI Countryman (2020) - Backrest tilt - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car seatbelt mechanism with a white arrow pointing to the side (no text or symbols visible)

Pull the strap and apply your weight to the backrest or lift it off, as necessary.

After the adjustment, move the backrest slightly forward or back to engage it correctly.

Safety belts

Number of safety belts and safety belt buckles

The vehicle is fitted with five safety belts to ensure occupant safety. However, they can only offer protection when adjusted correctly.

The two outer safety belt buckles of the rear seat are intended for the persons sitting on the left and right.

The center safety belt buckle of the rear seat is intended for the person sitting in the middle.

General information

Always make sure that safety belts are being worn by all occupants before driving off. Although airbags enhance safety by providing added protection, they are not a substitute for safety belts.

If needed, disengage the safety belt in the rear from the belt buckle on the side.

The upper shoulder strap's anchorage point will be correct for adult seat occupants of every build if the seat is correctly adjusted.

Safety information

Warning

Use of a safety belt to buckle more than one person will potentially defeat the ability of the safety belt to serve its protective function. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Do not allow more than one person to wear a single safety belt. Infants and children are not allowed on an occupant's lap, but must be transported and secured in designated child restraint systems.

Warning

The efficacy of safety gear, including safety belts, can be limited or lost when safety belts are fastened incorrectly. An incorrectly fastened safety belt can cause additional injuries, for instance in the event of an accident or during braking and evasive maneuvers. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Make sure that all

occupants are wearing safety belts correctly.

Warning

The efficacy of safety gear, including safety belts, may not be fully functional or fail in the following situations:

- The safety belts or safety belt buckles are damaged, soiled, or changed in any other way.

- Belt tensioners or belt retractors were modified.

Safety belts can be imperceptibly damaged in the event of an accident. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Do not modify safety belts, safety belt buckles, belt tensioners, belt retractors or belt anchors and keep them clean. Have the safety belts checked after an accident at the dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Correct use of safety belts

- Wear the safety belt twist-free and tight to your body over your lap and shoulders.

- Wear the safety belt deep on your hips over your lap. The safety belt may not press on your stomach.

- Do not rub the safety belt against sharp edges, or guide it or jam it in across hard or fragile objects.

- Avoid thick clothing.

- Re-tighten the safety belt frequently upward around your upper body.

Buckling the safety belt

  1. Guide the safety belt slowly over shoulder and hip to put it on.

  2. Insert the tongue plate into the safety belt buckle. The safety belt buckle must engage audibly.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Buckling the safety belt - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car seatbelt with a white arrow pointing to the side panel (no text or symbols visible)

Unbuckling the safety belt

  1. Hold the safety belt firmly.
  2. Press the red button in the belt buckle.
  3. Guide the safety belt back into its roll-up mechanism.

Middle safety belt in the rear

Buckling the safety belt

MINI Countryman (2020) - Buckling the safety belt - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car seatbelt with two labeled arrows indicating positions 1 and 2 (no text or symbols beyond labels)
  1. Pull the buckle tongues out of the mounts in the roof.
  2. Insert the lower buckle tongue in the belt buckle, arrow 1.
  3. Insert the upper buckle tongue in the belt buckle, arrow 2.
    Safety belt buckles must audibly click into place.

Unbuckling the safety belt

  1. Hold the safety belt firmly.
  2. Press the red button in the belt buckle.
  3. Use the buckle tongue, arrow 1, to open the second safety belt buckle, arrow 2.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Unbuckling the safety belt - 1

text_image Diagram of car seatbelt buckle assembly with numbered parts and directional arrows indicating assembly steps
  1. Guide the safety belt to the mount in the roofliner.

Safety belt reminder for driver's seat and front passenger seat

Display in the instrument cluster

The indicator light lights up and a signal sounds. Make sure that the safety belts are positioned correctly. The safety belt reminder can also be activated if objects are placed on the front passenger seat.

Front head restraints

Safety information

Warning

A missing protective effect due to removed or not correctly adjusted head restraints can cause injuries in the head and neck area. There is a risk of injury.

- Before driving, install the removed head restraints on the occupied seats.

  • Adjust the head restraint so its center supports the back of the head at as close to eye level as possible.
  • Adjust the distance so that the head restraint is as close as possible to the back of the head. Adjust the distance via the backrest tilt as needed.

Warning

Body parts can be jammed when moving the head restraint. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement is clear when moving the head restraint.

Warning

Objects on the head restraint reduce the protective effect in the head and neck area. There is a risk of injury.

  • Do not use seat or head restraint covers.
  • Do not hang objects, for instance clothes hangers, directly on the head restraint.
  • Only use accessories that have been determined to be safe for attachment to a head restraint.
  • Do not use any accessories, for instance pillows, while driving.

Adjusting the height: John Cooper Works sport seat

The height of the head restraints cannot be adjusted.

Adjusting the height

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting the height - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a white object with directional arrows indicating flow or movement (no text or symbols present)
  • To lower: press the button, arrow 1, and push the head restraint down.
  • To raise: push the head restraint up.

After setting the height, make sure that the head restraint engages correctly.

Removing: John Cooper Works sport seat

The head restraints cannot be removed.

Removing

Only remove the head restraint if no one will be sitting in the seat in question.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Removing - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a white vehicle headrest with directional arrows indicating movement or flow (no text or symbols)
  1. If necessary, fold the rear seat backrest forward.
  2. Pull head restraint up as far as possible.
  3. Press the button, arrow 1, and pull the head restraint out completely.

Installing

Proceed in the reverse order to install the head restraint.

Rear head restraints

Safety information

Warning

A missing protective effect due to removed or not correctly adjusted head restraints can cause injuries in the head and neck area. There is a risk of injury.

  • Before driving, install the removed head restraints on the occupied seats.
  • Adjust the head restraint so its center supports the back of the head at as close to eye level as possible.
  • Adjust the distance so that the head restraint is as close as possible to the back of the head. Adjust the distance via the backrest tilt as needed.

Warning

Body parts can be jammed when moving the head restraint. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement is clear when moving the head restraint.

Warning

Objects on the head restraint reduce the protective effect in the head and neck area. There is a risk of injury.

  • Do not use seat or head restraint covers.
  • Do not hang objects, for instance clothes hangers, directly on the head restraint.
  • Only use accessories that have been determined to be safe for attachment to a head restraint.
  • Do not use any accessories, for instance pillows, while driving.

Adjusting the height

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting the height - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's head and neck showing a circular component with directional arrows indicating motion or movement (no text or symbols)
  • To lower: press the button, arrow 1, and push the head restraint down.
  • To raise: push the head restraint up.

After setting the height, make sure that the head restraint engages correctly.

Fold down

MINI Countryman (2020) - Fold down - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a white helmet with two directional arrows labeled 1 and 2 (no text or symbols beyond labels)
  • To fold down: press the button, arrow 1, and press down the head restraint, arrow 2.
  • Forward: fold the head restraint toward the front as far as it will go. Make sure that the head restraint engages correctly.

Removing

The head restraints cannot be removed.

Memory function

Concept

The following settings can be stored and, if necessary, retrieved using the memory function:

  • Seat position.
  • Exterior mirror position.

General information

Different settings can be assigned to two memory locations.

The adjustment of the lumbar support is not stored.

Safety information

Warning

There is a risk of jamming when moving the seats. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the area of movement of the seat is clear prior to any adjustment.

Warning

Using the memory function while driving can lead to unexpected movements of the seat. Vehicle control could be lost. There is a risk of accident. Only retrieve the memory function when the vehicle is stationary.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Close-up of a black camera control panel with buttons and a grid of buttons (no text or symbols visible)

Storing

  1. Switch on the ignition.
  2. Set the desired position.
  3. SET the button. The LED in the button lights up.
  4. Press the desired button 1 or 2 while the LED is lit. The LED goes out.

Calling up settings

The stored position is called up automatically.

Press the desired button 1 or 2.

The procedure stops when a seat adjustment switch or one of the memory buttons is pressed.

Once underway, adjustment of the seat position on the driver's side is disabled after a short while.

Call up deactivated

After a brief period, calling up stored seat positions is deactivated to save battery power.

To reactivate calling up of a seat position:

  • Open or close the door or tailgate.
  • Press a button on the vehicle key.
  • Press the Start/Stop button.

Mirrors

Exterior mirrors

General information

The mirror on the front passenger side is more curved than the driver's side mirror.

The current exterior mirror position can be stored using the memory function, refer to page 89.

Safety information

Warning

Objects reflected in the mirror are closer than they appear. The distance to the traffic behind could be incorrectly estimated, for instance while changing lanes. There is a risk of accident. Estimate the distance to the traffic behind by looking over your shoulder.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

text_image 1 2 3

1 Adjusting
2 Selecting a mirror, Automatic Curb Monitor
3 Folding in and out

Selecting a mirror

MINI Countryman (2020) - Selecting a mirror - 1

To change over to the other mirror: Slide the switch.

Adjusting electrically

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting electrically - 1

Press the button.

The mirror movement follows the button movement.

Malfunction

In case of an electrical malfunction, adjust the mirror by pressing the edges of the mirror glass.

Folding in and out

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding in and out - 1

NOTICE

Depending on the vehicle width, the vehicle can be damaged in vehicle washes.

There is a risk of damage to property. Before washing, fold in the mirrors by hand or with the button.

MINI Countryman (2020) - NOTICE - 1

Press the button.

Folding is only possible up to a speed of approx. 15 mph/20 km/h.

Folding the mirrors in and out is helpful in the following situations:

  • In vehicle washes.
  • On narrow roads.

Mirrors that were folded in are folded out automatically at a speed of approx.

25 mph/40 km/h.

Automatic heating

Both exterior mirrors are automatically heated as needed and when the ignition is switched on.

Automatic dimming feature

The exterior mirror on the driver's side is automatically dimmed. Photocells in the car's interior mirror, refer to page 92, are used to control this.

Automatic Curb Monitor, exterior mirror

Concept

If reverse gear is engaged, the mirror glass on the front passenger side is tilted downward. This improves your view of the curb and other formatting issue - low-lying obstacles when parking, for instance.

Activating

  1. slide the switch to the driver's side mirror position.

  2. Engage selector lever position R.

Deactivating

Slide the switch to the passenger's side mirror position.

Interior mirror, manually dimmable

Flip lever

MINI Countryman (2020) - Flip lever - 1

natural_image Abstract 3D diagram of a funnel-shaped object with upward arrows indicating flow or movement (no text or symbols)

To reduce the blinding effect of the interior mirror, flip the lever forward.

Turn knob

MINI Countryman (2020) - Turn knob - 1

natural_image 3D diagram of a bowl with a circular button and directional arrows indicating rotation or movement (no text or symbols)

Turn the knob to reduce the blinding effect by the interior mirror.

Interior mirror, automatic dimming feature

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Two black medical or anatomical views of a device, showing internal structures with white arrows pointing to specific areas (no text or symbols present)

Photocells are used for control:

  • In the mirror glass.
  • On the back of the mirror.

Functional requirements

  • Keep the photocells clean.
  • Do not cover the area between the interior mirror and the windshield.

Steering wheel

Safety information

Warning

Steering wheel adjustments while driving can lead to unexpected steering wheel movements. Vehicle control could be lost. There is a risk of accident. Adjusting the steering wheel while the vehicle is stationary only.

Adjusting

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car interior showing a directional control knob with a white arrow pointing to the left side (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Fold the lever down.
  2. Move the steering wheel to the preferred height and angle to suit your seating position.
  3. Fold the lever back up.

Transporting children safely

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for

instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

The right place for children

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Unattended children or animals in the vehicle can cause the vehicle to move and endanger themselves and traffic, for instance due to the following actions:

  • Pressing the Start/Stop button.
  • Releasing the parking brake.
  • Opening and closing the doors or windows.
  • Engaging selector lever position N.
  • Using vehicle equipment.

There is a risk of accidents or injuries. Do not leave children or animals unattended in the vehicle. Take the vehicle key with you when exiting and lock the vehicle.

Always transport children in the rear seat

General information

Accident research shows that the safest place for children is in the rear seat.

Transport children younger than 13 years of age or shorter than 5 ft/150 cm only in the rear seat in suitable child restraint systems designed for the age, weight and size of the child. Children 13 years of age or older must wear a safety belt as soon as a suitable child restraint system can no longer be used due to their age, weight, or size.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

The safety belt cannot be fastened correctly on children shorter than 5 ft, 150 cm without suitable additional child restraint systems. The efficacy of safety gear, including safety belts, can be limited or lost when safety belts are fastened incorrectly. An incorrectly fastened safety belt can cause additional injuries, for instance in the event of an accident or during braking and evasive maneuvers. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Secure children shorter than 5 ft, 150 cm using suitable child restraint systems.

Children on the front passenger seat

General information

Before using a child restraint system on the front passenger seat, ensure that the front, knee, and side airbags on the front passenger side are deactivated. For automatic de-

activation of front-seat passenger airbags, refer to page 148.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Active front-seat passenger airbags can injure a child in a child restraint system when the airbags are activated. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the front-seat passenger airbags are deactivated and that the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator light lights up.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

The stability of the child restraint system is limited or compromised with incorrect seat adjustment or improper installation of the child seat. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Make sure that the child restraint system fits securely against the backrest. If possible, adjust the backrest tilt for all affected backrests and correctly adjust the seats. Make sure that seats and backrests are securely engaged or locked. If possible, adjust the height of the head restraints or remove them.

Installing child restraint systems

General information

Pay attention to the specifications of the child restraint system manufacturer when selecting, installing, and using child restraint systems.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

The protective effect of child restraint systems and their fastening systems which have been damaged or exposed to an accident can be limited or lost. A child cannot be properly restrained in the event of an accident or braking and evasive maneuvers. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life.

Do not use child restraint systems which have been damaged or exposed to an accident.

If a child restraint system and its fastening system has been damaged or exposed to an accident, have these systems checked and replaced by the dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

The stability of the child restraint system is limited or compromised with incorrect seat adjustment or improper installation of the child seat. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Make sure that the child restraint system fits securely against the backrest. If possible, adjust the backrest tilt for all affected backrests and correctly adjust the seats. Make sure that seats and backrests are securely engaged or locked. If possible, adjust the height of the head restraints or remove them.

On the rear seats

If the vehicle is equipped with a sliding rear seat row: move the seats to the rearmost position before mounting a child restraint system.

On the front passenger seat

Deactivating airbags

MINI Countryman (2020) - Deactivating airbags - 1

Warning

Active front-seat passenger airbags can injure a child in a child restraint system when the airbags are activated. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the front-seat passenger airbags are deactivated and that the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator light lights up.

Before installing a child restraint system in the front passenger seat, make sure that the front, knee and side airbags on the front passenger side are deactivated.

Deactivate the front-seat passenger airbags automatically, refer to page 148.

Seat position and height

Before installing a child restraint system, move the front passenger seat as far back as possible and adjust its height to the highest and thus best possible position for the belt and to offer optimal protection in the event of an accident.

If the upper anchorage of the safety belt is located in front of the belt guide of the child seat, move the front passenger seat carefully forward until the best possible belt guide position is reached.

Child seat security

MINI Countryman (2020) - Child seat security - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a car seat with visible seats and driver seat, no text or symbols present.

The rear safety belts and the front passenger safety belt can be permanently locked to fasten child restraint systems.

Locking the safety belt

  1. Pull out the belt strap completely.
  2. Secure the child restraint system with the safety belt.
  3. Allow the belt strap to be pulled in and pull it tight against the child restraint system. The safety belt is locked.

Unlocking the safety belt

  1. Unbuckle the safety belt buckle.
  2. Remove the child restraint system.
  3. Allow the belt strap to be pulled in completely.

In some cases it may be necessary to separate the lower belt attachment. Safety belts, refer to page 85.

LATCH child restraint fixing system

General information

LATCH: Lower Anchors and Tether for Children.

Pay attention to the operating and safety information from the child restraint system

manufacturer when installing and using LATCH child restraint fixing systems.

Mounts for the lower LATCH anchors

The lower anchors may be used to attach the CRS to the vehicle seat up to a combined child and CRS weight of 65 lbs/30 kg when the child is restrained by the internal harnesses.

Safety information

Warning

If the LATCH child restraint fixing systems are not correctly engaged, the protective effect of the LATCH child restraint fixing system can be limited. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Make sure that the lower anchors are securely engaged and that the LATCH child restraint fixing system fits securely against the backrest.

Position

Symbol Meaning

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 1

The corresponding symbol shows the mounts for the lower LATCH anchors.

Seats equipped with lower anchors are marked with a pair, (2), of LATCH symbols. For vehicles equipped with a middle seat:

It is not recommended to use the inner lower anchors of standard outer LATCH positions to fasten a child restraint system on the middle seat. Use the vehicle safety belt instead for the middle seat.

Before installing LATCH child restraint fixing systems

Pull the safety belt away from the area of the child restraint system.

Assembly of LATCH child restraint fixing systems

  1. Install child restraint system, see manufacturer's information.
  2. Ensure that both LATCH anchors are properly connected.

Child restraint systems with tether strap

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

If the upper retaining strap is incorrectly used for the child restraint system, the protective effect can be reduced. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the upper retaining strap does not run over sharp edges and is not twisted as it passes the upper anchor.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

If the rear backrest is not locked, the protective effect of the child restraint system is limited or there is none. In certain situations, for instance braking maneuvers or in case of an accident, the rear backrest can fold forward. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Make sure that the rear backrests are locked.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

NOTICE

The anchors for the upper retaining straps of child restraint systems are only provided for these retaining straps. When other objects are mounted, the anchors can be damaged. There is a risk of damage to property. Only mount child restraint systems to the upper anchors.

Anchors

MINI Countryman (2020) - Anchors - 1

The respective symbol shows the anchor for the upper retaining strap.

Seats with an upper top tether are marked with this symbol. It can be found on the rear seat backrest or the rear window shelf.

Routing the retaining strap

MINI Countryman (2020) - Routing the retaining strap - 1

text_image 1 2 6 3 5 4

1 Direction of travel
2 Head restraint
3 Hook for upper retaining strap
4 Anchor
5 Seat backrest
6 Upper retaining strap

Attaching the upper retaining strap to the anchor

  1. Raise the head restraint, if needed.
  2. On the rear seat: Guide the upper retaining strap between or along both sides of the supports of the head restraint to the anchor.
  3. Attach the hook of the retaining strap to the anchor on the rear seat.
  4. Tighten the retaining strap by pulling it down.

Locking the doors and windows

Doors

MINI Countryman (2020) - Doors - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's side panel showing a double-headed arrow indicating vertical motion (no text or symbols)

Push the locking lever on the rear doors up.

The door can now be opened from the outside only.

Safety switch for the rear

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety switch for the rear - 1

Press the button on the driver's door if children are being transported in the rear.

This locks various functions so that they cannot be operated from the rear: safety switch, refer to page 78.

Driving

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Start/Stop button

Concept

MINI Countryman (2020) - Concept - 1

Pressing the Start/Stop button switches the ignition on or off and starts the engine.

Steptronic transmission: the engine starts in selector lever

position P or N with the brake pedal pressed when you press the Start/Stop button.

Manual transmission: the engine starts with the clutch pedal pressed when the Start/Stop button is pressed.

Ignition on

Manual transmission: press the Start/Stop button without stepping on the clutch pedal.

Steptronic transmission: press the Start/Stop button, but do not press on the brake pedal at the same time.

All vehicle systems are ready for operation. Most of the indicator/warning lights in the instrument cluster light up for a varied length of time.

To save battery power when the engine is off, switch off the ignition and any unnecessary electronic systems/power consumers.

Ignition off

Manual transmission: press the Start/Stop button again without stepping on the clutch pedal.

Steptronic transmission: shift to selector lever position P, press the Start/Stop button again without stepping on the brake.

All indicator lights in the instrument cluster go out.

To save battery power when the engine is off, switch off the ignition and any unnecessary electronic systems/power consumers.

Safety measures

The ignition is switched off automatically in the following situations while the vehicle is stationary and the engine is off:

  • When locking the vehicle, even if the low beams are switched on.
  • Shortly before the battery is discharged completely, so that the engine can still be started. This function is only available when the low beams are switched off.
  • When opening or closing the driver door, if the driver's safety belt is unbuckled and the low beams are switched off.
  • While the driver's safety belt is unbuckled with driver's door open and low beams off.
  • When the front doors are opened if there is no other person sitting in the front seats.

- The low beams switch to parking lights after some minutes of no use.

Steptronic transmission with a tap-operated selector lever, refer to page 116: when switching off the ignition, the selector lever position P is engaged automatically if the selector lever position R, D or M/S is engaged.

Radio-ready state

General information

In the radio-ready state, certain power consumers remain ready for operation.

Activating

With the engine running, press the Start/Stop button.

If the engine is not running and the ignition is switched on: the system automatically activates radio-ready state when the door is opened if the lights are switched off or the daytime running lights are switched on.

Radio-ready state remains active if, for instance the ignition is automatically switched off for the following reasons:

- Opening or closing the driver's door.

- Unfastening of the driver's safety belt.

- When automatically switching from low beams to parking lights.

Switching off automatically

The radio-ready state is switched off automatically in the following situations:

- If the driver's or front passenger door is opened when exiting the vehicle, with the engine switched off manually.

- If the ignition is switched off manually with the Start/Stop button.

- After approx. 8 minutes.

- When the vehicle is locked using the central locking system.

- Shortly before the battery is discharged completely, so that the engine can still be started.

Starting the engine

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

DANGER

If the exhaust pipe is blocked or ventilation is insufficient, harmful exhaust gases can enter into the vehicle. The exhaust gases contain pollutants which are colorless and odorless. In enclosed areas, exhaust gases can also accumulate outside of the vehicle. There is danger to life. Keep the exhaust pipe free and ensure sufficient ventilation.

MINI Countryman (2020) - DANGER - 1

Warning

An unsecured vehicle can begin to move and possibly roll away. There is a risk of accident. Before exiting, secure the vehicle against rolling.

In order to ensure that the vehicle is secured against rolling away, follow the following:

- Set the parking brake.

- On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, turn the front wheels in the direction of the curb.

- On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, also secure the vehicle, for instance with a wheel chock.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

NOTICE

In the case of repeated starting attempts or repeated starting in quick succession, the fuel is not burned or is inadequately burned. The catalytic converter can over-

heat. There is a risk of damage to property. Avoid repeated starting in quick succession.

Gasoline engine

Depending on the motorization, the full drive power may not be available for approximately 30 seconds after starting the engine. In this case, the vehicle will not accelerate as usual.

Steptronic transmission

Starting the engine

  1. Depress the brake pedal.
  2. Engage selector lever position P or N.
  3. Press the Start/Stop button.

The ignition is activated automatically for a brief time and is stopped as soon as the engine starts.

Manual transmission

Starting the engine

  1. Depress the brake pedal.
  2. Press on the clutch pedal and shift to neutral.
  3. Press the Start/Stop button.

The ignition is activated automatically for a brief time and is stopped as soon as the engine starts.

Engine stop

Safety information

Warning

Unattended children or animals in the vehicle can cause the vehicle to move and endanger themselves and traffic, for instance due to the following actions:

  • Pressing the Start/Stop button.
  • Releasing the parking brake.
  • Opening and closing the doors or windows.

- Engaging selector lever position N.

- Using vehicle equipment.

There is a risk of accidents or injuries. Do not leave children or animals unattended in the vehicle. Take the vehicle key with you when exiting and lock the vehicle.

Warning

An unsecured vehicle can begin to move and possibly roll away. There is a risk of accident. Before exiting, secure the vehicle against rolling.

In order to ensure that the vehicle is secured against rolling away, follow the following:

  • Set the parking brake.
  • On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, turn the front wheels in the direction of the curb.
  • On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, also secure the vehicle, for instance with a wheel chock.

Steptronic transmission

Switching off the engine

  1. When the vehicle is stationary, apply the parking brake.
  2. Engage selector lever position P.
  3. Press the Start/Stop button.
    The engine is switched off.
    The radio-ready state is switched on.

Manual transmission

Switching off the engine

  1. With the vehicle at a standstill, press the Start/Stop button.
    The engine is switched off.
    The radio-ready state is switched on.

  2. Shift into first gear or reverse.

  3. Set the parking brake.

Auto Start/Stop function

Concept

The Auto Start/Stop function helps save fuel. The system switches off the engine during a stop, for instance in traffic congestion or at traffic lights. The ignition remains switched on. The engine starts automatically for driving off.

After each engine start using the Start/Stop button, the Auto Start/Stop function is ready and is activated at speeds faster than about 3 mph/5 km/h.

Depending on the selected driving mode, refer to page 168, the system is automatically activated or deactivated.

Engine stop

Functional requirements

The engine is switched off automatically during a stop under the following conditions:

Manual transmission:

  • Neutral is engaged and the clutch pedal is not pressed.
  • The driver's safety belt is buckled or the driver's door is closed.

Steptronic transmission:

  • The selector lever is in selector lever position D.
  • The brake pedal remains depressed while the vehicle is stopped.
  • The driver's safety belt is buckled or the driver's door is closed.

In order to be able to release the brake pedal, engage the selector lever in position P. The engine remains off.

To continue driving depress the brake pedal. When a gear is engaged, the engine starts automatically.

The air flow from the air conditioner is reduced when the engine is switched off.

Steptronic transmission: manual engine stop

Depending on the vehicle equipment and country version, the engine can be switched off manually, if the engine was not switched off automatically when the vehicle stopped:

- Press the brake pedal forcefully again from the current pedal position.

- Engage selector lever position P.

If all functional preconditions are fulfilled, the engine switches off.

Displays in the instrument cluster

MINI Countryman (2020) - Displays in the instrument cluster - 1

The display indicates that the Auto Start/Stop function is ready for an Automatic engine start.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Displays in the instrument cluster - 2

The display indicates that the conditions for an automatic engine stop have not been met.

Functional limitations

The engine is not switched off automatically in the following situations:

  • External temperature too low.
  • The external temperature is high and automatic climate control is running.
  • The car's interior has not yet been heated or cooled to the required level.
  • The engine is not yet at operating temperature.
  • The wheels are at a sharp angle or the steering wheel is being turned.
  • After driving in reverse.
  • Fogging of the windows when the automatic climate control is switched on.
  • The vehicle battery charge is very low.
  • At higher elevations.
  • The hood is unlocked.
  • The parking assistant is activated.
  • Stop-and-go traffic.
  • Selector lever in selector lever position R, N or M/S.

Starting the engine

The engine starts automatically under the following conditions:

- Manual transmission: clutch pedal is pressed.

- Steptronic transmission: by releasing the brake pedal.

After the engine starts, accelerate as usual.

Safety mode

After the engine switches off automatically, it will not start again automatically if any one of the following conditions are met:

  • The driver's safety belt is unbuckled and the driver's door is open.
  • The hood was unlocked.

Some indicator lights light up for a varied length of time.

The engine can only be started via the Start/Stop button.

Functional limitations

Even if driving off was not intended, the deactivated engine starts up automatically in the following situations:

  • Excessive warming of the car's interior when the air conditioning is switched on.
  • The steering wheel is turned.
  • Steptronic transmission: change from selector lever position D to R, N or M/S.
  • Steptronic transmission: change from selector lever position P to R, N, D or M/S.
  • The vehicle begins rolling.
  • Fogging of the windows when the automatic climate control is switched on.
  • The vehicle battery charge is very low.
  • Excessive cooling of the car's interior when the heating is switched on.
  • Manual transmission: low brake vacuum pressure; this can occur, for instance if the brake pedal is depressed a number of times in succession.

Intelligent Auto Start/Stop function

Depending on the vehicle equipment and country-specific version, the vehicle features a variety of sensors for assessing the traffic situation. The Intelligent Auto Start/Stop function uses this information to adapt to various traffic situations in a proactive manner.

For instance, this applies to the following situations:

  • If a situation is detected in which the stopping time is expected to be very short, the engine is not switched off automatically. A message appears on the Control Display, depending on the situation.
  • If a situation is detected in which the vehicle needs to drive off immediately, the engine is started automatically.

The function may be restricted if the navigation data is invalid, outdated or not available, for example.

Switching the system on/off

Using the button
MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching the system on/off - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's front dashboard with multiple white buttons and a central white object (no text or symbols visible)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching the system on/off - 2

Press the button.

- LED comes on: auto Start/Stop function is deactivated.

The engine is started during an automatic engine stop.

The engine can only be stopped or started via the Start/Stop button.

- LED goes out: auto Start/Stop function is activated.

Switching off the vehicle during an automatic engine stop

During an automatic engine stop, the vehicle can be switched off permanently, for instance when leaving it.

Steptronic transmission:

  1. Engage selector lever position P.
  2. Press the Start/Stop button. The ignition is switched off. The Auto Start/Stop function is deactivated.
  3. Set the parking brake.

Manual transmission:

  1. Press the Start/Stop button. The ignition is switched off. The Auto Start/Stop function is deactivated.
  2. Shift into first gear or reverse.
  3. Set the parking brake.

Engine start as usual via Start/Stop button.

Automatic deactivation

In certain situations, the Auto Start/Stop function is deactivated automatically for safety reasons, for instance if no driver is detected.

Malfunction

The Auto Start/Stop function no longer switches off the engine automatically. A Check Control message is displayed. It is possible to continue driving. Have the system checked by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Parking brake

Concept

The parking brake is used to prevent the vehicle from rolling when it is parked.

Safety information

Warning

An unsecured vehicle can begin to move and possibly roll away. There is a risk of accident. Before exiting, secure the vehicle against rolling.

In order to ensure that the vehicle is secured against rolling away, follow the following:

  • Set the parking brake.
  • On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, turn the front wheels in the direction of the curb.
  • On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, also secure the vehicle, for instance with a wheel chock.

Warning

Unattended children or animals in the vehicle can cause the vehicle to move and endanger themselves and traffic, for instance due to the following actions:

  • Pressing the Start/Stop button.
  • Releasing the parking brake.
  • Opening and closing the doors or windows.
  • Engaging selector lever position N.
  • Using vehicle equipment.

There is a risk of accidents or injuries. Do not leave children or animals unattended in the vehicle. Take the vehicle key with you when exiting and lock the vehicle.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with control buttons and vent slots (no visible text or symbols)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 2

Parking brake

Setting

With a stationary vehicle

MINI Countryman (2020) - With a stationary vehicle - 1

Pull the switch. The LED lights up.

MINI Countryman (2020) - With a stationary vehicle - 2

The indicator light lights up red. The parking brake is set.

Depending on the stopping situation, the parking brake is engaged automatically.

Steptronic transmission: in some parking situations, the parking brake is automatically engaged, when selector lever position P is engaged. In these cases, the parking brake is released automatically when you leave the selector lever position P.

While driving

To use as emergency brake while driving: Pull the switch and hold it. The vehicle brakes hard while the switch is being pulled.

MINI Countryman (2020) - While driving - 1

The indicator light lights up red, a signal sounds and the brake lights light up.

A Check Control message is displayed.

If the vehicle is decelerated to a complete stop, the parking brake is engaged.

Releasing

Releasing manually

  1. Switch on the ignition.

  2. Iual transmission: press the switch while the brake pedal is pressed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Releasing manually - 1

Steptronic transmission: press the ch while the brake is pressed or se- or lever position P is set.

The LED and indicator light go out. The parking brake is released.

Automatic release in cars with Steptronic transmission

For automatic release, step on the accelerator pedal.

The LED and indicator light go out.

The parking brake is automatically released when you step on the accelerator under the following conditions:

  • Engine on.
  • Drive mode engaged.
  • Driver buckled in and doors closed.

Automatic release in cars with manual transmission

Drive off as usual. The parking brake disengages when the clutch pedal is released.

The LED and indicator light go out.

Under the following conditions, the parking brake is automatically released:

  • Engine on.
  • Gear engaged.
    – Driver buckled in and doors closed.
  • Engine power is sufficient to drive off.

Malfunction

If the parking brake fails or malfunctions, secure the vehicle against rolling before exiting.

A Check Control message is displayed.

Secure the vehicle against rolling away, for instance with a wheel chock, after existing the vehicle.

After a power failure

Re-activating the parking brake

  1. Switch on the ignition.

  2. P is the switch while stepping on the brake pedal or selector lever position P is set.

It may take several seconds for the brake to be reactivated. Some mechanical sounds associated with this process are normal.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Re-activating the parking brake - 1

The indicator light in the instrument cluster goes out as soon as the parking brake is ready for operation.

Turn signal, high beams, head-light flasher

Turn signal

Using turn signals

MINI Countryman (2020) - Using turn signals - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a vehicle's left side with a cylindrical component and directional arrows indicating motion (no text or symbols)

Press the lever past the resistance point.

Canada: the lever returns into its starting position after actuation. To switch off manually, slightly tap the lever to the resistance point.

Triple turn signal activation

Lightly tap the lever up or down.

The triple turn signal duration can be adjusted.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. "Lighting"
  4. "Exterior lighting"
  5. "One-touch turn signal"
  6. Select the desired setting.

Settings are stored for the profile currently used.

Signaling briefly

Press the lever to the resistance point and hold it there for as long as you want the turn signal to flash.

Malfunction

Unusually rapid flashing of the indicator light indicates that a turn signal bulb has failed.

High beams, headlight flasher

Push the lever forward or pull it backward.

MINI Countryman (2020) - High beams, headlight flasher - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with directional arrows indicating left and right control buttons (no text or symbols)

- High beams on, arrow 1. The high beams light up when the low beams are switched on. - High beams off/headlight flasher, arrow 2.

Wiper system

General information

Do not use the wipers if the windshield is dry, as this may damage the wiper blades or cause them to become worn more quickly.

Safety information

Warning

If the wipers start moving in the folded away state, body parts can be jammed or damage may occur to parts of the vehicle. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the vehicle is switched off when the wipers are in the folded away state and the wipers are folded in when switching on.

NOTICE

If the wipers are frozen to the windshield, the wiper blades can be torn off and the wiper motor can overheat when switching on. There is a risk of damage to property.

Defrost the windshield prior to switching the wipers on.

Switching on

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 1

text_image Car interior control panel with numbered directional arrows indicating vehicle positions or movement

Press the lever up until the desired position is reached.

  • Resting position of the wipers, position 0.
  • Intermittent operation or rain sensor, position 1.
  • Normal wiper speed, position 2.
  • Fast wiper speed, position 3.

When travel is interrupted with the wiper system switched on: when travel continues, the wipers resume at their previous speed.

Switching off and brief wipe

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching off and brief wipe - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and directional arrow (no text or symbols)

Press the lever down.

  • Switching off: press the lever down until it reaches its standard position.
  • Brief wipe: press the lever down from the standard position.

The lever automatically returns to its initial position when released.

Interval mode or rain sensor

Concept

The rain sensor automatically controls the time between wipes depending on the intensity of the rainfall.

General information

The sensor is located on the windshield, directly in front of the interior mirror. Without the rain sensor, the frequency of the wiper operation is preset.

Safety information

NOTICE

If the rain sensor is activated, the wipers can accidentally start moving in vehicle washes. There is a risk of damage to property. Deactivate the rain sensor in vehicle washes.

Activating

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating - 1

text_image Car interior control panel with numbered directional arrows indicating vehicle positions or movement

Press the lever up once from its standard position, arrow 1.

Wiping is started.

The LED in the wiper lever is illuminated.

In frosty conditions, wiper operation may not start.

Deactivating

Press the lever back into the standard position.

Setting the frequency or sensitivity of the rain sensor

MINI Countryman (2020) - Setting the frequency or sensitivity of the rain sensor - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and directional arrow (no text or symbols)

Turn the thumbwheel.

With deactivated rain sensor: set the interval.

With activated rain sensor: set the rain sensor sensitivity.

Up: short interval or high sensitivity of the rain sensor.

Down: long interval or low sensitivity of the rain sensor.

Windshield washer system

Safety information

Warning

The washer fluid can freeze onto the window at low temperatures and obstruct the view. There is a risk of accident. Only use the washer systems, if the washer fluid cannot freeze. Use washer fluid with anti-freeze, if needed.

NOTICE

When the washer fluid reservoir is empty, the wash pump cannot work as intended. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not use the washer system when the washer fluid reservoir is empty.

Cleaning the windshield

MINI Countryman (2020) - Cleaning the windshield - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and air vent (no visible text or symbols)

Pull the lever.

The system sprays washer fluid on the windshield and activates the wipers briefly.

Windshield washer nozzles

The washer jets are automatically heated whenever the ignition is switched on.

Rear window wiper

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with three circular arrows indicating clockwise rotation (no text or symbols)

Switching on

Turn the outer switch upward.

- Resting position of the wiper, position 0.

- Intermittent mode, arrow 1. When reverse gear is engaged, the system switches to continuous operation.

Clean the rear window

Turn the outer switch in the desired direction.

- In resting position: turn the switch downward, arrow 3. The switch automatically returns to its idle position when released.

- In intermittent mode: turn the switch further, arrow 2. The switch automatically returns to its interval position when released.

The function is deactivated if the washer fluid reservoir level is low.

Fold-away position of the wipers

Concept

The fold-away position enables the wipers to be folded away from the windshield.

General information

Helpful when changing the wiper blades or under frosty conditions, for instance.

Safety information

Warning

If the wipers start moving in the folded away state, body parts can be jammed or damage may occur to parts of the vehicle. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the vehicle is switched off when the wipers are in the folded away state and the wipers are folded in when switching on.

NOTICE

If the wipers are frozen to the windshield, the wiper blades can be torn off and the wiper motor can overheat when switching on. There is a risk of damage to property. Defrost the windshield prior to switching the wipers on.

Folding away the wipers

  1. Switch the ignition on and off again.
  2. Press and hold the wiper lever down, until the wipers stop in a close to vertical position.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding away the wipers - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and directional arrow (no text or symbols)
  1. Fold the wipers all the way away from the windshield.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding away the wipers - 2

natural_image Close-up of a car's front window with white arrows pointing to the side panels (no text or symbols visible)

Folding down the wipers

After the wipers are folded back down, the wiper system must be reactivated.

  1. Fold the wipers back down onto the windshield.
  2. Switch on the ignition.

  3. Push wiper lever down. Wipers return to their resting position and are ready again for operation.

Canada: wiper system

General information

Do not use the wipers if the windshield is dry, as this may damage the wiper blades or cause them to become worn more quickly.

Safety information

Warning

If the wipers start moving in the folded away state, body parts can be jammed or damage may occur to parts of the vehicle. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the vehicle is switched off when the wipers are in the folded away state and the wipers are folded in when switching on.

NOTICE

If the wipers are frozen to the windshield, the wiper blades can be torn off and the wiper motor can overheat when switching on. There is a risk of damage to property. Defrost the windshield prior to switching the wipers on.

Switching on

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel, air vent, and directional arrow (no text or symbols)

Tap up the lever or press it past the resistance point.

  • Normal wiper speed: tap up once.
  • Fast wiper speed: tap up twice or tap once beyond the resistance point.

The lever automatically returns to its initial position when released.

Switching off and brief wipe

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching off and brief wipe - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and directional arrow (no text or symbols)

Press the lever down.

  • To switch off from fast wiper speed: press down twice.
  • To switch off from normal wiper speed: press down once.
  • Brief wipe: press down once.

The lever automatically returns to its initial position when released.

Interval mode or rain sensor

Concept

The rain sensor automatically controls the time between wipes depending on the intensity of the rainfall.

General information

The sensor is located on the windshield, directly in front of the interior mirror. Without the rain sensor, the frequency of the wiper operation is preset.

Safety information

NOTICE

If the rain sensor is activated, the wipers can accidentally start moving in vehicle washes. There is a risk of damage to property. Deactivate the rain sensor in vehicle washes.

Activating/deactivating

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating/deactivating - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with a white connector and a directional arrow pointing to the left side (no visible text or symbols)

Press the button on the wiper lever.

Wiping is started.

The LED in the wiper lever is illuminated.

In frosty conditions, wiper operation may not start.

If a journey is interrupted with the rain sensor switched on: if the trip is resumed within approx. 15 minutes, the rain sensor is automatically activated again.

Setting the frequency or sensitivity of the rain sensor

MINI Countryman (2020) - Setting the frequency or sensitivity of the rain sensor - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel, air vent, and control panel (no visible text or symbols)

Turn the thumbwheel.

With deactivated rain sensor: set the interval.

With activated rain sensor: set the rain sensor sensitivity.

Up: short interval or high sensitivity of the rain sensor.

Down: long interval or low sensitivity of the rain sensor.

Windshield washer system

Safety information

Warning

The washer fluid can freeze onto the window at low temperatures and obstruct the view. There is a risk of accident. Only use the washer systems, if the washer fluid cannot freeze. Use washer fluid with anti-freeze, if needed.

NOTICE

When the washer fluid reservoir is empty, the wash pump cannot work as intended. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not use the washer system when the washer fluid reservoir is empty.

Cleaning the windshield

MINI Countryman (2020) - Cleaning the windshield - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and air vent (no visible text or symbols)

Pull the lever.

The system sprays washer fluid on the windshield and activates the wipers briefly.

Windshield washer nozzles

The washer jets are automatically heated whenever the ignition is switched on.

Rear window wiper

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car interior showing a rotary switch mechanism with numbered arrows (0, 1, 2, 3) indicating clockwise motion (no text or symbols on the diagram itself)

Switching on

Turn the outer switch upward.

  • Resting position of the wiper, position 0.
  • Intermittent mode, arrow 1. When reverse gear is engaged, the system switches to continuous operation.

Clean the rear window

Turn the outer switch in the desired direction.

  • In resting position: turn the switch downward, arrow 3. The switch automatically returns to its idle position when released.
  • In intermittent mode: turn the switch further, arrow 2. The switch automatically returns to its interval position when released.

The function is deactivated if the washer fluid reservoir level is low.

Fold-away position of the wipers

Concept

The fold-away position enables the wipers to be folded away from the windshield.

General information

Helpful when changing the wiper blades or under frosty conditions, for instance.

Safety information

Warning

If the wipers start moving in the folded away state, body parts can be jammed or damage may occur to parts of the vehicle. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the vehicle is switched off when the wipers are in the folded away state and the wipers are folded in when switching on.

NOTICE

If the wipers are frozen to the windshield, the wiper blades can be torn off and the wiper motor can overheat when switching on. There is a risk of damage to property. Defrost the windshield prior to switching the wipers on.

Folding away the wipers

  1. Switch the ignition on and off again.
  2. Press the wiper lever up past the point of resistance and hold it for approx. 3 seconds, until the wipers remain in a nearly vertical position.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding away the wipers - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and directional arrow (no text or symbols)
  1. Fold the wipers all the way away from the windshield.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding away the wipers - 2

natural_image Close-up of a car's side profile showing two white arrows pointing left, one with a curved arrow and the other with a straight arrow (no text or symbols)

Folding down the wipers

After the wipers are folded back down, the wiper system must be reactivated.

  1. Fold the wipers back down onto the windshield.
  2. Switch on the ignition.
  3. Push wiper lever down. Wipers return to their resting position and are ready again for operation.

Washer fluid

General information

All washer nozzles are supplied from one reservoir.

Use a mixture of tap water and windshield washer concentrate. If desired, a windshield washer concentrate containing antifreeze can be used.

Recommended minimum fill quantity: 0.2 US gal/1 liter.

Safety information

Warning

Some antifreeze agents can contain harmful substances and are flammable. There is a risk of fire and a risk of injury. Follow the instructions on the containers. Keep antifreeze away from ignition sources. Do not refill operating materials into different bottles. Store operating materials out of reach of children.

United States: the washer fluid mixture ratio is regulated by the U.S. EPA and many individual states; do not exceed the allowable washer fluid dilution ratio limits that apply. Follow the usage instructions on the washer fluid container.

Use of BMW's Windshield Washer Concentrate or the equivalent is recommended.

Warning

Washer fluid can ignite and catch fire on contact with hot engine parts. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Only add washer fluid when the engine is cooled down. Next, fully close the lid of the washer fluid reservoir.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

NOTICE

Silicon-containing additives in the washer fluid for the water-repelling effect on the windows can lead to damage to the washing system. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not add silicon-containing additives to the washer fluid.

MINI Countryman (2020) - NOTICE - 1

NOTICE

Mixing different windshield washer concentrates or antifreeze can damage the washing system. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not mix different windshield washer concentrates or antifreeze. Follow the information and mixing ratios provided on the containers.

Overview
MINI Countryman (2020) - NOTICE - 1

natural_image Close-up of a white circular warning sign with a stylized bridge and warning symbol, mounted on a mechanical device (no readable text)

The washer fluid reservoir is located in the engine compartment.

Malfunction

The use of undiluted windshield washer concentrate or alcohol-based antifreeze can lead to incorrect readings at temperatures below +5 °F/-15 °C.

Manual transmission

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

An unsecured vehicle can begin to move and possibly roll away. There is a risk of accident. Before exiting, secure the vehicle against rolling.

In order to ensure that the vehicle is secured against rolling away, follow the following:

  • Set the parking brake.
  • On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, turn the front wheels in the direction of the curb.
  • On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, also secure the vehicle, for instance with a wheel chock.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

NOTICE

When shifting to a lower gear, excessive speeds can damage the engine. There is a risk of damage to property. When shifting into 5th or 6th gear, press the gearshift lever to the right.

Schematic diagram
MINI Countryman (2020) - NOTICE - 1

text_image R 1 3 5 2 4 6

- 1 - 6: forward gears

- R: reverse

Shifting

General information

Depending on the engine installation, the engine speed during a shifting operation is adjusted automatically as required for harmonious and dynamic gear shifting.

Reverse gear

Select only when the vehicle is stationary.

To overcome the resistance push the gear-shift lever dynamically to the left and engage reverse gear with a forward shifting movement.

Rolling or pushing the vehicle

In some situations, the vehicle is to roll without its own power, for instance in a vehicle wash, or be pushed.

  1. Switch on the ignition.
  2. Press on the clutch pedal and shift out of a forward gear or reverse.
  3. Release the parking brake.

Steptronic transmission

Concept

The Steptronic transmission combines the functions of an automatic transmission with the possibility of manual shifting, if needed.

Safety information

Warning

An unsecured vehicle can begin to move and possibly roll away. There is a risk of accident. Before exiting, secure the vehicle against rolling.

In order to ensure that the vehicle is secured against rolling away, follow the following:

  • Set the parking brake.
  • On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, turn the front wheels in the direction of the curb.
  • On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, also secure the vehicle, for instance with a wheel chock.

Selector lever version

General information

Depending on the vehicle equipment, a transmission with either a latching selector lever or a tap-operated selector lever is installed.

Transmission with a latching selector lever

MINI Countryman (2020) - Transmission with a latching selector lever - 1

text_image P R N D

The selector lever positions P, R, N, and D are selected by moving the selector lever into the respective selector lever position. The selector lever engages in the selector lever positions.

Transmission with a tap-operated selector lever

MINI Countryman (2020) - Transmission with a tap-operated selector lever - 1

text_image A B C D E F

The selector lever positions P, R, N, and D are selected by tapping the selector lever forward or back. The selector lever automatically returns to the center position when released.

Selector lever position P is engaged automatically, refer to page 117, in certain situations.

Selector lever positions

Drive mode D

Selector lever position for normal vehicle operation. All gears for forward travel are activated automatically.

R is reverse

Engage selector lever position R only when the vehicle is stationary.

Neutral N

The vehicle may be pushed or roll without engine power in selector lever position N, for instance in vehicle washes, refer to page 119.

Parking position P

General information

Selector lever position, for instance for parking the vehicle.

The transmission blocks the drive wheels in selector lever position P.

Engage selector lever position P only when the vehicle is stationary.

Before exiting the vehicle, make sure that selector lever position P is set. Otherwise, the vehicle may begin to move.

Automatic parking position for a transmission with a tap-operated selector lever

Selector lever position P is engaged automatically in situations such as the following:

  • After the engine is switched off when the vehicle is in the radio-ready state, refer to page 100, or when the ignition is switched off, refer to page 99, while selector lever position R, D or M/S is engaged.
  • If the driver's safety belt is unbuckled, the driver's door is opened, and the brake pedal is not pressed while the vehicle is stationary and selector lever position D, M/S or R is engaged.
  • After the ignition has been switched off while selector lever position N is engaged.

Engaging selector lever positions: with a latching selector lever

General information

To prevent the vehicle from creeping after you select a drive mode, maintain pressure on the brake pedal until you are ready to start.

Functional requirements

The selector lever can only be taken out of selector lever position P if the ignition is on or the engine is running.

Engaging selector lever position D, N, R, or P

With the vehicle stationary, depress the brake pedal before shifting out of selector lever position P or N; otherwise, the shift block will not be deactivated and the shift command will not be executed.

A selector lever lock prevents the following faulty operation:

  • Unintentional shifting into selector lever position P or R.
  • Unintentional shifting from selector lever position P into another selector lever position.
  • To release the selector lever lock: with the brake pedal depressed, press the button on the front of the selector lever.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Engaging selector lever position D, N, R, or P - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car gear shift lever showing the shaft and keyway (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Move the selector lever into the desired position.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Engaging selector lever position D, N, R, or P - 2

text_image P R N D

Engaging selector lever positions: with a tap-operated selector lever

General information

To prevent the vehicle from creeping after you select a drive mode, maintain pressure on the brake pedal until you are ready to start.

Functional requirements

Only when the brake pedal is depressed is it possible to change from selector lever position P to another selector lever position.

Depending on the transmission version, the engine may have to be running too.

The selection lever position P cannot be changed until all technical requirements are met.

Engaging selector lever position D, N, R

A selector lever lock prevents the following faulty operation:

  • Unintentional shifting into selector lever position R.
  • Unintentional shifting from selector lever position P into another selector lever position.

  • Press and hold the button to release the selector lever lock.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Engaging selector lever position D, N, R - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car gear shift lever with a white arrow pointing to the mode (no visible text or symbols)
  1. With the driver's safety belt fastened, briefly push the selector lever in the desired direction, past a resistance point,

if needed. The selector lever automatically returns to the center position when released.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Engaging selector lever position D, N, R - 2

text_image R N N D

Engaging selector lever position P
MINI Countryman (2020) - Engaging selector lever position D, N, R - 3

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical gear shift lever with a white arrow pointing to the shaft (no visible text or symbols)

Press button P.

Rolling or pushing the vehicle

General information

In some situations, the vehicle is to roll without its own power for a short distance, for instance in a vehicle wash, or be pushed.

Engaging selector lever position N: with a latching selector lever

  1. Switch on the ignition.
  2. If necessary, release the parking brake.
  3. Depress the brake pedal.
  4. Touch the selector lever lock and engage selector lever position N.
  5. Release brake.

The vehicle can roll.

If there is a malfunction, you may not be able to change the selector lever position. Manually unlock the transmission lock, if needed, refer to page 122.

Engaging selector lever position N: with a tap-operated selector lever

  1. Start the engine while pressing on the brake pedal.
  2. If necessary, release the parking brake.
  3. Depress the brake pedal.
  4. Touch the selector lever lock and engage selector lever position N.
  5. Switch the engine off.

In this way, the ignition remains switched on, and a Check-Control message is displayed.

The vehicle can roll.

NOTICE

Selector lever position P is automatically engaged when the ignition is switched off. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not switch ignition off in vehicle washes.

Irrespective of the ignition, the selector lever position P is automatically engaged after approx. 15 minutes.

If there is a malfunction, you may not be able to change the selector lever position. Electronically unlock the transmission lock, if needed, refer to page 122.

Kickdown

Kickdown is used to achieve maximum driving performance. Step on the accelerator pedal beyond the resistance point at the full throttle position.

Sport program M/S

Concept

The shifting points and shifting times in the Sport program are designed for a sportier driving style. The transmission, for instance shifts up later and the shifting times are shorter.

Activating the Sport program

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating the Sport program - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car gear shift lever mechanism with a white arrow pointing to the shaft (no text or symbols visible)

Press the selector lever to the left from selector lever position D.

The engaged gear is displayed in the instrument cluster, for instance S1.

The sport program of the transmission is activated.

Ending the Sport program

Push the selector lever to the right.

D is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Manual mode M/S

Concept

Manual gear-shifting is possible in manual mode.

Activating manual mode

  1. Press the selector lever to the left from selector lever position D, arrow 1.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating manual mode - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car gear shift lever mechanism (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Push the selector lever forward or pull it backward, arrows 2.

Manual mode M/S becomes active and the gear is changed.

The engaged gear is displayed in the instrument cluster, for instance M1.

Shifting

  • To shift down: press the selector lever forward.
  • To shift up: pull the selector lever rearwards.

The Steptronic transmission continues shifting automatically in certain situations, for instance when certain engine speed limits are reached.

With a tap-operated selector lever: when M2 is set manually while the vehicle is stationary, the transmission will no longer shift back to M1. This shifting behavior is retained until you engage M1 manually or exit M.

Avoiding automatic upshifting

Once a particular engine speed is attained, M/S manual mode is automatically upshifted as needed.

MINI John Cooper Works: once particular engine speeds are attained, upshifting is not

automatically performed in M/S manual mode.

For vehicles with Steptronic Sport transmission, automatic shift operations are not performed if one of the following conditions is met:

  • DSC is deactivated.
  • TRACTION is activated.

In addition, there is no downshifting for kickdown.

With the appropriate transmission version, the lowest possible gear can be selected by simultaneously activating kickdown and operating the left shift paddles. This is not possible by switching briefly via the shift paddles from selector lever position D to manual mode M/S.

Ending the manual mode

Push the selector lever to the right.

D is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Shift paddles for Steptronic Sport transmission

Concept

The shift paddles on the steering wheel allow you to shift gears quickly while keeping both hands on the steering wheel.

General information

Shifting

Gears will only be shifted at appropriate engine and road speeds, for instance down-shifting is not possible if the engine speed is too high.

Short-term manual mode

In selector lever position D, actuating a shift paddle switches into manual mode temporarily.

After conservative driving in manual mode without acceleration or shifting via the shift paddles for a certain amount of time, the transmission switches back to automatic mode.

It is possible to switch into automatic mode as follows:

  • Pull and hold right shift paddle.
  • In addition to the briefly pulled right shift paddle, briefly pull the left shift paddle.

Continuous manual mode

In selector lever position S, actuating a shift paddle switches into manual mode permanently.

Shifting

MINI Countryman (2020) - Shifting - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with the Mini wheel and steering wheel (no text or symbols visible)
  • To shift up: briefly pull right shift paddle.
  • To shift down: briefly pull left shift paddle.
  • The lowest possible gear can be selected by pulling and holding the left shift paddle.

The selected gear is briefly displayed in the instrument cluster, followed by the current gear.

Displays in the instrument cluster

MINI Countryman (2020) - Displays in the instrument cluster - 1

The selector lever position is displayed, for example P.

Releasing the transmission lock manually: with a latching selector lever

If the selector lever is locked in selector lever position P despite the ignition being switched on, the brake pedal being depressed and the button on the selector lever being pressed, the transmission lock can be unlocked manually:

Before unlocking the transmission lock manually, set the parking brake to prevent the vehicle from rolling away.

  1. Loosen the selector lever sleeve, together with the lower retaining ring, from the center console. To do so, pull the retaining ring upward at the rear edge.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Releasing the transmission lock manually: with a latching selector lever - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's head and dashboard with a circular button labeled 'U' and an upward arrow symbol (no text or numbers present)
  1. Lift the sleeve. Unplug the cable connector, if needed.
  2. Using the screwdriver from the onboard vehicle tool kit, refer to page 300, press

the yellow release lever downward, see arrow.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Releasing the transmission lock manually: with a latching selector lever - 2

natural_image Close-up of a car interior showing a mechanical component with a white arrow pointing to a specific area (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Press the button on the front of the selector lever and move the selector lever back slightly.

Release the release lever.

  1. Bring the selector lever into the desired position.

For additional information, see the chapter on tow-starting and towing.

Releasing the transmission lock electronically: with a tap-operated selector lever

General information

Electronically unlock the transmission lock to maneuver vehicle from a danger area.

Before unlocking the transmission lock, set the parking brake to prevent the vehicle from rolling away.

Engaging selector lever position N

Unlocking is possible, if the starter can spin the engine.

  1. Press and hold down brake pedal.
  2. Press the Start/Stop button. The starter must audibly start.
  3. Press the button on the selector lever, arrow 1, and press and hold the selector lever into selector lever position N, ar-

row N, until selector lever position N is displayed in the instrument cluster.

A Check Control message is displayed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Engaging selector lever position N - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car gear shift lever with labeled parts (no readable text or symbols)
  1. Release the selector lever.
  2. Release brake, as soon as the starter stops.
  3. Maneuver the vehicle from the danger area and secure it against moving on its own.

For additional information, see the chapter on tow-starting and towing.

Steptronic Sport transmission: Launch Control

Concept

Launch Control enables optimum acceleration on surfaces with good traction under dry surrounding conditions.

General information

The use of Launch Control causes premature component wear since this function represents a very heavy load for the vehicle.

Do not use Launch Control during the break-in, refer to page 222, period.

Do not turn the steering wheel when driving away with Launch Control.

Functional requirements

Launch Control is available as soon as the engine and transmission are at operating temperature.

Depending on the external temperature and driving style, the engine and transmission require an interrupted trip of up to 30 miles/50 km in order to reach the operating temperature needed for Launch Control.

Start with launch control

While the engine is running:

  1. The OFF button and select SPORT with the MINI Driving Modes switch. The instrument cluster displays TRACTION in combination with SPORT. The DSC OFF indicator light lights up.

  2. Engage selector lever position S.

  3. With the left foot, forcefully press down on the brake.
  4. Step on the accelerator pedal beyond the resistance point at the full throttle position, kickdown.

A flag symbol is displayed in the instrument cluster.

  1. The starting engine speed adjusts. Within 3 seconds, release the brake.

Repeated use during a trip

After Launch Control has been used, the transmission must cool down for approx. 5 minutes before Launch Control can be used again.

After using Launch Control

To increase vehicle stability, activate DSC Dynamic Stability Control again.

System limits

An experienced driver may be able to achieve better acceleration values in DSC OFF mode.

Displays

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for

instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Instrument cluster

Overview
MINI Countryman (2020) - Instrument cluster - 1

text_image 1 2 3 2 4 OFF 6 5 0 1/2

1 Tachometer 129
2 Indicator/warning lights
3 Speedometer

4 Fuel gauge 129
5 Display/reset miles 129
6 Electronic displays 125

Electronic displays

MINI Countryman (2020) - Electronic displays - 1

text_image 1 2 3

1 Driver assistance systems

Messages, for instance Check Control

Time 130

External temperature 130

Selection lists 134

Total miles/trip odometer 129

Onboard Computer 134

2 Selector lever position 116

Gear shift indicator 132

3 MINI Driving Modes switch status 168

Check Control

Concept

The Check Control system monitors functions in the vehicle and notifies you of malfunctions in the monitored systems.

General information

A Check Control message is displayed as a combination of indicator or warning lights and text messages in the instrument cluster.

In addition, an acoustic signal may be output and a SMS text message may appear on the Control Display.

Indicator/warning lights

General information

The indicator/warning lights can light up in a variety of combinations and colors.

Several of the lights are checked for proper functioning and light up temporarily when the engine is started or the ignition is switched on.

Red lights

Safety belt reminder

Indicator light flashes or is illuminated: safety belt on the driver or passenger side is not buckled. The safety belt reminder can also be activated if objects are placed on the front passenger seat.

Make sure that the safety belts are positioned correctly.

Airbag system

MINI Countryman (2020) - Airbag system - 1

Airbag system and belt tensioner may not be working.

Have the vehicle checked immediately by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Parking brake

MINI Countryman (2020) - Parking brake - 1

The parking brake is set.

For releasing the parking brake, refer to page 106.

Brake system

MINI Countryman (2020) - Brake system - 1

Braking system impaired. Continue to drive moderately.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Brake system - 2

Have the vehicle checked immediately by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Approach control warning

MINI Countryman (2020) - Approach control warning - 1

Indicator light illuminates: advance warning is issued, for example when there is the impending danger of a

collision or the distance to the vehicle ahead is too small.

Increase the distance.

Indicator light flashes: acute warning of the imminent danger of a collision when the vehicle approaches another vehicle at a relatively high differential speed.

Intervene by braking or make an evasive maneuver.

Person warning

MINI Countryman (2020) - Person warning - 1

If a collision with a detected person is imminent, the symbol lights up and a signal sounds.

Orange lights

Active Cruise Control

MINI Countryman (2020) - Active Cruise Control - 1

The number bars shows the selected distance from the vehicle driving ahead.

Camera-based cruise control, refer to page 171.

Vehicle detection, Active Cruise Control

MINI Countryman (2020) - Vehicle detection, Active Cruise Control - 1

Indicator light illuminates: a vehicle has been detected ahead of you.

Indicator light flashes: the conditions are not adequate for the system to work.

The system was deactivated but applies the brakes until the driver actively resumes control of the vehicle by pressing on the brake pedal or accelerator pedal.

Yellow lights

Anti-lock Braking System ABS

MINI Countryman (2020) - Anti-lock Braking System ABS - 1

The Brake Assistant function may not activate. Avoid abrupt braking. Take the longer braking distance into account.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Anti-lock Braking System ABS - 2

Have the system immediately checked by a dealer's service center

or another qualified service center or repair shop.

DSC Dynamic Stability Control

MINI Countryman (2020) - DSC Dynamic Stability Control - 1

The indicator light flashes: DSC controls the drive and braking forces.

The vehicle is stabilized. Reduce

speed and modify your driving style to the driving circumstances.

The indicator light lights up: DSC has malfunctioned.

Have the system checked by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

DSC, refer to page 166.

DSC Dynamic Stability Control is deactivated or DTC Dynamic Traction Control is activated

MINI Countryman (2020) - DSC Dynamic Stability Control is deactivated or DTC Dynamic Traction Control is activated - 1

DSC is deactivated or DTC is activated.

DSC, refer to page 166, and DTC, refer to page 167.

Flat Tire Monitor FTM

MINI Countryman (2020) - Flat Tire Monitor FTM - 1

The Flat Tire Monitor signals a loss of tire inflation pressure in a tire.

Reduce your speed and stop cautiously. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers.

Flat Tire Monitor, refer to page 154.

Tire Pressure Monitor TPM

MINI Countryman (2020) - Tire Pressure Monitor TPM - 1

The indicator light lights up: the Tire Pressure Monitor reports a low tire inflation pressure or a flat tire. Fol-

low the information in the Check Control message.

The indicator light flashes and then continuously lights up: no flat tire or loss of tire inflation pressure can be detected.

- Interference caused by systems or devices with the same radio frequency: after leaving the area of the interference, the system automatically becomes active again.

- TPM was unable to complete the reset. Reset the system again.

- A wheel without TPM wheel electronics is mounted: have it checked by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop as needed.

- Malfunction: have the system checked by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Tire Pressure Monitor, refer to page 150.

Steering system

MINI Countryman (2020) - Steering system - 1

Steering system may not be working.

Have the system checked by a dealer's service center or another quali-

fied service center or repair shop.

Emissions

MINI Countryman (2020) - Emissions - 1

- The warning light lights up:

Emissions are deteriorating.

Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible.

- The warning light flashes under certain circumstances:

This indicates that there is excessive misfiring in the engine.

Reduce the vehicle speed and have the system checked immediately; otherwise, serious engine misfiring within a brief period can seriously damage emission control components, in particular the catalytic converter.

Socket for Onboard Diagnosis, refer to page 299.

Green lights

Turn signal

MINI Countryman (2020) - Turn signal - 1

Turn signal switched on.

Unusually rapid flashing of the indicator light indicates that a turn signal bulb has failed.

Turn signal, refer to page 106.

Parking lights, headlight

MINI Countryman (2020) - Parking lights, headlight - 1

Parking lights or headlights are switched on.

Parking lights/low beams, headlight control, refer to page 140.

Front fog lights

MINI Countryman (2020) - Front fog lights - 1

Front fog lights are switched on.

Front fog lights, refer to page 143.

High-beam Assistant

MINI Countryman (2020) - High-beam Assistant - 1

High-beam Assistant is switched on.

High beams are switched on and off automatically depending on the traffic situation.

High-beam Assistant, refer to page 142.

Cruise control

MINI Countryman (2020) - Cruise control - 1

The system is switched on. It maintains the speed that was set using the control elements on the steering

wheel.

Blue lights

High beams

MINI Countryman (2020) - High beams - 1

High beams are switched on.

High beams, refer to page 107.

Hiding Check Control messages

MINI Countryman (2020) - Hiding Check Control messages - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car interior showing a white USB drive with a black tab and arrow pointing to the button (no text or symbols visible)

Press the button on the turn signal lever.

Continuous display

Some Check Control messages are displayed continuously and are not cleared until the malfunction is eliminated. If several malfunctions occur at once, the messages are displayed consecutively.

The messages can be hidden for approx. 8 seconds. After this time, they are displayed again automatically.

Temporary display

Some Check Control messages are hidden automatically after approx. 20 seconds. The Check Control messages are stored and can be displayed again later.

Displaying stored Check Control messages

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "Vehicle status"

  3. "Check Control"

  4. Select the SMS text message.

Display

Check Control

MINI Countryman (2020) - Check Control - 1

At least one Check Control message is displayed or stored.

SMS text messages

SMS text messages in combination with a symbol in the instrument cluster explain a Check Control message and the meaning of the indicator/warning lights.

Supplementary SMS text messages

Additional information, such as on the cause of an error or the required action, can be called up via Check Control.

With urgent messages the added text will be automatically displayed on the Control Display.

Depending on the Check Control message, further help can be selected.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "Vehicle status"

  3. "Check Control"

  4. Select the desired text message.

  5. Select the desired setting.

Messages after trip completion

Certain messages displayed while driving are displayed again after the ignition is switched off.

Fuel gauge

MINI Countryman (2020) - Fuel gauge - 1

The arrow beside the fuel pump symbol shows which side of the vehicle the fuel filler flap is on.

Vehicle tilt position may cause

the display to vary.

Information on refueling, refer to page 264.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Fuel gauge - 2

The yellow indicator light illuminates, once the fuel reserve is reached.

Tachometer

Always avoid engine speeds in the red warning field. In this range, the fuel supply is reduced to protect the engine.

Odometer and trip odometer

Concept

The total mileage driven and the mileage driven since the last reset are displayed in the instrument cluster.

Reset the trip odometer

MINI Countryman (2020) - Reset the trip odometer - 1

Press the button.

- The odometer is displayed when the ignition is switched off.

- When the ignition is switched on, the trip odometer is reset.

External temperature

General information

If the indicator drops to +37 °F/+3 °C, a signal sounds.

A Check Control message is displayed.

There is an increased risk of ice on roads.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Even at temperatures above +37 °F/+3 °C there can be a risk of icy roads, for instance on bridges or shady sections of the road. There is a risk of accident. Modify your driving style to the weather conditions at low temperatures.

Display

MINI Countryman (2020) - Display - 1

The external temperature is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Time

MINI Countryman (2020) - Time - 1

The time is displayed in the instrument cluster.

The time can be set via the Central Information Display (CID).

Date

MINI Countryman (2020) - Date - 1

The date is displayed in the instrument cluster.

The date can be set via the Central Information Display (CID).

Range

General information

When the remaining range is low:

  • A Check Control message is displayed briefly.
  • The remaining range is shown on the Onboard Computer.
  • With a dynamic driving style, for instance fast cornering, the engine function is not always ensured.

The Check Control message appears continuously below a range of approx. 30 miles/50 km.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

NOTICE

With a driving range of less than 30 miles/50 km the engine may no longer have sufficient fuel. Engine functions are not ensured anymore. There is a risk of damage to property. Refuel promptly.

Display

MINI Countryman (2020) - Display - 1

The current range is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Displaying the cruising range

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Displays"
  4. "Instrument panel"
  5. "Range"

Current consumption

Concept

Displays the current fuel consumption. Check whether you are currently driving in an efficient and environmentally-friendly manner.

Displaying the current consumption

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Displays"
  4. "Instrument panel"
  5. "Current consumption"

Service requirements

Concept

The function displays the service requirements and the corresponding maintenance scopes.

General information

After the ignition is switched on the instrument cluster briefly displays available driving distance or time to the next scheduled maintenance.

A service advisor can read out the current service requirements from your vehicle key.

Display

Detailed information on service requirements

More information on the type of service required may be displayed on the Control Display.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle status"
  3. "Service required"

Required maintenance procedures and legally mandated inspections are displayed.

  1. Select an entry to call up detailed information.

Symbols

Symbols Description

OK

No service is currently required.

The deadline for scheduled maintenance or a legally mandated inspection is approaching.

The service deadline has already passed.

Entering appointment dates

Enter the dates for the mandatory vehicle inspections.

Make sure that the vehicle's date and time are set correctly.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle status"
  3. "Service required"
  4. "Vehicle inspection"
  5. "Date:"
  6. Select the desired setting.

Automatic Service Request

Data regarding the service status or legally mandated vehicle inspections is automatically transmitted to your dealer's service center before your vehicle is due for service.

You can check when your dealer's service center was notified.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle status"
  3. Move the Controller to the left.
  4. "Teleservice Call"

Gear shift indicator

Concept

The system recommends the most efficient gear for the current driving situation.

General information

Depending on the vehicle equipment and country version, the gear shift indicator is active in the manual mode of the Steptronic transmission and with manual transmission.

Suggestions to shift up or down are displayed in the instrument cluster.

Manual transmission: displaying

Example Description

MINI Countryman (2020) - Example Description - 1

Efficient gear is set.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Example Description - 2

Shift into efficient gear.

Steptronic transmission: displaying

Example Description

MINI Countryman (2020) - Example Description - 1

Efficient gear is set.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Example Description - 2

Shift into efficient gear.

Speed Limit Info

Speed Limit Info

Concept

Speed Limit Info shows the current maximum permitted speed in the instrument cluster.

General information

The camera at the base of the interior mirror detects traffic signs at the edge of the road as well as variable overhead sign posts. Traffic signs with extra symbols for wet road conditions, etc., are also detected and compared with the vehicle's onboard data, such as from the rain sensor, and will be displayed depending on the situation.

Without a navigation system, the system is subject to limitations imposed by technology. Traffic signs with speed limitations are detected and displayed only. Speed limita-

tions due to entering or exiting towns, highway signs, etc. are not displayed. Speed limits with extra text characters are always displayed.

Safety information

Warning

The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment in assessing visibility and traffic situation. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Overview

Camera
MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Front view of a car with an upward arrow symbol on the windshield (no text or labels)

The camera is installed near the interior mirror.

Keep the windshield in front of the interior mirror clean and clear.

Display

Speed Limit Info is displayed via the On-board Computer.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Display - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car interior showing a white arrow pointing to a connected audio component (no text or symbols visible)

Press button on the turn signal lever several times, if needed.

Speed Limit Info is displayed on the Info Display in the instrument cluster.

Speed Limit Info

MINI Countryman (2020) - Speed Limit Info - 1

The last speed limit detected. Without a navigation system the traffic signals are grayed out after curves or longer stretches of roadway.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Speed Limit Info - 2

Without navigation system: no speed limit or cancellation is detected.

System limits

The system may not be fully functional and may provide incorrect information in the following situations:

  • In heavy fog, wet conditions, or snowfall.
  • When signs are fully or partially concealed by objects, stickers or paint.
  • When driving very close to the vehicle in front of you.
  • When driving toward bright lights or strong reflections.
  • When the windshield in front of the interior mirror is fogged over, dirty or covered by a sticker, etc.

  • In the event of incorrect detection by the camera.

  • When passing buses or trucks with a speed sticker.
  • If the traffic signs are non-conforming.
  • When signs that are valid for a parallel road are detected.
    – During calibration of the camera immediately after vehicle delivery.

Selection lists

General information

Depending on the vehicle equipment, the buttons on the steering wheel and the display in the instrument cluster can be used to display or use the following:

  • Current audio source.
  • Phone redial.
  • Turn on voice activation system.

Activating a list and adjusting the setting

Button on the steering wheelFunction
Move selection up.
Move selection down.

Display

MINI Countryman (2020) - Display - 1

text_image D BAYERN 3

Onboard Computer

Concept

The Onboard Computer displays different vehicle data in the instrument cluster, such as average values.

Calling up information on the Info Display

MINI Countryman (2020) - Calling up information on the Info Display - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car interior showing a white arrow pointing to a button on the steering wheel (no text or symbols visible)

Press the button on the turn signal lever.

Information is displayed in the Info Display of the instrument cluster.

Information at a glance

Info Display

MINI Countryman (2020) - Info Display - 1

Repeatedly pressing the button on the turn signal lever calls up the following information in the Info Display:

- Range.

- GREEN Info.

When GREEN Mode is activated.

  • Average consumption, fuel.
  • Current consumption, fuel.
  • Average speed.
  • Date.
  • Engine temperature display.
  • Speed Limit Info.
  • Vehicle speed.

The unit of some information can be changed.

Setting units, refer to page 48.

Selecting information

Depending on the vehicle equipment, you can select what information from the On-board Computer can be displayed on the Info Display of the instrument cluster.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Displays"
  4. "Instrument panel"
  5. Select the desired setting.

Settings are stored for the profile currently used.

Information in detail

Range

Displays the estimated cruising range available with the remaining fuel.

The range is calculated based on your driving style over the last 20 miles/30 km.

GREEN info

The achieved range extension may be displayed as a bonus range.

Average consumption

This is calculated for the period while the engine is running.

The average consumption is calculated for the distance traveled since the last reset by the Onboard Computer.

Average speed

Periods in which the vehicle is parked with the engine manually stopped are not included in the calculation of the average speed.

Resetting average values

MINI Countryman (2020) - Resetting average values - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a white arrow pointing to a car's side panel (no text or symbols visible)

Press and hold the button on the turn signal lever.

Engine temperature display

Concept

Displays the current engine temperature, based on a combination of coolant and engine oil temperature. As soon as the optimum operating temperature has been attained, the indicator is in the center position.

General information

If the engine oil or coolant, and thus the engine, become too hot, a Check Control message is displayed too.

MINI Countryman (2020) - General information - 1

When the engine temperature is too high, a red indicator light is displayed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - General information - 2

When the engine oil temperature is too high, a red indicator light is displayed.

To check the coolant level, refer to page 296.

Display
MINI Countryman (2020) - General information - 3

text_image OK

Speed Limit Info

Speed Limit Info shows the current maximum permitted speed in the instrument cluster.

Onboard Computer on the Control Display

Concept

The Onboard Computer displays different vehicle data on the Control Display, such as average values.

General information

Two types of Onboard Computers are available on the Control Display:

  • "Onboard info": average values, such as the consumption, are displayed. The values can be reset individually.
  • "Trip computer": the values deliver an overview of a specific route and can be reset as often as necessary.

Calling up the Onboard Computer or trip computer

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Driving information"
  3. "Onboard info" or "Trip computer"

Resetting the Onboard Computer

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Driving information"
  3. "Onboard info"
  4. "Consumption" or "Speed"
  5. "OK"

Resetting the trip computer

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Driving information"
  3. "Trip computer"

  4. Move the Controller to the left, if needed.

  5. "Reset": all values are reset.

  6. "Automatic reset": all values are reset approx. 4 hours after the vehicle has come to a standstill.

  7. If necessary, "OK"

Driving Excitement

Concept

On the Control Display, sport instruments can be displayed, and the vehicle state can be checked before the use of the SPORT program.

Sport instruments

General information

On the Control Display, values for power and torque are displayed.

Displaying sport instruments

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Technology in action"
  3. "Sport displays"
  4. "Sports instruments"

Via MINI Driving Modes switch:

  1. Activate SPORT.
  2. "Sport displays"
  3. "Sports instruments"

Speed warning

Concept

A speed limit can be set that when reached will cause a warning to be issued.

General information

The warning is repeated if the vehicle speed exceeds the set speed limit again, after it has dropped below it by 3 mph/5 km/h.

Adjusting

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. "Speed warning"
  4. "Warning at:"
  5. Turn the Controller until the desired speed is displayed.
  6. Press the Controller.

Activating/deactivating

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. "Speed warning"
  4. "Speed warning"

Setting your current speed as the speed warning

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. "Speed warning"
  4. "Select current speed"

LED ring on the central instrument cluster

Concept

The LED ring displays light animations to represent specific functions.

Basic displays

Basic functions, for instance the tachometer, can be set to be displayed continually if so desired.

Event displays

Functions that are only displayed temporarily, for instance the volume or temperature settings, can be set as event displays.

Several vehicle assistance functions can also be displayed on the LED ring. This display corresponds with the displays of the function in the respective display.

Example: tachometer

Like the tachometer in the instrument cluster, the light animations of the tachometer's basic display show the current RPMs and the respective RPM warning thresholds.

Display
MINI Countryman (2020) - Example: tachometer - 1

text_image Car dashboard interior with labeled navigation arrows pointing to the steering wheel and dashboard screen
  • Arrow 1: current RPM.
  • Arrow 2: prewarning field.
  • Arrow 3: warning field.

Switching on/off LED ring

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Displays"
  4. "Center Instrument"
  5. "Center Instrument"

Adjusting the LED ring

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Displays"
  4. "Center Instrument"
  5. "Basic display" or "Event display"
  6. Select the desired setting.

Setting the brightness

The brightness can be adjusted when night lighting is active in the instrument cluster. Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Displays"
  4. "Center Instrument"
  5. "Brightness at night"
  6. Turn the Controller until the desired brightness is set.
  7. Press the Controller.

The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Vehicle status

General information

The status can be displayed and actions performed for several systems.

Opening the vehicle status

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "Vehicle status"

Information at a glance

Symbols Description

(!) "Flat Tire Monitor": status of the Flat Tire Monitor, refer to page 154.
(!) "Tire Pressure Monitor": status of the Tire Pressure Monitor, refer to page 150.
"Engine oil level": Electronic engine oil level check, refer to page 292.
⚠️ "Check Control": Check Control messages are stored in the background and can be displayed on the Control Display. Displaying stored Check Control messages, refer to page 128.
"Service required": displaying service requirements, refer to page 131.
"Teleservice Call": Service Request.

Lights

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Overview

Switches in the vehicle
MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with key controls and a visible 'MIDI' logo (no text or symbols on the main components)

The light switch element is located next to the steering wheel.

Symbol Function

#DFront fog lights.
≡CAAutomatic headlight control.Cornering light.
0Lights off.Daytime running lights.

Symbol Function

Parking lights.
Low beams.
Instrument lighting.

Parking lights, low beams and roadside parking lights

General information

Position of switch: 0, D

If the driver's door is opened when the ignition is switched off, the exterior lighting is automatically switched off.

Parking lights

Position of switch: ✉D D

The vehicle is illuminated on all sides.

Do not use the parking lights for extended periods; otherwise, the battery may become discharged and it would then be impossible to start the engine.

Canada: when parking, switch on the one-sided roadside parking light, refer to page 141.

Low beams

Position of switch: D

The low beams light up when the ignition is switched on.

Canada: roadside parking light

Concept

The vehicle can be illuminated on one side.

Switching on

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a vehicle wheel and seat, with bidirectional arrows indicating movement or force (no text or symbols present)

With radio-ready state switched off, press the lever either up or down past the resistance point for approx. 2 seconds.

Switching off

Briefly press the lever to the resistance point in the opposite direction.

Welcome lights and headlight courtesy delay feature

Welcome lights

General information

Depending on the vehicle equipment and the ambient brightness, individual light functions may be switched on briefly when the vehicle is unlocked.

Activating/deactivating

Position of switch:

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating/deactivating - 1

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating/deactivating - 2

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "Vehicle settings"

  3. "Lighting"

  4. "Exterior lighting"

  5. "Welcome lights"

The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Headlight courtesy delay feature

General information

The low beams stay illuminated for a particular time if the high beams are switched on after radio-ready state is switched off.

Canada: the low beams stay illuminated for a particular time if the headlight flasher is switched on after radio-ready state is switched off.

Setting the duration

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "Vehicle settings"

  3. "Lighting"

  4. "Exterior lighting"

  5. "Pathway lighting"

  6. Set length of time.

The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Automatic headlight control

Concept

The low beams are switched on and off automatically depending on the ambient brightness, for example in tunnels, in twilight or if there is precipitation.

General information

A blue sky with the sun low on the horizon can cause the lights to be switched on.

Activating

Position of switch:

The indicator light in the instrument cluster is illuminated when the low beams are switched on.

System limits

The automatic headlight control cannot serve as a substitute for your personal judgment of lighting conditions.

For example, the sensors are unable to detect fog or hazy weather. In these situations, switch the lights on manually.

Daytime running lights

General information

Position of switch: 0,

MINI Countryman (2020) - General information - 1

MINI Countryman (2020) - General information - 2

The daytime running lights light up when the ignition is switched on. After the ignition is switched off, the parking lights light up in position

Activating/deactivating

In some countries, daytime running lights are mandatory, so it may not be possible to deactivate the daytime running lights.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "Vehicle settings"

  3. "Lighting"

  4. "Exterior lighting"

  5. Select the desired setting.

Settings are stored for the currently used vehicle key.

Cornering light

General information

Position of switch:

MINI Countryman (2020) - General information - 1

In tight curves, for instance on mountainous roads or when turning, an additional, cornering light is switched on that lights up the inside of the curve when the vehicle is moving below a certain speed.

The cornering light is automatically switched on depending on the steering angle or, where applicable, the use of turn signals.

When driving in reverse, the cornering lights may be automatically switched on regardless of the steering angle.

Adaptive headlight range control

The adaptive headlight range control feature balances out acceleration and braking processes as well as the vehicle load conditions in order to avoid dazzling oncoming traffic. Illumination of the road is optimized.

High-beam Assistant

Concept

The high-beam Assistant detects other traffic participants early on and automatically switches the high beams on or off depending on the traffic situation.

General information

The high-beam Assistant ensures that the high beams are switched on, whenever the traffic situation allows. In the low speed range, the high beams are not switched on by the system.

The system responds to light from oncoming traffic and traffic driving ahead of you, and to ambient lighting, for instance in towns and cities.

The high beams can be switched on and off manually at any time.

Activating/deactivating

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating/deactivating - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a car's wheel and steering wheel (no text or symbols visible)

Position of switch, depending on the vehicle equipment: 📄 📋

Press the button on the turn signal lever.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating/deactivating - 2

The indicator light in the instrument cluster is illuminated when the low beams are switched on.

The headlights are automatically switched between low beams and high beams.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating/deactivating - 3

The blue indicator light in the instrument cluster lights up when the system switches on the high beams.

The high-beam Assistant is deactivated when manually switching the high beams on and off, refer to page 107.

To reactivate the high-beam Assistant, press the button on the turn signal lever.

System limits

The high-beam Assistant cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment of when to use the high beams. In situation that require this, therefore switch off manually.

The system is not fully functional in the following situations, and driver intervention may be necessary:

- In very unfavorable weather conditions, such as fog or heavy precipitation.

- When detecting poorly-lit road users such as pedestrians, cyclists, horseback riders and wagons; when driving close to train or ship traffic; or at animal crossings.

- In tight curves, on hilltops or in depressions, in crossing traffic or half-obscured oncoming traffic on highways.

- In poorly-lit towns and cities or in the presence of highly reflective signs.

- When the windshield in front of the interior mirror is fogged over, dirty or covered with stickers, etc.

Fog lights

Front fog lights

Concept

The front fog lights work alongside the low beams to illuminate a wider area of the roadway.

Functional requirement

The low beams must be switched on before switching on the front fog lights.

Switching on/off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off - 1

Press the button.

The green indicator light lights up if the front fog lights are switched on.

If the automatic headlight control, refer to page 141, is activated, the low beams will come on automatically when you switch on the front fog lights.

When the high beams or headlight flasher are activated, the front fog lights are not switched on.

Instrument lighting

Functional requirement

The parking lights or low beams must be switched on to adjust the brightness.

Adjusting

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting - 1

Adjust the brightness with the thumbwheel.

Interior lights

General information

Depending on the equipment, the interior lights, footwell lights, entry lights, and courtesy lights are controlled automatically.

The thumbwheel for the instrument lighting controls brightness of some of these features.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

text_image 2 1 3 2

1 Interior lights
2 Reading lights
3 Ambient light

Switching the interior lights on/off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching the interior lights on/off - 1

Press the button.

To switch off permanently: press the button and hold for approx. 3 seconds.

Switching the reading lights on and off manually

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching the reading lights on and off manually - 1

Press the button.

The reading lights are located in the front next to the interior light.

Ambient light

General information

Depending on the equipment version, lighting can be adjusted for some lights in the car's interior.

Changing color

MINI Countryman (2020) - Changing color - 1

Push the switch forward or back: manual color change.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Changing color - 2

Press the switch forward or backward and hold for approx. 3 seconds, until the ambient light illuminates

several times: automatic color change. Push the switch again to end color changes.

Setting the brightness

Depending on the equipment, the brightness of the ambient light can be adjusted via the thumbwheel for the instrument lighting or on the Control Display.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. "Lighting"
  4. "Interior lighting"
  5. "Brightness"
  6. Adjust the brightness.

Safety

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for

instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Airbags

MINI Countryman (2020) - Airbags - 1

text_image Interior view of a car with numbered anatomical labels pointing to specific sections

1 Front airbag, driver
2 Front airbag, front passenger
3 Head airbag

4 Side airbag
5 Knee airbag

Front airbags

Front airbags help protect the driver and the front passenger by responding to frontal impacts in which safety belts alone would not provide adequate protection.

Side airbag

In the event of a side impact, the side air-bag protects the side of the body in the chest and lap area.

Head airbag

In the event of a side impact, the head airbag protects the head.

Ejection Mitigation

The head airbag system is designed as an ejection mitigation countermeasure to reduce the likelihood of ejections of vehicle occupants through side windows during rollovers or side impact events.

Knee airbag

The knee airbag protects the legs in the event of a frontal impact.

Protective effect

Airbags are not triggered in every impact situation, for instance in less severe accidents or rear-end collisions.

Information on optimum effect of the airbags

MINI Countryman (2020) - Information on optimum effect of the airbags - 1

Warning

If the seat position is incorrect or the deployment area of the airbags is impaired, the airbag system cannot provide protection as intended and may cause additional injuries due to triggering. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Follow the information on achieving the optimum protective effect of the airbag system.

  • Keep a distance from the airbags.
  • Always grasp the steering wheel on the steering wheel rim. Hold your hands at the 3 o'clock and 9 o'clock positions, to keep the risk of injury to your hands or arms as low as possible when the airbag is triggered.
  • Make sure that the front passenger is sitting correctly, i.e., keeps his or her

feet and legs in the floor area and does not support them on the dashboard.

  • Make sure that occupants keep their heads away from the side airbag.
  • There should be no additional persons, animals or objects between an airbag and a person.
  • Dashboard and windshield on the front passenger side must stay clear - do not attach adhesive labels or coverings and do not attach brackets or cables, for instance for GPS devices or mobile phones.
  • Do not apply adhesive materials to the airbag cover panels, do not cover them or modify them in any way.
  • Do not use the cover of the front airbag on the front passenger side as a storage area.
  • Do not attach slip covers, seat cushions or other objects to the front passenger seat that are not specifically suited for seats with integrated side airbags.
  • Do not place seat cushions or other objects on the front seats that are not specifically suited for seats with integrated side airbags.
  • Do not hang pieces of clothing, such as jackets, over the backrests.
  • Never modify either the individual components or the wiring in the airbag system. This also applies to steering wheel covers, the dashboard, and the seats.
  • Do not remove the airbag system.

Even when you follow all instructions very closely, injury from contact with the airbags cannot be fully ruled out in certain situations.

The ignition and inflation noise may lead to short-term and, in most cases, temporary hearing impairment in sensitive occupants.

Vehicle modifications for a person with disabilities may affect the air bag system; con-

tact MINI Customer Relations for further information.

Warnings and information on the airbags are also found on the sun visors.

Functional readiness of the airbag system

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Individual components can be hot after triggering of the airbag system. There is a risk of injury. Do not touch individual components.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

Improperly executed work can lead to failure, malfunction or unintentional triggering of the airbag system. In the case of a malfunction, the airbag system might not trigger as intended despite the accident severity. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Have the airbag system checked, repaired, dismantled and scrapped by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Correct function

MINI Countryman (2020) - Correct function - 1

When the ignition is switched on, the warning light in the instrument cluster lights up briefly and thereby indicates the operational readiness of the entire airbag system and the belt tensioner.

Airbag system malfunctioning

- Warning light does not come on when the ignition is switched on.

- The warning light lights up continuously.

Automatic deactivation of the front-seat passenger airbags

Concept

The system reads if the front passenger seat is occupied by measuring the human body's resistance.

Front, knee, and side airbag on the front passenger's side are activated or deactivated.

General information

Before transporting a child on the front passenger seat, refer to the safety information and instructions for children on the front passenger seat, see Children.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

To ensure the front-seat passenger airbag function, the system must be able to detect whether a person is sitting in the front passenger seat. The entire seat cushion area must be used for this purpose. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Make sure that the front passenger keeps his or her feet in the floor area.

Malfunction of the automatic deactivation system

When transporting older children and adults, the front-seat passenger airbags may be deactivated in certain sitting positions. In this case, the indicator light for the front-seat passenger airbags lights up.

In this case, change the sitting position so that the front-seat passenger airbags are activated and the indicator light goes out.

If it is not possible to activate the airbags, have the person sit in the rear.

To enable correct recognition of the occupied seat cushion.

  • Do not attach covers, cushions, ball mats or other items to the front passenger seat unless they are specifically determined to be safe for use on the front passenger seat.
  • Do not place any electronic devices on the front passenger seat if a child restraint system is to be installed on it.
  • Do not place objects under the seat that could press against the seat from below.
  • No moisture in or on the seat.

Indicator light for the front-seat passenger airbags

MINI Countryman (2020) - Indicator light for the front-seat passenger airbags - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car front view showing the dashboard and steering wheel (no text or symbols visible)

The indicator light for the front-seat passenger airbags indicates the operating state of the front-seat passenger airbags.

The light indicates whether the airbags are either activated or deactivated.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Indicator light for the front-seat passenger airbags - 2

- The indicator light lights up when a child is properly seated in a child restraint system or when the seat is empty. The airbags on the front passenger side are not activated.

- The indicator light does not light up when, for instance a correctly seated person of sufficient size is detected on the seat. The airbags on the front passenger side are activated.

Detected child restraint systems

The system generally detects children seated in a child restraint system, particularly in child restraint systems required by NHTSA at the point in time when the vehicle was manufactured. After installing a child restraint system, make sure that the indicator light for the front-seat passenger airbags lights up. This indicates that the child restraint system has been detected and the front-seat passenger airbags are not activated.

Strength of the driver's and front-seat passenger airbag

The explosive power that activates driver's/front-seat passenger airbags very much depends on the positions of the driver's/front passenger seat.

To maintain the accuracy of this function over the long-term, calibrate the front seats as soon as a relevant Check Control message is displayed.

Calibrating the front seats

Warning

There is a risk of jamming when moving the seats. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the area of movement of the seat is clear prior to any adjustment.

An appropriate Check Control message is displayed.

  1. Move the respective seat all the way forward.
  2. Move the respective seat forward again. The seat moves forward briefly.
  3. Readjust the seat to the desired position.

The calibration procedure is completed when the Check Control message disappears.

If the message continues to be displayed, repeat the calibration.

If the message does not disappear after a repeat calibration, have the system checked as soon as possible.

Tire Pressure Monitor TPM

Concept

The system monitors tire inflation pressure in the four mounted tires. The system warns you if there is a significant loss of pressure in one or more tires.

General information

Sensors in the tire valves measure the tire inflation pressure and, depending on the model, the tire temperature.

Further information and instructions on using the system can also be found under Tire inflation pressure, refer to page 268.

Functional requirements

The following conditions must be met for the system; otherwise, reliable flagging of a loss of tire inflation pressure is not assured:

  • After a tire or wheel replacement, a reset was performed with the correct tire inflation pressure.
  • After the tire inflation pressure was adjusted to a new value, a reset was performed.
  • Wheels with TPM wheel electronics.

Status display

Current status

The system status can be displayed on the Control Display, e.g., whether or not the system is active.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle status"
  3. "Tire Pressure Monitor"
    The current status is displayed.

Additional information

The current tire inflation pressures are displayed too. The values shown are instantaneous measurements and may vary depending on driving style or weather conditions.

Resetting the system

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle status"
  3. "Dire Pressure Monitor"
  4. Start the engine but do not drive off.
  5. Reset the tire inflation pressure using "Perform reset".
  6. Drive away.

The following is displayed: "Resetting Tire Pressure Monitor...".

After a travel time of several minutes, the set tire inflation pressures are accepted as reference values. The resetting process is completed automatically while driving.

After a successfully completed reset, the following is displayed: "Tire Pressure Monitor active. See label for recommended pressures.".

You may interrupt this trip at any time. When you continue the reset resumes automatically.

Messages

General information

A low tire inflation pressure may cause the DSC Dynamic Stability Control to be switched on.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

A damaged regular tire with low or missing tire inflation pressure impacts handling, such as steering and braking response. Run-flat tires can maintain limited stability. There is a risk of accident. Do not continue driving if the vehicle is equipped with normal tires. Follow the information on run-flat tires and continued driving with these tires.

If a tire inflation pressure check is required

Message

A symbol with a Check Control message appears on the Control Display.

Symbol Possible cause

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Possible cause - 1

The system has detected a wheel change, but no reset was done.

No reset was performed for the system. The system issues a warning based on the tire inflation pressures stored during the last reset.

Inflation was not carried out according to specifications.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Possible cause - 2

The tire inflation pressure has fallen below the level of the last reset.

Measure

  1. Check the tire pressure and correct as needed.
  2. Reset the system.

If the tire inflation pressure is too low

Message

MINI Countryman (2020) - Message - 1

A yellow warning light is illuminated in the instrument cluster.

In addition, a symbol with a Check Control message appears on the Control Display.

Symbol Possible cause

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Possible cause - 1

There is a tire inflation pressure loss.

No reset was performed for the system. The system issues a warning based on the tire inflation pressures stored during the last reset.

Measure

  1. Reduce your speed and drive moderately. Do not exceed a speed of 80 mph/130 km/h.

  2. At the next opportunity, for instance gas station, check and correct the tire inflation pressure in all four tires, if necessary.

  3. Reset the system.

If there is a significant loss of tire inflation pressure

Message

MINI Countryman (2020) - Message - 1

A yellow warning light is illuminated in the instrument cluster.

In addition, a symbol with the affected tire appears in a Check Control message on the Control Display.

Symbol Possible cause

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Possible cause - 1

There is a flat tire or a major loss in tire inflation pressure.

No reset was performed for the system. The system issues a warning based on the tire inflation pressures stored during the last reset.

Measure

  1. Reduce your speed and stop cautiously. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers.
  2. Check whether the vehicle is fitted with normal tires or run-flat tires.

Run-flat tires, refer to page 277, are labeled with a circular symbol containing the letters RSC marked on the tire's sidewall.

Actions in the event of a flat tire

Normal tires

  1. Identify the damaged tire.

To do this, check the tire inflation pressure in all four tires, for instance using the tire pressure gage of a flat tire kit.

If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Tire Pressure Monitor may not have been reset. In this case, perform the reset.

If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Flat Tire Monitor may not have been initialized. In this case, initialize the system.

If identification of flat tire damage is not possible, please contact a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

  1. Repair the flat tire, e.g., with a flat tire kit or by changing the wheel.

Use of sealant, for instance from the flat tire kit, may damage the TPM wheel electronics. In this case, have the electronics checked and replaced at the next opportunity.

Run-flat tires

Safety information

Warning

Your vehicle handles differently with a run-flat tire with no or low inflation pressure; for instance, your lane stability when braking is reduced, braking distances are longer and the self-steering properties will change. There is a risk of accident. Drive moderately and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.

Maximum speed

You may continue driving with a damaged tire at speeds up to 50 mph/80 km/h.

Continued driving with a flat tire

If continuing to drive with a damaged tire:

  1. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers.
  2. Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.
  3. Check the tire inflation pressure in all four tires at the next opportunity.
    If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Tire Pressure Monitor may not have been reset. In this case, perform the reset.

Possible driving range with a depressurized tire

The distance for which it may be possible to drive safely varies depending on how the vehicle is loaded and used, e.g., speed, road conditions, external temperature. The driving range may be less but may also be more if an economical driving style is used.

If the vehicle is loaded with an average weight and used under favorable conditions, the distance for which it may be safe to drive may be up to 50 miles/80 km.

Vehicle handling with damaged tires

Vehicles driven with a damaged tire will handle differently, potentially leading to conditions such as the following:

  • Greater likelihood of swerving off course.
  • Longer braking distances.
  • Changed self-steering properties.

Modify your driving style. Avoid abrupt steering maneuvers or driving over obstacles, for instance curbs or potholes.

Final tire failure

Vibrations or loud noises while driving can indicate the final failure of a tire.

Reduce speed and stop; otherwise, pieces of the tire could come loose and cause an accident.

Do not continue driving. Contact a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

System limits

Temperature

The tire inflation pressure depends on the tire's temperature.

Driving or exposure to the sun will increase the tire's temperature, thus increasing the tire inflation pressure.

The tire inflation pressure is reduced when the tire temperature falls again.

These circumstances may cause a warning when temperatures fall very sharply.

Sudden tire pressure loss

The system cannot indicate sudden serious tire damage caused by external circumstances.

Failure performing a reset

The system does not function properly if a reset has not been carried out, for instance a flat tire is reported though tire inflation pressures are correct.

Malfunction

MINI Countryman (2020) - Malfunction - 1

The yellow warning light flashes and is then illuminated continuously. A Check Control message is displayed.

It may not be possible to identify tire pressure losses.

Examples and recommendations in the following situations:

- A wheel without TPM wheel electronics, for instance an emergency wheel, is mounted: have it checked by a dealer's

service center or another qualified service center or repair shop as needed.

  • Malfunction: have system checked by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.
  • The system was unable to complete the reset. Perform a system reset again.
  • Interference caused by systems or devices with the same radio frequency: after leaving the area of the interference, the system automatically becomes active again.

Declaration according to NHTSA/FMVSS 138 Tire Pressure Monitoring System

Each tire, including the spare (if provided) should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.) As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale. Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.

Flat Tire Monitor FTM

Concept

The system detects tire inflation pressure loss on the basis of rotation speed differences between the individual wheels while driving.

In the event of a tire inflation pressure loss, the diameter and therefore the rotational speed of the corresponding wheel changes. The difference will be detected and reported as a flat tire.

The system does not measure the actual inflation pressure in the tires.

Functional requirements

The following conditions must be met for the system; otherwise, reliable flagging of a loss of tire inflation pressure is not assured:

  • After a tire or wheel replacement, an initialization was performed with the correct tire inflation pressure.
  • After the tire pressure was adjusted to a new value, an initialization was performed.

Status display

The current status of the flat tire monitor can be displayed, for instance whether the RPA is active.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle status"
  3. "Flat Tire Monitor"

The status is displayed.

Initialization required

An initialization must be performed in the following situations:

  • After the tire inflation pressure has been adjusted.
  • After a tire or wheel replacement.

Performing initialization

When initializing, the set tire inflation pressures serve as reference values in order to detect a flat tire. Initialization is started by confirming the tire inflation pressures.

Do not initialize the system when driving with snow chains.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle status"
  3. "Flat Tire Monitor"

  4. Start the engine but do not drive off.

  5. Start the initialization with: "Perform reset".

  6. Drive away.

The initialization is completed while driving, which can be interrupted at any time. The initialization automatically continues when driving resumes.

Messages

General information

When a flat tire is indicated, DSC Dynamic Stability Control is switched on, if needed.

Safety information

Warning

A damaged regular tire with low or missing tire inflation pressure impacts handling, such as steering and braking response. Run-flat tires can maintain limited stability. There is a risk of accident. Do not continue driving if the vehicle is equipped with normal tires. Follow the information on run-flat tires and continued driving with these tires.

Indication of a flat tire

MINI Countryman (2020) - Indication of a flat tire - 1

A yellow warning light is illuminated in the instrument cluster.

In addition, a symbol with a Check Control message appears on the Control Display.

Symbol Possible cause

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Possible cause - 1

There is a flat tire or a major loss in tire inflation pressure.

Measure

  1. Reduce your speed and stop cautiously. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers.
  2. Check whether the vehicle is fitted with normal tires or run-flat tires.
    Run-flat tires, refer to page 277, are labeled with a circular symbol containing the letters RSC marked on the tire's sidewall.

Actions in the event of a flat tire

Normal tires

  1. Identify the damaged tire.

To do this, check the tire inflation pressure in all four tires, for instance using the tire pressure gage of a flat tire kit.

If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Tire Pressure Monitor may not have been reset. In this case, perform the reset.

If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Flat Tire Monitor may not have been initialized. In this case, initialize the system.

If identification of flat tire damage is not possible, please contact a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

  1. Repair the flat tire, e.g., with a flat tire kit or by changing the wheel.

Use of sealant, for instance from the flat tire kit, may damage the TPM wheel electronics. In this case, have the electronics checked and replaced at the next opportunity.

Run-flat tires

Safety information

Warning

Your vehicle handles differently with a run-flat tire with no or low inflation pressure; for instance, your lane stability when braking is reduced, braking distances are longer and the self-steering properties will change. There is a risk of accident. Drive moderately and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.

Maximum speed

You may continue driving with a damaged tire at speeds up to 50 mph/80 km/h.

Continued driving with a flat tire

If continuing to drive with a damaged tire:

  1. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers.
  2. Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.
  3. Check the tire inflation pressure in all four tires at the next opportunity. If the tire inflation pressure in all four tires is correct, the Flat Tire Monitor may not have been initialized. In this case, initialize the system.

Possible driving range with a depressurized tire

The distance for which it may be possible to drive safely varies depending on how the vehicle is loaded and used, e.g., speed, road conditions, external temperature. The driving range may be less but may also be more if an economical driving style is used.

If the vehicle is loaded with an average weight and used under favorable conditions,

the distance for which it may be safe to drive may be up to 50 miles/80 km.

Vehicle handling with damaged tires

Vehicles driven with a damaged tire will handle differently, potentially leading to conditions such as the following:

  • Greater likelihood of swerving off course.
  • Longer braking distances.
  • Changed self-steering properties.

Modify your driving style. Avoid abrupt steering maneuvers or driving over obstacles, for instance curbs or potholes.

Final tire failure

Vibrations or loud noises while driving can indicate the final failure of a tire.

Reduce speed and stop; otherwise, pieces of the tire could come loose and cause an accident.

Do not continue driving. Contact a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

System limits

The system could be delayed or malfunction in the following situations:

  • A natural, even tire inflation pressure loss in all four tires will not be recognized. Therefore, check the tire inflation pressure regularly.
  • Sudden serious tire damage caused by external circumstances cannot be recognized in advance.
  • When the system has not been initialized.
  • When driving on a snowy or slippery road surface.
  • Sporty driving style: spinning traction wheels, high lateral acceleration (drifting).

- When driving with snow chains.

Intelligent Safety

Concept

Intelligent Safety enables central operation of the driver assistance systems.

The intelligent safety systems can help prevent an imminent collision.

  • Approach control warning with City light braking function, refer to page 158.
    – Daytime pedestrian collision mitigation, refer to page 162.

Safety information

Warning

The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment in assessing visibility and traffic situation. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Warning

Indicators and warnings cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment. Due to its limits, the system may not issue warnings or reactions, or these may be issued late or in a manner that is not consistent with their normal use. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Warning

Due to system limits, individual functions can malfunction during tow-starting/towing with the Intelligent Safety systems activated. There is a risk of accident. Switch all Intelligent Safety systems off prior to tow-starting/towing.

Overview

Button in the vehicle
MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and air conditioner (no visible text or symbols)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 2

Intelligent Safety button

Switching on/off

Some Intelligent Safety systems are automatically active after every departure. Some Intelligent Safety systems activate according to the last setting.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off - 1

Press button briefly:

- The menu for the Intelligent Safety system is displayed. The systems are individually switched off according to their respective settings.

- LED lights up orange or goes out respective to their individual settings.

Adjust the settings as needed. The individual settings are stored for the driver profile currently in use.

Press button again: - All Intelligent Safety systems are switched on. - The LED lights up green.

Hold down button: - All Intelligent Safety systems are switched off.

- The LED goes out.

Approach control warning with city light braking function

Concept

The system may prevent some accidents. In the event of an accident, the system may reduce impact speed.

The system sounds a warning before an imminent collision and activates brakes independently, if needed.

The Brake Assistant function activates and applies the brakes with limited force and duration.

A camera at the base of the interior mirror controls the system.

The approach control warning is available even if cruise control has been deactivated.

With the vehicle approaching another vehicle intentionally, the approach control warning and braking are delayed in order to avoid false system reactions.

General information

The system warns at two levels of an imminent danger of collision at speeds from approx. 3 mph/5 km/h. The timing of warnings may vary with the current driving situation.

Braking is performed at speeds up to approximately 35 mph/60 km/h.

Detection range
MINI Countryman (2020) - General information - 1

natural_image Top-down view of three cars on a road with a triangular light source, no text or symbols visible

Objects that the system can detect are taken into account.

Safety information

Warning

The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment in assessing visibility and traffic situation. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Warning

Indicators and warnings cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment. Due to its limits, the system may not issue warnings or reactions, or these may be issued late or in a manner that is not consistent with their normal use. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Warning

Due to system limits, individual functions can malfunction during tow-starting/towing with the Intelligent Safety systems activated. There is a risk of accident. Switch all Intelligent Safety systems off prior to tow-starting/towing.

Overview

Button in the vehicle
MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and dashboard (no visible text or symbols)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 2

Intelligent Safety button

Camera
MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 3

natural_image Front view of a car with an upward arrow symbol on the windshield (no text or labels)

The camera is installed near the interior mirror.

Keep the windshield in front of the interior mirror clean and clear.

Switching on/off

Switching on automatically

The system is automatically active after every driving off.

Switching on/off manually

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off manually - 1

Press button briefly:

- The menu for the Intelligent Safety system is displayed. The systems are individually switched off according to their respective settings.

- LED lights up orange or goes out respective to their individual settings.

Adjust the settings as needed. The individual settings are stored for the driver profile currently in use.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off manually - 2

Press button again:

- All Intelligent Safety systems are switched on.

- The LED lights up green.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off manually - 3

Hold down button:

- All Intelligent Safety systems are switched off.

- The LED goes out.

Setting the warning time

The warning time can be set via the Central Information Display (CID).

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "Vehicle settings"

  3. "Intelligent Safety"

  4. "Warning time"

  5. Select the desired setting.

The selected warning time is stored for the driver profile currently in use.

Warning with braking function

Display

If a collision with a vehicle detected in this way is imminent, a warning symbol appears on the instrument cluster.

Symbol Measure

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Measure - 1

Symbol lights up red: prewarning.

Brake and increase distance.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Measure - 2

Symbol flashes red and an acoustic signal sounds: acute warning.

Brake and make an evasive maneuver, if necessary.

Prewarning

This warning is provided, for instance when there is impending danger of a collision or the distance to the vehicle ahead is too small.

If a prewarning is provided, respond by braking as warranted.

Acute warning with braking function

An acute warning is displayed when there is an imminent danger of collision due to the vehicle approaching another object at a high speed.

The driver must intervene actively when there is an acute warning. If necessary, the driver is assisted by a minor automatic braking intervention in a possible risk of collision.

Acute warnings may be provided even when there has been no prior warning.

Braking intervention

The warning prompts the driver to intervene. During a warning, the maximum braking force is used. In order to activate the

Brake Assistant function, you must apply the brakes quickly and forcefully. If there is a risk of collision, the system may assist with braking. When the vehicle is traveling at a low speed, the vehicle may come to a complete stop.

Manual transmission: during a braking intervention up to a complete stop, the engine may be shut down.

The braking intervention occurs only if vehicle stability has not been restricted, for instance by deactivating the DSC Dynamic Stability Control.

The driver may interrupt the braking intervention function by stepping on the accelerator pedal or by actively moving the steering wheel.

The system's ability to detect objects may be limited in some circumstances. Refer to the information in this Owner's Manual regarding the limitations of the system and actively intervene as warranted.

System limits

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

The system is designed to operate in certain conditions and circumstances. Due to conditions or other factors, the system may not respond. There may be a risk of accident or risk of damage to property. Actively intervene as warranted. Refer to the information in this Owner's Manual regarding the scope of the system's operation and limitations.

Detection range

The system's detection potential is limited.

Thus, a system reaction might not come or might come late.

The following situations may not be detected, for example:

  • Slow moving vehicles when you approach them at high speed.
  • Vehicles that suddenly swerve in front of you, or sharply decelerating vehicles.
  • Vehicles with an unusual rear appearance.
  • Two-wheeled vehicles ahead of you.

Functional limitations

The system may not be fully functional in the following situations:

  • In heavy fog, wet conditions, or snowfall.
  • In tight curves.
  • If the field of view of the camera or the windshield is dirty or covered.
  • If the driving stability control systems are deactivated, for instance DSC OFF.
  • Up to 10 seconds after the start of the engine via the Start/Stop button.
    – During calibration of the camera immediately after vehicle delivery.
  • If there are constant blinding effects because of oncoming light, for instance from the sun low in the sky.

Warning sensitivity

The more sensitive the warning settings are, the more warnings are displayed.

Therefore, there may also be an excess of premature or unjustified warnings and reactions.

Daytime pedestrian collision mitigation

Concept

The system may prevent some accidents with pedestrians.

When driving at city speeds, the system will issue a warning if there is imminent risk of a collision with pedestrians, and support this with a light braking function.

The camera at the base of the interior mirror controls the system.

General information

In sufficiently bright conditions, the system issues a warning of a possible risk of collision with pedestrians in the speed range from approx. 6 mph/10 km/h to approx. 35 mph/60 km/h

The system reacts to people who are within the detection range of the system.

Detection range
MINI Countryman (2020) - General information - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Car"] --> B["Path 1"]
    A --> C["Path 2"]
    A --> D["Path 2"]

The detection area in front of the vehicle is divided into two areas:

- Central area, arrow 1, directly in front of the vehicle.

- Expanded area, arrow 2, to the right and left of the central area.

A collision is imminent if pedestrians are located within the central area. A warning is issued about pedestrians who are located

within the extended area only if they are moving in the direction of the central area.

Safety information

Warning

The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment in assessing visibility and traffic situation. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Warning

Indicators and warnings cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment. Due to its limits, the system may not issue warnings or reactions, or these may be issued late or in a manner that is not consistent with their normal use. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Warning

Due to system limits, individual functions can malfunction during tow-starting/towing with the Intelligent Safety systems activated. There is a risk of accident. Switch all Intelligent Safety systems off prior to tow-starting/towing.

Overview

Button in the vehicle

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button in the vehicle - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and air vent (no visible text or symbols)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button in the vehicle - 2

Intelligent Safety button

Camera

MINI Countryman (2020) - Camera - 1

natural_image Front view of a car with an upward arrow symbol on the windshield (no text or labels)

The camera is installed near the interior mirror.

Keep the windshield in front of the interior mirror clean and clear.

Switching on/off

Switching on automatically

The system is automatically active after every driving off.

Switching on/off manually

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off manually - 1

Press button briefly:

- The menu for the Intelligent Safety system is displayed. The systems are individually

switched off according to their respective settings.

- LED lights up orange or goes out respective to their individual settings.

Adjust the settings as needed. The individual settings are stored for the driver profile currently in use.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off manually - 2

Press button again:

- All Intelligent Safety systems are switched on.

- The LED lights up green.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off manually - 3

Hold down button:

- All Intelligent Safety systems are switched off.

- The LED goes out.

Warning with braking function

Display

If a collision with a person detected in this way is imminent, a warning symbol appears on the instrument cluster.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Display - 1

The red symbol is displayed and a signal sounds.

Intervene immediately by braking or make an evasive maneuver.

Braking intervention

The warning prompts the driver to intervene. During a warning, the maximum braking force is used. In order to activate the Brake Assistant function, you must apply the brakes quickly and forcefully. If there is a risk of collision, the system may assist with braking. When the vehicle is traveling at a low speed, the vehicle may come to a complete stop.

Manual transmission: during a braking intervention up to a complete stop, the engine may be shut down.

The braking intervention occurs only if vehicle stability has not been restricted, for instance by deactivating the DSC Dynamic Stability Control.

The driver may interrupt the braking intervention function by stepping on the accelerator pedal or by actively moving the steering wheel.

The system's ability to detect objects may be limited in some circumstances. Refer to the information in this Owner's Manual regarding the limitations of the system and actively intervene as warranted.

System limits

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

The system is designed to operate in certain conditions and circumstances. Due to conditions or other factors, the system may not respond. There may be a risk of accident or risk of damage to property. Actively intervene as warranted. Refer to the information in this Owner's Manual regarding the scope of the system's operation and limitations.

Detection range

The detection potential of the camera is limited.

Thus, a warning might not be issued or be issued late.

The following situations may not be detected, for example:

  • Partially covered pedestrians.
  • Pedestrians that are not detected as such because of the viewing angle or contour.
  • Pedestrians outside of the detection range.

- Pedestrians having a body size less than 32 in/80 cm.

Functional limitations

The system may not be fully functional or may not be available in the following situations:

  • In heavy fog, wet conditions, or snowfall.
  • In tight curves.
  • If the field of view of the camera or the windshield is dirty or covered.
  • If the driving stability control systems are deactivated, for instance DSC OFF.
  • Up to 10 seconds after the start of the engine via the Start/Stop button.
  • During calibration of the camera immediately after vehicle delivery.
  • If there are constant blinding effects because of oncoming light, for instance from the sun low in the sky.
  • When it is dark outside.

Brake force display

Concept

Additional brake lights indicate emergency braking to the traffic behind. This can reduce the risk of a rear-end collision.

General information

MINI Countryman (2020) - General information - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's front and side views showing the illuminated camera lens (no text or symbols visible)

- During normal brake application, the brake lights light up.

– During heavy brake application, the flashers additionally light up.

PostCrash - iBrake

Concept

In the event of an accident, the system can bring the vehicle to a halt automatically without intervention by the driver in certain situations. This can reduce the risk of a further collision and the consequences thereof.

At standstill

After coming to a halt, the brake is released automatically. Secure the vehicle against rolling.

Harder vehicle braking

In certain situations, it can be necessary to bring the vehicle to a halt more quickly than the Brake Assistant allows.

To do this, quickly apply extra force to the brake. For a brief period, the braking pressure will be higher than the braking pressure that is achieved by the automatic braking function. This interrupts automatic braking.

Interrupting automatic braking

It can be necessary to interrupt automatic braking in certain situations, for instance for an evasive maneuver.

Interrupt automatic braking:

- By pressing the brake pedal.

- By pressing the accelerator pedal.

Driving stability control systems

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Anti-lock Braking System ABS

ABS prevents locking of the wheels during braking.

The vehicle maintains its steering power even during full brake applications, thus increasing active safety.

ABS is operational every time you start the engine.

Brake assistant

When you apply the brakes rapidly, this system automatically boosts the vehicle braking capability to the furthest possible extent. It reduces the braking distance to a minimum during an emergency stop. This system utilizes all of the capabilities provided by the Antilock Brake System ABS.

Do not reduce the pressure on the brake pedal for the duration of the emergency stop.

DSC Dynamic Stability Control

Concept

Within the physical limits, the system helps to keep the vehicle on a steady course by reducing engine speed and by applying brakes to the individual wheels.

General information

DSC detects the following unstable driving conditions, for instance:

  • Fishtailing, which can lead to oversteering.
  • Loss of traction of the front wheels, which can lead to understeering.

Dynamic Traction Control DTC, refer to page 167, is a version of the DSC where forward momentum is optimized.

Safety information

Warning

The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment in assessing the traffic conditions. Based on the limits of the system, it cannot independently react to all traffic situations. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Warning

When driving with a roof load, for instance with roof-mounted luggage rack, the vehicle's center of gravity is higher, which increases the risk of the vehicle tipping in critical driving situations. There

may be a risk of accident or risk of damage to property. Do not deactivate DSC Dynamic Stability Control when driving with roof load.

Indicator/warning lights

MINI Countryman (2020) - Indicator/warning lights - 1

The indicator light flashes: DSC controls the drive and braking forces.

The indicator light lights up: DSC has malfunctioned.

Deactivating DSC: DSC OFF

General information

When DSC is deactivated, driving stability is reduced during acceleration and when driving in curves.

To increase vehicle stability, activate DSC again as soon as possible.

Deactivating DSC

MINI Countryman (2020) - Deactivating DSC - 1

Press and hold this button but not longer than approx. 10 seconds, until the indicator light for DSC OFF

lights up in the instrument cluster and displays DSC OFF.

DSC is switched off.

Activating DSC

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating DSC - 1

Press the button.

DSC OFF and the DSC OFF indicator

light go out.

Indicator/warning lights

When DSC is deactivated, DSC OFF is displayed in the instrument cluster.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Indicator/warning lights - 1

The indicator light lights up: DSC is deactivated.

Automatic activation

When DSC is deactivated, automatic activation occurs in the following situations:

- The vehicle has a flat tire.

- When activating cruise control in TRACTION or DSC OFF mode.

DTC Dynamic Traction Control

Concept

DTC is a version of the DSC Dynamic Stability Control where forward momentum is optimized.

The system ensures maximum headway on special road conditions, for instance unplowed snowy roads or loose road surfaces, but with somewhat limited vehicle stability.

When DTC is activated, the vehicle has maximum traction. Driving stability is limited during acceleration and when driving in curves.

Drive carefully.

You may find it useful to briefly activate DTC under the following special circumstances:

- When driving in slush or on uncleared, snow-covered roads.

- When driving off from deep snow or loose ground.

- When driving with snow chains.

Deactivating/activating DTC Dynamic Traction Control

Activating DTC

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating DTC - 1

Press the button.

TRACTION is displayed in the instrument cluster and the indicator light for DSC OFF lights up.

Deactivating DTC

MINI Countryman (2020) - Deactivating DTC - 1

Press the button again.

TRACTION and the DSC OFF indicator light go out.

Performance Control

Performance Control enhances the agility of the vehicle.

To increase maneuverability, wheels are braked individually when a sporty driving style is used.

ALL4

ALL4 is the all-wheel-drive system of your vehicle. Concerted action by ALL4 and DSC Dynamic Stability Control further optimizes traction and driving dynamics. The ALL4 all-wheel-drive system variably distributes the driving forces to the front and rear axles as demanded by the driving situation and road surface.

Adaptive chassis

Concept

The tuning of the suspension can be changed with the system.

The system offers several different programs.

The programs are selected via the MINI Driving Modes switch.

Programs

MID/GREEN

Balanced tuning of the shock absorbers for more comfort.

SPORT

Consistently sporty tuning of the shock absorbers for greater driving agility.

MINI Driving Modes switch

Concept

The MINI Driving Modes switch helps to fine-tune the vehicle's settings and features. Choose between three different programs.

Pressing the MINI Driving Modes switch will activate the particular program.

Operating the programs

MINI Driving Modes switch Program

SPORT
GREEN

SPORT

MID

GREEN

MID

MID provides balanced tuning.

With each starting operation, MID is activated using the Start/Stop button.

GREEN

Concept

GREEN, refer to page 228, provides consistent tuning to maximize range.

Activating GREEN

Press the MINI Driving Modes switch downward until GREEN is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Configuring GREEN

Via MINI Driving Modes switch

  1. Activate GREEN.
  2. "Configure GREEN"
  3. Configure the program.
    This configuration is retrieved when GREEN is activated.

Via the Central Information Display (CID)

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. If necessary, "Driving mode"
  4. "Configure GREEN"
  5. Select the desired setting.

This configuration is retrieved when GREEN is activated.

SPORT

Concept

Consistently sporty tuning of the drivetrain for greater driving agility.

Depending on the vehicle equipment, the tuning of the chassis and suspension also changes and SPORT can be individually configured.

The configuration is stored for the driver profile currently in use.

Activating SPORT

Press the MINI Driving Modes switch upward until SPORT is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Configuring SPORT

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. If necessary, "Driving mode"
  4. "Configure SPORT"
  5. Select the desired setting.

This configuration is retrieved when SPORT is activated.

Configuring driving program

Settings can be made for the following driving programs in Driving mode:

  • GREEN, refer to page 168.
  • SPORT, refer to page 169.

Displays

Program selection

MINI Countryman (2020) - Program selection - 1

Pressing the MINI Driving Modes switch displays a list of programs, which can be selected.

Selected program

MINI Countryman (2020) - Selected program - 1

The instrument cluster displays the selected program.

Drive-off assistant

Concept

This system supports driving off on uphill grades. The parking brake is not required.

Driving off with the drive-off assistant

  1. Hold the vehicle in place with the foot brake.
  2. Release the foot brake and drive off without delay.

After the foot brake is released, the vehicle is held in place for approx. 2 seconds.

Servotronic

Servotronic is a speed-dependent power steering function.

The system provides the steering force with more support at low speeds than at higher ones. This makes it easier to park, for instance, and makes steering firmer when driving at faster speeds.

Furthermore, the steering force adapts according to the driving program, so that a firm, sporty feel or a comfortable steering response is conveyed.

Driving comfort

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Camera-based cruise control

Concept

Using this system, a desired speed and a distance to a vehicle ahead can be adjusted using the buttons on the steering wheel.

The system maintains the desired speed on clear roads. For this purpose, the vehicle accelerates or brakes automatically.

If a vehicle is driving ahead of you, the system adjusts the speed of your vehicle so that the set distance to the vehicle ahead is maintained. The speed is adjusted as far as the given situation allows.

The distance can be adjusted in several steps. For safety reasons, it depends on the respective speed.

With the Stop&Go function for Steptronic transmissions: if the vehicle ahead of you brakes to a halt, and then proceeds to drive again shortly thereafter, the system is able to detect this within the given system limits.

General information

A camera on the interior mirror is used to detect vehicles driving ahead.

Depending on the settings, the characteristics of cruise control many change in certain ranges.

Safety information

Warning

The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment in assessing the traffic conditions. Based on the limits of the system, it cannot independently react to all traffic situations. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Warning

The desired speed can be incorrectly adjusted or called up by mistake. There is a risk of accident. Adjust the desired speed to the traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Warning

Risk of accident due to too high speed differences to other vehicles, for instance in the following situations:

- When fast approaching a slowly moving vehicle.

- Vehicle suddenly swerving into own lane.

- When fast approaching standing vehicles.

There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

An unsecured vehicle can begin to move and possibly roll away. There is a risk of accident. Before exiting, secure the vehicle against rolling.

In order to ensure that the vehicle is secured against rolling away, follow the following:

  • Set the parking brake.
  • On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, turn the front wheels in the direction of the curb.
  • On uphill grades or on a downhill slope, also secure the vehicle, for instance with a wheel chock.

Overview

Buttons on the steering wheel

Button Function

Cruise control on/off, refer to page 173.
SETStore/maintain speed, refer to page 173.
RES CNCLPause cruise control, refer to page 173.Continue cruise control with the last setting, refer to page 174.
Reduce distance, refer to page 174.
Increase the distance, refer to page 174.

Button Function
MINI Countryman (2020) - Buttons on the steering wheel - 1

Increase speed, refer to page 173.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Buttons on the steering wheel - 2

Reduce speed, refer to page 173.

Buttons are arranged according to vehicle's series, optional features and country specifications.

Camera

MINI Countryman (2020) - Camera - 1

natural_image Front view of a car with a white upward arrow symbol on the windshield (no text or labels)

The camera is installed near the interior mirror.

Keep the windshield in front of the interior mirror clean and clear.

Functional requirements

Speed range

The system is best used on well-constructed roads.

The system is functional at speeds beginning at approx. 20 mph/30 km/h.

With the Stop&Go function for Steptronic transmissions: the system can also be activated while the vehicle is stationary.

The max. speed that can be set is 85 mph/140 km/h.

Manual transmission: Active Cruise Control is interrupted below a speed of approx. 20 mph/30 km/h. The system does not brake to a stop.

Switching on/off and interrupting cruise control

Switching on

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 1

Press the button on the steering wheel.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 2

Display in the instrument cluster lights up.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 3

Display in the instrument cluster lights up. The current speed is adopted as desired speed and diswith symbol.

Cruise control is active and maintains the set speed.

DSC Dynamic Stability Control is switched on, if necessary.

Switching off

With the Stop&Go function for Steptronic transmissions: when switching off while stationary, depress the brake pedal simultaneously.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching off - 1

Press the button on the steering wheel.

The displays go out. The stored desired speed is deleted.

Interrupting manually

MINI Countryman (2020) - Interrupting manually - 1

Press the button on the steering wheel.

With the Stop&Go function for Steptronic transmissions: when interrupting while stationary, depress the brake pedal simultaneously.

Interrupting automatically

The system is automatically interrupted in the following situations:

- When the driver applies the brakes.

- Manual transmission: when the clutch pedal is depressed for a few seconds or released while a gear is not engaged.

- If selector lever position N is set.

- Dynamic Traction Control DTC is activated or DSC Dynamic Stability Control is deactivated.

- If DSC Dynamic Stability Control intervenes.

- If the detection range of the camera is impaired, for instance by soiling, heavy precipitation or glare effects from the sun.

- Manual transmission: if the vehicle in front decelerates below a speed of approx. 20 mph/30 km/h.

- With the Stop&Go function for Steptronic transmissions: following a stationary period of approx. 3 seconds, after the vehicle was braked to a stop by the system.

Setting the speed

Maintaining/storing the speed

Press +or button in the interrupted state.

When the system is switched on, the current speed is maintained and stored as the desired speed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Maintaining/storing the speed - 1

The stored speed is displayed on the symbol.

DSC Dynamic Stability Control is switched on, if necessary.

The speed can also be stored as follows:

MINI Countryman (2020) - Maintaining/storing the speed - 2

Press the button.

Changing the speed

+ or —button: press until the desired speed is set.

If active, the displayed speed is stored and the vehicle reaches the stored speed when the road is clear.

  • or button: each time it is pressed to the point of resistance, the desired speed increases or decreases by approx. 1 mph/1 km/h.
  • or button: each time it is pressed past the resistance point, the desired speed changes by a maximum of 5 mph/10 km/h.
  • or -button: hold down to repeat the action.

Adjusting the distance

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment. Due to the system limits, braking can be late. There may be a risk of accident or risk of damage to property. Be aware to the traffic situation at all times. Adjust the distance to the traffic and weather conditions and maintain the prescribed safety distance, possibly by braking.

Reduce distance

MINI Countryman (2020) - Reduce distance - 1

Press the button repeatedly until the desired distance is set.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Reduce distance - 2

The set distance is briefly displayed in the left part of the instrument cluster.

Increase the distance

MINI Countryman (2020) - Increase the distance - 1

Press the button repeatedly until the desired distance is set.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Increase the distance - 2

The set distance is briefly displayed in the left part of the instrument cluster.

Continuing cruise control

General information

An interrupted cruise control can be continued by calling up the stored speed.

Make sure that the difference between current speed and stored speed is not too large before calling up the stored speed. Otherwise, unintentional braking or accelerating may occur.

In the following cases, the stored speed value is deleted and cannot be called up again:

  • When the system is switched off.
  • When the ignition is switched off.

Calling up the stored speed and distance

MINI Countryman (2020) - Calling up the stored speed and distance - 1

Press the button with the system interrupted. Cruise control is continued with the stored values. The se-

lected distance is briefly displayed in the Info Display.

Switching distance control on/off

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

The system does not react to traffic driving ahead of you, but instead maintains the stored speed. There may be a risk of accident or risk of damage to property. Ad-

just the desired speed to the traffic conditions and brake as needed.

Switching distance control off

Distance control can be switched off and on when driving with cruise control activated.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching distance control off - 1

Press and hold this button.

Or:

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching distance control off - 2

Press and hold this button.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching distance control off - 3

The indicator light in the instrument cluster lights up.

To switch distance control back on, press one of the two buttons again briefly.

After changing over distance control, a Check Control message is displayed.

Displays in the instrument cluster

Desired speed and stored speed

MINI Countryman (2020) - Desired speed and stored speed - 1

In addition to the indicator light, the desired speed is displayed in the Info Display.

  • Display lights up green: system is active, the display indicates the desired speed.
  • Display lights up orange: system is interrupted, the display indicates the stored speed.
  • No display: system is switched off.

If no speed is indicated, it is possible that the conditions necessary for operation are not currently fulfilled.

Distance to vehicle ahead of you

Selected distance from the vehicle driving ahead is briefly displayed in the left hand portion of the Info Display.

Distance display

MINI Countryman (2020) - Distance display - 1

Distance 1

MINI Countryman (2020) - Distance display - 2

Distance 2

MINI Countryman (2020) - Distance display - 3

Distance 3

MINI Countryman (2020) - Distance display - 4

Distance 4

This value is set automatically after the system is switched on.

Detected vehicle

MINI Countryman (2020) - Detected vehicle - 1

Symbol lights up orange:

A vehicle has been detected ahead of you.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Detected vehicle - 2

With the Stop&Go function for Steptronic transmissions:

Rolling bars: the detected vehicle

has driven away.

ACC does not accelerate. To accelerate, activate ACC as follows:

  • By briefly pressing the accelerator pedal.
  • By pressing the RES CNCL button.
  • By pressing the or button.

Indicator/warning lights

MINI Countryman (2020) - Indicator/warning lights - 1

Symbol flashes orange:

The conditions are not adequate for the system to work.

The system was deactivated but applies the brakes until you actively resume control by pressing on the brake pedal or accelerator pedal.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Indicator/warning lights - 2

Symbol flashes red and a signal sounds:

Brake and make an evasive maneuver, if necessary.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Indicator/warning lights - 3

The system has been interrupted or distance control is temporarily suppressed because the accelerator

pedal is being pressed; a vehicle was not detected.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Indicator/warning lights - 4

Distance control is temporarily suppressed because the accelerator pedal is being pressed; a vehicle was

detected.

System limits

Detection range
MINI Countryman (2020) - System limits - 1

natural_image Top-down view of three cars on a road with a triangular light source, no text or symbols visible

The detection capacity of the system and the automatic braking capacity are limited. Two-wheeled vehicles for instance might not be detected.

Deceleration

The system does not decelerate in the following situations:

  • For pedestrians, cyclists or similarly slow-moving road users.
  • For red traffic lights.
  • For cross traffic.
  • For oncoming traffic.

- Unlit vehicles or vehicles with nonworking lighting at night.

Swerving vehicles
MINI Countryman (2020) - Deceleration - 1

natural_image Top-down diagram of two cars on a road with a curved arrow indicating direction (no text or symbols)

A vehicle driving in front of you is not detected until it is completely within the same lane as your vehicle.

If a vehicle driving ahead of you suddenly swerves into your lane, the system may not be able to automatically restore the selected distance. It may not be possible to restore the selected distance in certain situations, including if you are driving significantly faster than vehicles driving ahead of you, for instance when rapidly approaching a truck. When a vehicle driving ahead of you is reliably detected, the system requests that the driver intervene by braking and carrying out evasive maneuvers, if needed.

With the Stop&Go function for Steptronic transmissions: driving off

In some situations, the vehicle cannot drive off automatically; for example:

  • On steep uphill grades.
  • In front of bumps in the road.

In these cases, press on the accelerator pedal.

Cornering

MINI Countryman (2020) - Cornering - 1

natural_image Top-down view of two cars driving on a curved road, no text or symbols visible

If the desired speed is too high for a curve, the speed is reduced slightly, although curves cannot be anticipated in advance. Therefore, drive into a curve at an appropriate speed.

The system has a limited detection range. Situations can arise in tight curves where a vehicle driving ahead will not be detected or will be detected very late.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Cornering - 2

natural_image Top-down view of two cars on a curved road with dashed lane markings (no text or symbols)

When you approach a curve the system may briefly report vehicles in the next lane due to the bend of the curve. If the system decelerates you may compensate it by briefly accelerating. After releasing the accelerator pedal the system is reactivated and controls speed independently.

Weather

The following restrictions can occur under unfavorable weather or light conditions:

  • Poorer vehicle recognition.
  • Short-term interruptions for vehicles that are already recognized.

Examples of unfavorable weather or light conditions:

  • Wet conditions.
  • Snowfall.
  • Slush.
  • Fog.
  • Glare.

Drive attentively, and react to the current traffic situation. If necessary, intervene actively, for instance by braking, steering or evading.

Engine power

The desired speed may not be maintained on uphill grades if engine power is insufficient.

Malfunction

A Check Control message is displayed if the system fails or was automatically deactivated.

The system may not be fully functional in the following situations:

  • When an object was not correctly detected.
  • In heavy fog, wet conditions, or snowfall.
  • In tight curves.
  • If the field of view of the camera or the windshield is dirty or covered.
  • When driving toward bright lights.
  • Up to 20 seconds after the start of the engine, via the Start/Stop button.
    – During calibration of the camera immediately after vehicle delivery.

Cruise control

Concept

Using this system, a desired speed can be adjusted using the buttons on the steering wheel. The system maintains the desired speed. The system accelerates and brakes automatically as needed.

General information

The system is functional at speeds beginning at approx. 20 mph/30 km/h.

Depending on the settings, the cruise control settings many change under certain conditions.

Safety information

Warning

The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment in assessing the traffic conditions. Based on the limits of the system, it cannot independently react to all traffic situations. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Warning

The use of the system can lead to an increased risk of accidents in the following situations, for instance:

  • On winding roads.
  • In heavy traffic.
  • On slippery roads, in fog, snow, or wet conditions, or on a loose road surface.

There may be a risk of accident or risk of damage to property. Only use the system if driving at constant speed is possible.

Overview

Buttons on the steering wheel

Button Function

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button Function - 1

Cruise control on/off, refer to page 178.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button Function - 2

Store speed, refer to page 179.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button Function - 3

Pause cruise control, refer to page 178.

Continue cruise control with the last setting, refer to page 179.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button Function - 4

Increase speed, refer to page 179.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Button Function - 5

Reduce speed, refer to page 179.

Switching on/off and interrupting cruise control

Switching on

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 1

Press the button on the steering wheel.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 2

The indicator light in the instrument cluster lights up.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on - 3

The current speed is adopted as the desired speed and is displayed with the symbol in the instrument cluster.

Cruise control is active and maintains the set speed.

DSC Dynamic Stability Control is switched on, if necessary.

Switching off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching off - 1

Press the button on the steering wheel.

The displays go out. The stored desired speed is deleted.

Interrupting manually

MINI Countryman (2020) - Interrupting manually - 1

When active, press the button on the steering wheel.

Interrupting automatically

The system is automatically interrupted in the following situations:

  • When the driver applies the brakes.
  • If the clutch pedal is depressed for a few seconds or released while a gear is not engaged.
  • If the gear engaged is too high for the current speed.
  • If selector lever position N is set.
  • Dynamic Traction Control DTC is activated or DSC Dynamic Stability Control is deactivated.
  • If DSC Dynamic Stability Control intervenes.

Setting the speed

Maintaining/storing the speed

Press +or button in the interrupted state.

When the system is switched on, the current speed is maintained and stored as the desired speed.

The stored speed is displayed in the instrument cluster.

DSC Dynamic Stability Control is switched on, if necessary.

The speed can also be stored as follows:

MINI Countryman (2020) - Maintaining/storing the speed - 1

Press the button.

Changing the speed

+ or —button: press until the desired speed is set.

If active, the displayed speed is stored and the vehicle reaches the stored speed when the road is clear.

  • or button: each time it is pressed to the point of resistance, the desired speed increases or decreases by approx. 1 mph/1 km/h.
  • or button: each time it is pressed past the resistance point, the desired speed changes by a maximum of 5 mph/10 km/h.
  • or button: pressing it to the resistance point and holding it accelerates or decelerates the vehicle without requiring pressure on the accelerator pedal. After the button is released, the vehicle maintains its final speed. Pressing the switch beyond the resistance point causes the vehicle to accelerate more rapidly.

Continuing cruise control

General information

An interrupted cruise control can be continued by calling up the stored speed.

Make sure that the difference between current speed and stored speed is not too large before calling up the stored speed. Otherwise, unintentional braking or accelerating may occur.

Calling up the stored speed

MINI Countryman (2020) - Calling up the stored speed - 1

Press the button on the steering wheel.

The stored speed is reached again and maintained.

Displays in the instrument cluster

Indicator light

MINI Countryman (2020) - Indicator light - 1

Depending on how the vehicle is equipped, the indicator light in the instrument cluster indicates whether

the system is switched on.

Desired speed and stored speed

MINI Countryman (2020) - Desired speed and stored speed - 1

The desired speed is displayed together with the symbol.

- Display lights up green: system is active, the display indicates the desired speed.

  • Display lights up orange: system is interrupted, the display indicates the stored speed.
  • No display: system is switched off.

If no speed is indicated, it is possible that the conditions necessary for operation are not currently fulfilled.

System limits

Engine power

The desired speed is also maintained downhill, but may not be maintained on uphill grades if engine power is insufficient.

PDC Park Distance Control

Concept

PDC is a support when parking. The system detects objects behind the vehicle. If the vehicle is equipped with front PDC, objects in front of the vehicle are detected too. Objects that you are approaching slowly are indicated by signal tones and a visual display.

General information

The ultrasound sensors for measuring the distances are located in the bumpers.

The delete range, depending on obstacles and environmental conditions, is approx. 6 ft/2 m.

An acoustic warning is first given in the following situations:

  • By the front middle sensors and the two corner sensors at approx. 24 in/60 cm from the object.
  • By the rear middle sensors at approx. 5 ft/1.50 m from the object.
  • When a collision is imminent.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment in assessing the traffic conditions. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic and vehicle surroundings closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

Due to high speeds when PDC Park Distance Control is activated, the warning can be delayed due to physical circumstances. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Avoid approaching an object too fast. Avoid driving off fast while PDC Park Distance Control is not yet active.

Overview

With front PDC: button in vehicle

MINI Countryman (2020) - With front PDC: button in vehicle - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's front wheel hub with multiple white buttons and a central knob (no text or symbols visible)

MINI Countryman (2020) - With front PDC: button in vehicle - 2

Park assistance button

Ultrasound sensors

MINI Countryman (2020) - Ultrasound sensors - 1

Ultrasound sensors of the PDC, for instance in the bumpers.

Functional requirements

Ensure full functionality:

  • Do not cover sensors, for instance with stickers, bicycle racks.
  • Keep the sensors clean and unobstructed.

Switching on/off

Switching on automatically

The system switches on automatically in the following situations:

  • If selector lever position R is engaged when the engine is running.
    The rearview camera also switches on.

- With front PDC: when obstacles are detected behind or in front of the vehicle by PDC and the speed is slower than approx. 2.5 mph/4 km/h.

With front PDC: automatic activation on obstacle detection can be switched off. Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. "Parking"
  4. "Automatic PDC activation": depending on the vehicle equipment.
  5. "Automatic PDC activation" The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Automatic deactivation during forward travel

The system switches off when a certain driving distance or speed is exceeded. Switch the system back on, if needed.

With front PDC: switching on/off manually

MINI Countryman (2020) - With front PDC: switching on/off manually - 1

Press the park assistance button.

  • On: the LED lights up.
  • Off: the LED goes out.

The rearview camera image is displayed if the reverse gear is engaged when pressing the park assistance button.

Warning

Signal tones

An intermittent tone indicates when the vehicle is approaching an object. For instance, if an object is detected to the left rear of the vehicle, a signal tone sounds from the left rear speaker.

The shorter the distance to the object, the shorter the intervals.

If the distance to a detected object is less than approx. 10 inches/25 cm, a continuous tone is sounded.

With front PDC: if objects are simultaneously located both in front of and behind the vehicle, an alternating continuous signal is sounded.

The signal tone is switched off, when selector lever position P is engaged on vehicles with Steptronic transmission.

Volume

The ratio of the PDC signal tone volume to the entertainment volume can be adjusted.

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Tone"
  4. "Volume settings"
  5. "PDC"
  6. Set the desired value.

The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Visual warning

The approach of the vehicle to an object can be shown on the Control Display. Objects that are farther away are already displayed on the Control Display before a signal sounds.

A display appears as soon as Park Distance Control (PDC) is activated.

The range of the sensors is represented in colors: red, green and yellow.

When the image of the rearview camera is displayed, the switch can be made to PDC:

MINI Countryman (2020) - Visual warning - 1

"Rear view camera"

System limits

Safety information

Warning

The system is designed to operate in certain conditions and circumstances. Due to conditions or other factors, the system may not respond. There may be a risk of accident or risk of damage to property. Actively intervene as warranted. Refer to the information in this Owner's Manual regarding the scope of the system's operation and limitations.

Limits of ultrasonic measurement

Ultrasonic measuring might not function under the following circumstances:

  • For small children and animals.
  • For persons with certain clothing, for instance coats.
  • With external interference of the ultrasound, for instance from passing vehicles or loud machines.
  • When sensors are dirty, iced over, damaged or out of position.
  • If cargo protrudes.
  • Under certain weather conditions such as high relative humidity, wet conditions, snowfall, extreme heat, or strong wind.
  • With tow bars and trailer couplings of other vehicles.
  • With thin or wedge-shaped objects.
  • With moving objects.
  • With elevated, protruding objects such as ledges or cargo.
  • With objects with corners and sharp edges.

  • With objects with a fine surface structure such as fences.

  • For objects with porous surfaces.
  • Low objects already displayed, for instance curbs, can move into the blind area of the sensors before or after a continuous tone sounds.

False warnings

The system may issue a warning under the following conditions even though there is no obstacle within the detection range:

  • In heavy rain.
  • When sensors are very dirty or covered with ice.
  • When sensors are covered in snow.

- On rough road surfaces.

- On uneven surfaces, such as speed bumps.

- In large buildings with right angles and smooth walls, for instance in underground garages.

- In automatic vehicle washes.

- Due to heavy exhaust.

- Due to other ultrasound sources, for instance sweeping machines, high pressure steam cleaners or neon lights.

The malfunction is signaled by a continuous tone alternating between the front and rear speakers. As soon as the malfunction due to other ultrasound sources is no longer present, the system is again fully functional.

With front PDC: to reduce false alarms, switch off automatic PDC activation on obstacle detection, for instance in vehicle washes; see Switching on/off.

Malfunction

A Check Control message is displayed in the instrument cluster.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Malfunction - 1

Red symbol is displayed, and the range of the sensors is dimmed on the Control Display.

PDC has failed. Have the system checked by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Rearview camera

Concept

The rearview camera provides assistance in parking and maneuvering backwards. The area behind the vehicle is shown on the Control Display.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment in assessing the traffic conditions. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic and vehicle surroundings closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

Overview

Depending on the vehicle equipment: button in the vehicle

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's front-mounted air vent with multiple white filter knobs (no text or symbols visible)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 2

Park assistance button

Camera

MINI Countryman (2020) - Camera - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's front bumper with the Mini logo and an upward arrow indicator (no text or symbols beyond the logo)

The camera lens is located in the handle of the tailgate.

The image quality may be impaired by dirt. If necessary, clean the camera lens.

Switching on/off

Switching on automatically

The system is switched on automatically if selector lever position R is engaged when the engine is running.

Automatic deactivation during forward travel

The system switches off when a certain driving distance or speed is exceeded. Switch the system back on, if needed.

Depending on the vehicle equipment: switching on/off manually

MINI Countryman (2020) - Depending on the vehicle equipment: switching on/off manually - 1

Press the park assistance button.

  • On: the LED lights up.
  • Off: the LED goes out.

The parking assistance functions are shown on the Control Display.

Switching the view via the Central Information Display (CID)

If the rearview camera view is not displayed, change the view via the Central Information Display (CID):

"Rear view camera"

The rearview camera image is displayed.

Display on the Control Display

Functional requirement

  • The rearview camera is switched on.
  • The tailgate is fully closed.
  • Keep the recording range of the camera clear.

Protruding cargo or carrier systems and trailers that are not connected to a trailer power socket can lead to malfunctions.

Activating assistance functions

More than one assistance function can be active at the same time.

- Parking aid lines

"Parking aid lines"

Lanes and turning radius lines are indicated.

- Obstacle marking

P_G "Obstacle marking"

Obstacles are marked, depending on the vehicle equipment.

Pathway lines

MINI Countryman (2020) - Pathway lines - 1

natural_image Aerial view of a long, straight road leading into the distance from the center (no text or symbols visible)

Pathway lines can be superimposed on the image of the rearview camera.

Pathway lines help you to estimate the space required when parking and maneuvering on level roads.

Pathway lines depend on the current steering angle and are continuously adjusted to the steering wheel movements.

Turning radius lines

MINI Countryman (2020) - Turning radius lines - 1

natural_image Exterior view of a paved road with two curved lanes crossing through the center (no signage or text)

Turning radius lines can be superimposed on the image of the rearview camera.

Turning radius lines show the course of the smallest possible turning radius on a level road.

Only one turning radius line is displayed after the steering wheel is turned past a certain angle.

Obstacle marking

MINI Countryman (2020) - Obstacle marking - 1

natural_image Close-up of two vertical cylindrical components mounted on a curved surface with a grid pattern below (no text or symbols visible)

Depending on the vehicle equipment, obstacle markings can be faded into the image of the rearview camera.

The colored thresholds of the obstacle markings match the markings of the PDC Park Distance Control.

Parking using pathway and turning radius lines

  1. Position the vehicle so that the turning radius lines lead to within the limits of the parking space.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Parking using pathway and turning radius lines - 1

natural_image Exterior view of a road with parallel tracks and a triangular arch (no signage or text)
  1. Turn the steering wheel to the point where the pathway line covers the corresponding turning radius line.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Parking using pathway and turning radius lines - 2

natural_image Exterior view of a paved road with lane markings (no signage or text)

Display settings

Brightness

With the rearview camera switched on:

  1. Select the symbol.

  2. Turn the Controller until the desired setting is reached and press the Controller.

Contrast

With the rearview camera switched on:

  1. Select the symbol.

  2. Turn the Controller until the desired setting is reached and press the Controller.

System limits

Detection of objects

Very low obstacles or high, protruding objects such as ledges may not be recognized by the system.

Depending on the vehicle equipment, some assistance functions also consider data from the PDC Park Distance Control.

Follow the notes in the PDC Park Distance Control chapter.

The objects displayed on the Control Display may be closer than they appear. There-

fore, do not estimate the distance from the objects on the display.

Parking assistant

Concept

MINI Countryman (2020) - Concept - 1

natural_image Top-down view of a multi-lane road with cars and a curved arrow indicating direction (no text or symbols)

This system assists the driver in parking parallel to the road.

General information

Parking assistant handling is divided into three steps:

- Switching on and activating.

- Parking space search.

- Parking.

Ultrasound sensors measure parking spaces on both sides of the vehicle.

The parking assistant calculates the best possible parking line and takes control of steering during the parking procedure.

System status and instructions on required actions are displayed on the Control Display.

A component of the parking assistant is the PDC Park Distance Control.

Safety information

Warning

The system cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judgment in assessing the traffic conditions. Based on the limits of the system, it cannot independently react to all traffic situations. There is a risk of accident. Adjust driving style to traffic conditions. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

NOTICE

The parking assistant can steer the vehicle over or onto curbs. There is a risk of damage to property. Watch traffic closely and actively intervene where appropriate.

The safety information of the PDC Park Distance Control applies in addition.

Overview

Button in the vehicle
MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car dashboard with five white circular buttons and a central oval object (no text or symbols visible)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 2

Park assistance button

Ultrasound sensors

MINI Countryman (2020) - Ultrasound sensors - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's side profile with a white arrow pointing to a circular mark on the wheel (no text or symbols visible)

The ultrasound sensors for measuring parking spaces are located on the wheel housing.

Functional requirements

Ultrasound sensors

Ensure full functionality:

- Do not cover sensors, for instance with stickers.

- Keep the sensors clean and unob- structed.

For measuring parking spaces

- Maximum speed while driving forward approx. 22 mph/35 km/h.

- Maximum distance to row of parked vehicles: 5 ft/1.5 m.

Suitable parking space

- Gaps behind an object that has a min. length of 5 ft/1.5 m.

- Gap between two objects with a minimum length of approx. 5 ft/1.5 m.

- Min. length of gap between two objects: your vehicle's length plus approx. 3.3 ft/1.0 m.

- Minimum depth: approx. 5 ft/1.5 m.

For parking

- Doors and tailgate are closed.

  • The parking brake is released.
  • When parking in parking spaces on the driver's side, the corresponding turn signal must be switched on.

Switching on and activating

Switching on with the button

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on with the button - 1

Press the park assistance button. The LED lights up.

The current status of the parking space search is indicated on the Control Display.

Parking assistant is activated automatically.

Switching on with reverse gear

Shift into reverse.

The current status of the parking space search is indicated on the Control Display.

To activate: P"Parking Assistant"

Display on the Control Display

System activated/deactivated

Symbol Meaning

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 1

Gray: the system is not available.

White: the system is available but not activated.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 2

The system is activated.

Parking space search and system status

MINI Countryman (2020) - Parking space search and system status - 1

text_image (P)

- Symbol P on the vehicle image: the parking assistant is activated and the parking space search is active.

- Control Display shows suitable parking spaces at the edge of the road next to the vehicle symbol. When the parking assistant is active, suitable parking spaces are highlighted.

- The parking procedure is

MINI Countryman (2020) - Parking space search and system status - 2

active. Steering control has been taken over by system.

- Parking space search is always active whenever the vehicle is moving forward slow and straight, even if the system is deactivated. When the system is deactivated, the displays on the Control Display are shown in gray.

Parking using the parking assistant

Parking

  1. Puss the park assistance button or shift into reverse gear to switch on the parking assistant, refer to page 188. Activate the parking assistant, if needed.
    Parking assistant is activated.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Parking - 1

  1. Pass the row of parked vehicles at a speed of up to approx. 22 mph/35 km/h

and at a distance of maximum 5 ft/1.5 m.

The status of the parking space search and possible parking spaces are displayed on the display, refer to page 188.

  1. Follow the instructions on the display.

The best possible parking position will come after gear change on the stationary vehicle - wait for the automatic steering wheel move.

The end of the parking procedure is indicated on the display.

  1. Adjust the parking position yourself, if needed.

Interrupting manually

The parking assistant can be interrupted at any time:

- Press the park assistance button.

- "Parking Assistant"

Interrupting automatically

The system is interrupted automatically in the following situations:

  • If the driver grasps the steering wheel or takes over steering.
  • If a gear is selected that does not match the instruction on the display.
  • If the vehicle speed exceeds approx. 6 mph/10 km/h.
  • Possibly on snow-covered or slippery road surfaces.
  • If a maximum number of parking attempts or the time taken for parking is exceeded.
  • If the PDC Park Distance Control displays clearances that are too small.
  • When switching into other functions of the radio.

A Check Control message is displayed.

Resuming

An interrupted parking procedure can be continued, if needed.

Reactivate the parking assistant, refer to page 188, and follow the instructions on the display.

Switching off

The system can be switched off as follows:

- Press the park assistance button.

- Switching off the ignition.

System limits

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

The system is designed to operate in certain conditions and circumstances. Due to conditions or other factors, the system may not respond. There may be a risk of accident or risk of damage to property. Actively intervene as warranted. Refer to the information in this Owner's Manual regarding the scope of the system's operation and limitations.

No parking assistance

The parking assistant does not offer assistance in the following situations:

- In tight curves.

Functional limitations

The system may not be fully functional in the following situations:

- On bumpy road surfaces such as gravel roads.

- On slippery ground.

  • With accumulations of leaves/snow in the parking space.
  • With a mounted emergency wheel.
  • With ditches or edges, for instance an edge of a port.

Limits of ultrasonic measurement

Ultrasonic measuring might not function under the following circumstances:

  • For small children and animals.
  • For persons with certain clothing, for instance coats.
  • With external interference of the ultrasound, for instance from passing vehicles or loud machines.
  • When sensors are dirty, iced over, damaged or out of position.

- If cargo protrudes.

- Under certain weather conditions such as high relative humidity, wet conditions, snowfall, extreme heat, or strong wind.

- With tow bars and trailer couplings of other vehicles.

- With thin or wedge-shaped objects.

- With moving objects.

- With elevated, protruding objects such as ledges or cargo.

- With objects with corners and sharp edges.

- With objects with a fine surface structure such as fences.

- For objects with porous surfaces.

- Low objects already displayed, for instance curbs, can move into the blind area of the sensors before or after a continuous tone sounds.

- The parking assistant may identify parking spaces that are not suitable for parking.

Tire size

The parking position may vary depending on the tire size.

Malfunction

A Check Control message is displayed.

The parking assistant failed. Have the system checked by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Climate control

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Interior air quality

The air quality in the vehicle is improved by the following components:

- Emission tested passenger compartment.

- Microfilter.

- Air conditioning system to control the temperature, air flow and recirculated-air mode.

Depending on the equipment specification:

- Microfilter/activated-charcoal filter.

- Automatic climate control.

- Parked-car ventilation.

Air conditioner

MINI Countryman (2020) - Air conditioner - 1

text_image 1 2 3 OFF 9 8 7 6 5 A/C 4

1 Air distribution settings 2 Air flow

3 Temperature
4 Seat heating, right 84
5 Air conditioning
6 Recirculated-air mode

Climate control functions in detail

Switching the system on/off

Switching on

Set any air flow.

Switching off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching off - 1

Turn the wheel for air flow all the way to the left.

Temperature

Concept

The system heats or cools, depending on the set temperature.

Adjusting

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting - 1

Turn the wheel to set the desired temperature.

Air conditioning

Concept

The air in the car's interior will be cooled and dehumidified and, depending on the temperature setting, warmed again.

The car's interior can only be cooled with the engine running.

7 Rear window defroster
8 Windshield defroster
9 Seat heating, left 84

Switching on/off

A/C

Press the button.

The LED is illuminated with air conditioning switched on.

Depending on the weather, the windshield may fog up briefly when the engine is started.

The air conditioner produces condensation water, refer to page 225, that will exit from below the vehicle.

Recirculated-air mode

Concept

You may react to unpleasant odors or pollutants in the immediate environment by temporarily suspending the supply of outside air. The system then recirculates the air flow within the vehicle.

Operation

MINI Countryman (2020) - Operation - 1

Press the button:

The LED is illuminated when recirculated-air mode is switched on. The supply of outside air is shut off.

When recirculated-air mode is switched off, fresh air is directed into the vehicle's interior.

To prevent window condensation, recirculated-air mode switches off automatically after a certain amount of time, depending on the external temperature.

With constant recirculated-air mode, the air quality in the car's interior deteriorates and window fogging increases.

If the windows fog over, switch off recirculated-air mode and increase the air flow, if needed.

Controlling the air flow manually

Concept

The air flow for climate control can be adjusted manually.

Operation

MINI Countryman (2020) - Operation - 1

Turn the ring to set the desired air flow.

The higher the air flow, the more effective the heating or cooling will be.

The air flow from the air conditioner may be reduced automatically to save battery power.

Controlling the air distribution manually

Concept

The air distribution for climate control can be adjusted manually.

Operation

MINI Countryman (2020) - Operation - 1

Turn the wheel to select the desired program or the desired intermediate setting.

- Windows.

- Upper body region.

- Floor area.

- Windows, upper body region, and floor area.

To defrost windows and remove condensation

Make the following settings to defrost the windows and remove condensation:

- Direct the air distribution onto the windows.

- Increasing the air flow.

- Increase the temperature.

- Switch on the air conditioning if needed.

Windshield defroster

MINI Countryman (2020) - Windshield defroster - 1

Press the button. The LED lights up.

The front window defroster

switches off automatically after a certain period of time.

Rear window defroster

MINI Countryman (2020) - Rear window defroster - 1

Press the button. The LED lights up.

The rear window defroster switches off automatically after a certain period of time.

For permanent activation, press the button for longer than 3 seconds. To deactivate, press the button again.

The rear window defroster can only be activated continuously at an external temperature below approx. 41 °F/5 °C.

When GREEN Mode is activated, the heating output is reduced.

Microfilter

In external and recirculated-air mode, the microfilter filters dust and pollen from the air.

Have this filter changed during vehicle maintenance, refer to page 298.

Automatic climate control

MINI Countryman (2020) - Automatic climate control - 1

text_image 1 2 3 4 5 AUTO OFF 6 7 MAX A M A/C MAX A/C 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8

1 Temperature, left
2 Display
3 Air flow, AUTO intensity
4 AUTO program
5 Air distribution, manual
6 Display
7 Temperature, right
8 Seat heating, right 84

9 Maximum cooling
10 Air conditioning
11 Recirculated-air mode
12 Rear window defroster
13 Windshield defroster
14 To defrost windows and remove condensation
15 Seat heating, left 84

Climate control functions in detail

Switching the system on/off

Switching on

Set any air flow.

Switching off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching off - 1

Turn wheel for air flow to the left until the control switches off.

Temperature

Concept

The automatic climate control achieves the set temperature as quickly as possible, if

necessary by using the maximum cooling or heating power, and then keeps it constant.

Adjusting

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting - 1

Turn the wheel to set the desired temperature.

Do not rapidly switch between different temperature settings. The automatic climate control will not have sufficient time to adjust the set temperature.

Air conditioning

Concept

The air in the car's interior will be cooled and dehumidified and, depending on the temperature setting, warmed again.

The car's interior can only be cooled with the engine running.

Switching on/off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off - 1

Press the button.

The LED is illuminated with air conditioning switched on.

Depending on the weather, the windshield may fog up briefly when the engine is started.

The cooling function is switched on automatically with the AUTO program.

When using the automatic climate control, condensation water, refer to page 225, develops and drains underneath the vehicle. This is normal.

Maximum cooling

Concept

The system is set to the lowest temperature, maximum air flow and recirculated-air mode.

General information

The function is available with external temperatures beyond approx. 32 °F/0 °C and with the engine running.

Air flows out of the vents to the upper body region. The vents need to be open for this.

The air flow can be adjusted with the program active.

Switching on/off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off - 1

Press the button.

The LED is illuminated with the system switched on.

The system is set to the lowest temperature, optimum air flow and air circulation mode.

AUTO program

Concept

The AUTO program cools, ventilates or heats the car's interior automatically.

The air distribution and temperature are controlled automatically depending on the temperature in the car's interior and the desired temperature setting including the selected intensity of the air flow.

Switching on/off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off - 1

Press the button.

The LED is illuminated with the

AUTO program switched on.

Depending on the selected temperature, AUTO intensity and outside influences, the

air is directed to the windshield, side windows, upper body, and into the floor area.

Point the side vents toward the side windows.

The following features are switched on automatically with the AUTO program:

- The air conditioning, refer to page 195.

To switch off the program: press the button again or manually adjust the air distribution.

Intensity

With the AUTO program activated, the automatic intensity control can be changed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Intensity - 1

Turn the ring to set the desired intensity from soft to intensive.

The set intensity is displayed via the position of the illuminated LED segment.

Automatic recirculated-air control/recirculated-air mode

Concept

The automatic recirculated-air control AUC recognizes odors or pollutants in the outside air. The outside air supply is shut off and the interior air is recirculated.

General information

If the system is activated, a sensor detects pollutants in the outside air and controls the shut-off automatically.

If the system is deactivated, outside air continuously flows into the car's interior.

With constant recirculated-air mode, the air quality in the car's interior deteriorates and window fogging increases.

You may react to unpleasant odors or pollutants in the immediate environment by temporarily suspending the supply of outside air. The system then recirculates the air flow within the vehicle.

Switching on/off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off - 1

Press button repeatedly to select an operating mode:

  • LEDs off: outside air flows in continuously.
  • Left LED on, automatic recirculated-air control: a sensor detects pollutants in the outside air and shuts off automatically.
  • Right LED on, recirculated-air mode: the supply of outside air into the vehicle is permanently blocked.

To prevent window condensation, recirculated-air mode switches off automatically after a certain amount of time, depending on the external temperature.

If windows are fogged over, switch off the recirculating mode and press the AUTO button. Make sure that air can flow to the windshield.

Adjusting the air flow manually

Concept

The air flow for climate control can be adjusted manually.

General information

To adjust the air flow manually switch off AUTO program first.

Operation

MINI Countryman (2020) - Operation - 1

Turn the ring to set the desired air flow.

The manually adjusted air flow is displayed via illuminated LED segments.

The air flow of the automatic climate control may be reduced automatically to save battery power.

Adjusting the air distribution manually

Concept

The air distribution for climate control can be adjusted manually.

Operation

MINI Countryman (2020) - Operation - 1

Press the button repeatedly to select a program:

  • Windows, upper body region, and floor area.
  • Upper body region and floor area.
  • Floor area.
  • Windows and floor area.
  • Windows.
  • Windows and upper body region.
  • Upper body region.

To defrost windows and remove condensation

Concept

Ice and condensation are quickly removed from the windshield and the front side windows.

Switching on/off

MINI Countryman (2020) - Switching on/off - 1

Press the button.

The LED is illuminated with the

system switched on.

Ice and condensation are quickly removed from the windshield and the front side windows.

The air flow can be adjusted with the program active.

If there is window condensation, switch on the air conditioning too.

Windshield defroster

MINI Countryman (2020) - Windshield defroster - 1

Press the button. The LED lights up.

The front window defroster

switches off automatically after a certain period of time.

Rear window defroster

MINI Countryman (2020) - Rear window defroster - 1

Press the button. The LED lights up.

The rear window defroster switches off automatically after a certain period of time.

For permanent activation, press the button for longer than 3 seconds. To deactivate, press the button again.

The rear window defroster can only be activated continuously at an external temperature below approx. 41 °F/5 °C.

When GREEN Mode is activated, the heating output is reduced.

Microfilter/activated-charcoal filter

In external and recirculated-air mode, the microfilter/activated charcoal filter filters dust, pollen, and gaseous pollutants out of the air.

Have this filter changed during vehicle maintenance, refer to page 298.

Ventilation

Setting

The air flow directions can be individually adjusted:

- Direct ventilation:

The air flow is directly pointed onto the person. The air flow heats or cools noticeably, depending on the adjusted temperature.

- Indirect ventilation:

If the vents are fully or partly closed, the air is directly routed into the car's interior.

Front ventilation

MINI Countryman (2020) - Front ventilation - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's front air intake section with white directional arrows indicating flow or movement (no text or symbols)
  • Turn knob for continuous opening and closing of the vents.
  • Swivel the vents to alter the direction of the vent flow, arrows.

Ventilation in the rear

MINI Countryman (2020) - Ventilation in the rear - 1

text_image 1 1 2
  • Lever for changing the air flow direction, arrow 1.
  • Thumbwheel for variable opening and closing of the vents, arrow 2.

Parked-car ventilation

Concept

The parked-car ventilation ventilates the car's interior and lowers its temperature, if needed.

General information

The parked-car ventilation can be switched on and off directly or by using two preset activation times. The system remains switched on for 30 minutes.

The parked-car ventilation system is operated via the Central Information Display (CID).

Functional requirements

  • Direct operation: vehicle is in radio-ready state.
  • Direct operation or preset activation time: does not depend on external temperature.
  • Battery is sufficiently charged.

If parked-car ventilation is switched on, the vehicle battery will be discharged. Thus, limit the maximum activation time to save the vehicle battery. The system will be available again after the engine is started or after a short trip.

  • Make sure that the vehicle's date and time are set correctly.
  • Open the vents to allow air to flow out.

Switching on/off directly

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. If necessary, "Climate functions"
  4. "Activate comfort ventilation now"

The symbol on the automatic climate control flashes if the system is switched on.

Preselecting the activation time

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. If necessary, "Climate functions"
  4. "Comfort ventilation"
  5. Select the desired activation time.
  6. Set the desired time.

Activating the activation time

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"
  3. If necessary, "Climate functions"
  4. "For start time at:"

Activate the desired activation time.

The symbol on the automatic climate control lights up when the activation time is activated.
The symbol on the automatic climate control flashes when the system has been switched on.

The system will only be switched on within the next 24 hours. After that, it needs to be reactivated.

Interior equipment

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Integrated Universal Remote Control

Concept

The integrated Universal Remote Control in the interior mirror can operate up to 3 functions of remote-controlled systems such as garage door drives, barriers, or lighting systems.

General information

The Integrated Universal Remote Control replaces up to 3 different hand-held transmitters. To operate the remote control, the buttons on the interior mirror must be programmed with the desired functions. The hand-held transmitter for the particular system is required in order to program the remote control.

Before selling the vehicle, delete the stored functions for the sake of security.

If possible, do not install the antenna of the remote-controlled system, e.g. the garage door drive, near metal objects to ensure the best possible operation.

Safety information

Warning

The operation of remote-controlled systems with the integrated universal remote control, such as the garage door, may result in injury, for example, body parts becoming jammed in a garage door. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the area of movement of the respective system is clear during programming and operation. Also follow the safety information of the hand-held transmitter.

Compatibility

If this symbol is printed on the packaging or in the owner's manual of the system to be controlled, the system is generally compatible with the integrated Universal Remote Control.

Additional questions are answered by:

- A dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

- www.homelink.com on the Internet.

HomeLink is a registered trademark of Gentex Corporation.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

text_image Diagram of a device with labeled parts, showing a top view and three numbered components.

1 LED

2 Programmable keys

3 Hand-held transmitters of the system

Programming

General information

The battery of the hand-held transmitter must be fully charged at the time of programming to ensure an optimal range of the integrated universal remote control.

  1. Switch on the ignition.

  2. Initial setup:

Press and hold the two outer buttons on the interior mirror simultaneously for approximately 10 seconds until the LED flashes green rapidly. This erases all programming of the buttons on the interior mirror.

  1. Press the interior mirror button to be programmed. The LED on the interior mirror will slowly begin flashing orange.

  2. Hold the hand-held transmitter for the system to be used approx. 1 to 12 in/2.5 to 30 cm away from the buttons on the interior mirror. The required distance depends on the hand-held transmitter.

  3. Press and hold the button of the desired function on the hand-held transmitter.

Canada: if programming with the hand-held transmitter was interrupted, hold

down the interior mirror button and repeatedly press and release the hand-held transmitter button for 2 seconds.

    • The LED lights up green: programming completed.

Release the button.

- The LED flashes fast: programming is not complete.

Press the button on the interior mirror for 2 seconds and release. Perform this procedure three times to complete the programming procedure.

If the integrated universal remote control remains nonoperational, continue with the special features for change code wireless systems.

- LED does not flash green after 60 seconds: programming not completed.

Repeat steps 3 to 6.

To program other functions on other buttons, repeat steps 3 to 5.

Special feature of the rolling code wireless system

If you are unable to operate the system after repeated programming, please check if the system to be controlled features a rolling code radio system.

Refer to the owner's manual for the system.

For systems with a rolling code radio system, the integrated Universal Remote Control and the system also have to be synchronized.

Please read the owner's manual to find out how to synchronize the system.

Synchronizing is easier with the aid of a second person.

Synchronizing the universal remote control with the system:

  1. Park the vehicle within range of the remote-controlled system.
  2. Program the relevant button on the interior mirror as described.
  3. Locate and press the synchronizing button on the system being programmed, e.g. at the garage gate. You have approx. 30 seconds for the next step.
  4. Hold down the programmed button on the interior mirror for approximately 3 seconds and then release it. If necessary, repeat this step up to three times in order to finish synchronization. Once synchronization is complete, the programmed function will be carried out.

Reprogramming individual buttons

  1. Switch on the ignition.
  2. Press and hold the interior mirror button to be programmed.
  3. As soon as the LED on the interior mirror flashes orange after approx. 20 seconds, release the button.
  4. Hold the hand-held transmitter for the system to be used approx. 1 to 12 in/2.5 to 30 cm away from the buttons on the interior mirror. The required distance depends on the hand-held transmitter.
  5. Press and hold the button of the desired function on the hand-held transmitter. Canada: if programming with the hand-held transmitter was interrupted, hold down the interior mirror button and repeatedly press and release the hand-held transmitter button for 2 seconds.
  6. The LED can light up in different ways.
  7. The LED lights up green: the programming procedure is completed. Release the button.

  8. The LED flashes fast: the hand-held transmitter was detected but programming is not complete.
    Press the button on the interior mirror for 2 seconds and release. Perform this procedure three times to complete the programming procedure.
    If the integrated universal remote control remains nonoperational, continue with the special features for change code wireless systems.

- LED does not flash green after 60 seconds: programming not completed.

Repeat steps 3 to 6.

If the programming procedure is not completed, the previous programming will remain unchanged.

Operation

Warning

The operation of remote-controlled systems with the integrated universal remote control, such as the garage door, may result in injury, for example, body parts becoming jammed in a garage door. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the area of movement of the respective system is clear during programming and operation. Also follow the safety information of the hand-held transmitter.

The system, such as the garage door, can be operated using the button on the interior mirror while the engine is running or when the ignition is started. To do this, hold down the button within receiving range of the system until the function is activated. The interior mirror LED stays lit while the wireless signal is being transmitted.

Deleting stored functions

All stored functions will be deleted. The functions cannot be deleted individually.

Press and hold the two outer buttons on the interior mirror simultaneously for approximately 10 seconds until the LED on the interior mirror flashes green rapidly.

Digital compass

Overview
MINI Countryman (2020) - Digital compass - 1

text_image 2 N4 1

1 Control button
2 Mirror display

Mirror display

The point of the compass is displayed in the mirror when driving straight.

Operating concept

Various functions can be called up by pressing the control button with a pointed object, such as the tip of a ballpoint pen or similar object. The following setting options are displayed in succession, depending on how long the control button is pressed:

  • Pressed briefly: turns display on/off.
  • 3 to 6 seconds: compass zone setting.
  • 6 to 9 seconds: compass calibration.
  • 9 to 12 seconds: left/right-hand steering setting.
  • 12 to 15 seconds: language setting.

Setting the compass zones

Sets the particular compass zones on the vehicle so that the compass operates correctly; refer to World map with compass zones.

World map with magnetic zones

MINI Countryman (2020) - World map with magnetic zones - 1

contour | Region | Value | |--------|-------| | North America | 1 | | Europe | 2 | | Asia | 3 | | Africa | 4 | | South America | 5 | | Australia | 6 | | Central America | 7 | | Middle East | 8 | | Southeast Asia | 9 | | Eastern Europe | 10 | | Southern Europe | 11 | | Western Europe | 12 | | North America (Central) | 13 | | Europe (Central) | 14 | | Asia (Central) | 15 | | Africa (Central) | 14 | | South America (Central) | 13 | | Western Europe (Central) | 12 | | Eastern Europe (Central) | 11 | | Southern Europe (Central) | 10 | | Western Europe (Central) | 9 | | Northern America (Central) | 8 | | Central America (Central) | 7 | | Southern America (Central) | 6 | | Western Europe (Central) | 5 | | Eastern Europe (Central) | 4 | | Southern Europe (Central) | 3 | | Western Europe (Central) | 2 | | Northern America (Central) | 1 |

Procedure

  1. Press and hold the control button for approx. 3 to 4 seconds. The number of the set compass zone appears in the mirror.
  2. To change the zone setting, press the control button quickly and repeatedly until the number of the compass zone that corresponds with your location appears in the mirror.

The set zone is stored automatically. The compass is ready for use again after approximately 10 seconds.

Calibrating the digital compass

The digital compass must be calibrated in the event of the following:

  • The wrong compass point is displayed.
  • The point of the compass displayed does not change despite changing the direction of travel.
  • Not all points of the compass are displayed.

Procedure

  1. Make sure that there are no large metallic objects or overhead power lines near the vehicle and that there is sufficient room to drive around in a circle.
  2. Set the currently applicable compass zone.
  3. Press and hold the control button for approx. 6 to 7 seconds so that "C" appears on the display. Next, drive in a complete circle at least once at a speed of no more than 4mph / 7km / h . If calibration is successful, the "C" is replaced by the points of the compass.

Left/right-hand steering

The digital compass is already set for right or left-hand steering at the factory.

Setting the language

Press and hold the control button for approx. 12 to 13 seconds. Briefly press the

control button again to switch between English "E" and German "O".

Settings are stored automatically after approximately 10 seconds.

Sun visor

Glare shield

To provide protection against glare, fold the sun visor down or pivot it to the side.

Vanity mirror

A vanity mirror is located in the sun visor behind a cover.

When the cover is opened, the mirror lighting switches on.

Ashtray/cigarette lighter

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car gear shift lever mechanism (no visible text or symbols)

The ashtray is located in one of the frontal cup holders, the cigarette lighter above it in the center console.

Ashtray

In order to empty the ashtray, remove the ashtray from the cup holder.

Cigarette lighter

Safety information

Warning

Contact with the hot heating element or the hot socket of the cigarette lighter can cause burns. Flammable materials can ignite if the cigarette lighter falls down or is held against the objects. There is a risk of fire and injuries. There is a risk of damage to property. Take hold of the cigarette lighter by its handle. Make sure that children do not use the cigarette lighter.

NOTICE

If metal objects fall into the socket, they can cause a short circuit. There is a risk of damage to property. Replace the cigarette lighter or socket cover again after using the socket.

Operation

MINI Countryman (2020) - Operation - 1

Push in the cigarette lighter. The cigarette lighter can be removed as soon as it pops back out.

Sockets

Concept

The lighter socket can be used as a socket for electrical equipment while the ignition is switched on or the engine is running.

General information

The total load of all sockets must not exceed 140 watts at 12 volts.

Do not damage the socket by using non-compatible connectors.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Devices and cables in the unfolding area of the airbags, such as portable navigation devices, can hinder the unfolding of the airbag or be thrown around in the car's interior during unfolding. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that devices and cables are not in the airbag's area of unfolding.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

NOTICE

Battery chargers for the vehicle battery can work with high voltages and currents, which means that the 12 volt on-board network can be overloaded or damaged. There is a risk of damage to property. Only connect battery chargers for the vehicle battery to the starting aid terminals in the engine compartment.

MINI Countryman (2020) - NOTICE - 1

NOTICE

If metal objects fall into the socket, they can cause a short circuit. There is a risk of damage to property. Replace the cigarette lighter or socket cover again after using the socket.

In the center console

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the center console - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car gear shift lever and control panel (no visible text or symbols)

Remove the cover or cigarette lighter.

In the cargo area

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the cargo area - 1

natural_image Interior view of a dimly lit room with a circular light fixture and a small inset image (no visible text or symbols)

The socket is located on the right side in the cargo area.

USB interface

Concept

Mobile devices with a USB port can be connected to the USB interface.

General information

Follow the information regarding the connection of mobile devices to the USB interface in the section on USB connections, refer to page 53.

In the front center console

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the front center console - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car backrest door with a white arrow pointing to the left side of the button (no text or symbols visible)

The USB interface is located in the front of the center console.

Properties:

  • USB port Type A.
  • For charging mobile devices and for data transfer.
  • Charge current: max. 1.5 A.

In the rear center console

MINI Countryman (2020) - In the rear center console - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car air vent with two illuminated windows and a small label (no visible text or symbols)

One USB dual charge socket is located in the rear center console.

Properties:

  • USB port Type C.
  • For charging of mobile devices.
  • Charge current: max. 3 A.

Storage compartments

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Safety information

Warning

Loose objects or devices with a cable connection to the vehicle, for instance mobile phones, can be thrown into the car's interior while driving, for instance in the event of an accident or during braking and evasive maneuvers. There is a risk of injury. Secure loose objects or devices with a cable connection to the vehicle in the car's interior.

NOTICE

Anti-slip pads such as anti-slip mats can damage the dashboard. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not use anti-slip pads.

Overview

The following storage compartments are available in the car's interior:

  • Glove compartment on the front passenger side.
  • Compartments in the doors.
  • Storage compartment in the center arm-rest.
  • Storage compartment in front of the cup holders.
  • Clothes hooks
  • Storage compartments in the cargo area.
  • Storage tray in the center console.
  • Pockets on the backrests of the front seats.

Glove compartment

Safety information

Warning

Folded open, the glove compartment protrudes in the car's interior. Objects in the glove compartment can be thrown into the car's interior while driving, for instance in the event of an accident or during braking and evasive maneuvers. There is a risk of injury. Always close the glove compartment immediately after using it.

Opening

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with a hand cursor pointing to the side panel (no text or symbols visible)

Pull the handle.

The light in the glove compartment switches on.

Closing

Fold up the cover.

Compartments in the doors

General information

There are storage compartments in the doors.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Breakable objects, such as glass bottles or glasses, can break in the event of an accident or a braking or evasive maneuver. Broken glass can be scattered in the car's interior. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Do not use any breakable objects while driving. Only stow breakable objects in closed storage compartments.

Center armrest

General information

The center armrest contains a storage compartment.

Opening

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car seatbelt with two white arrows pointing to the side of the seat (no text or symbols visible)

Press button, arrow 1, and open center arm-rest upward, arrow 2.

Set the incline

The center armrest can be adjusted in several tilt settings.

Cup holders

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Unsuitable containers in the cup holders may damage the cup holders or be thrown about the car's interior in the event of an accident, an evasive maneuver, or forceful braking. Spilled liquids can distract from the traffic conditions and lead to an accident. Hot drinks can damage the cup holder or lead to scalding. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Do not force objects into the cup holder. Use lightweight, shatterproof, and sealable

containers. Do not transport hot beverages.

Front

MINI Countryman (2020) - Front - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car gear shift lever mechanism (no text or symbols visible)

In the center console.

Rear

General information

The cup holder is located in the center arm-rest.

MINI Countryman (2020) - General information - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car seatbelt with a highlighted component (no text or symbols visible)

Pull the center armrest forward at the strap. To open: press the button.

To close: push both covers back in, one after the other.

Safety information

NOTICE

With an open cup holder, the center arm-rest cannot be folded back up. There is a risk of damage to property. Press back the covers before the center armrest is folded up.

Clothes hooks

General information

The clothes hooks are located above the rear doors.

Safety information

Warning

Clothing articles on the clothes hooks can obstruct the view while driving. There is a risk of accident. When suspending clothing articles from the clothes hooks, ensure that they will not obstruct the driver's view.

Warning

Improper use of the clothes hooks can lead to a risk of objects flying about during braking and evasive maneuvers. There is a risk of injury and risk of damage to property. Only hang lightweight objects, for instance clothing articles, from the clothes hooks.

Cargo area

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Loading

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

High gross weight can overheat the tires, damage them internally and cause a sudden drop in tire inflation pressure. Driving characteristics may be negatively impacted, reducing lane stability, lengthening the braking distances and changing the steering response. There is a risk of accident. Pay attention to the permitted load capacity of the tires and never exceed the permitted gross weight.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

Loose objects or devices with a cable connection to the vehicle, for instance mobile phones, can be thrown into the car's interior while driving, for instance in the event of an accident or during braking and evasive maneuvers. There is a risk of injury. Secure loose objects or devices with

a cable connection to the vehicle in the car's interior.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

Improperly stowed objects can shift and be thrown into the car's interior, for instance in the event of an accident or during braking and evasive maneuvers. Vehicle occupants can be hit and injured. There is a risk of injury. Stow and secure objects and cargo properly.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

NOTICE

Fluids in the cargo area can cause damage. There is a risk of damage to property. Make sure that no fluids leak in the cargo area.

Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit

  1. Locate the statement "The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs" on your vehicle's placard.
  2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.
  3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs
  4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the "XXX" amount equals 1,400 lbs and there will be five 150 lbs passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and

luggage load capacity is 650 lbs (1,400 - 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs)

  1. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.
  2. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.

Load

MINI Countryman (2020) - Load - 1

text_image + ≦ Max. Load + ≦ Max. Load + ≦ Max. Load

The maximum load is the sum of the weight of the occupants and the cargo.

The greater the weight of the occupants, the less cargo that can be transported.

Stowing and securing cargo

  • Cover sharp edges and corners on the cargo.
  • Heavy cargo: stow as far forward as possible, directly behind and at the bottom of the rear passenger seat backrests.
  • Very heavy cargo: when the rear seat is not occupied, secure each of the outer safety belts in the opposite buckle.
  • If necessary, fold down the rear back-rests to stow large cargo.

- Do not stack cargo above the top edge of the backrests.

Lashing eyes in the cargo area

MINI Countryman (2020) - Lashing eyes in the cargo area - 1

natural_image Top-down view of a car backrest with white arrows pointing to the rear panel (no text or symbols visible)

With cargo area partition net: to secure the cargo there are six lashing eyes in the cargo area.

Attach load securing aids, such as lashing straps, tensioning straps, draw straps or cargo nets, to the lashing eyes in the cargo area.

Cargo cover

General information

When the tailgate is opened, the cargo cover is raised.

Safety information

Warning

Loose objects or devices with a cable connection to the vehicle, for instance mobile phones, can be thrown into the car's interior while driving, for instance in the event of an accident or during braking and evasive maneuvers. There is a risk of injury. Secure loose objects or devices with a cable connection to the vehicle in the car's interior.

Removing

For storing bulky objects the cargo cover can be removed.

  1. Detach the left and right retaining straps at the tailgate.
  2. Pull the cargo cover out of the brackets on the left and right.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Removing - 1

natural_image Interior view of a vehicle showing a rectangular tray with a white arrow pointing downward to a lower panel (no text or symbols visible)

Installing

  1. Slide the cargo cover forward horizontally into the two side brackets until it audibly engages.
  2. Attach the left and right retaining straps at the tailgate.

Storage compartments in the cargo area

Storage compartment on the side

A storage compartment is located on the left side.

Multi-function hook

MINI Countryman (2020) - Multi-function hook - 1

Warning

Improper use of the multi-function hooks can lead to a risk of objects flying about during braking and evasive maneuvers, for example. There is a risk of injury and risk of damage to property. Only hang lightweight objects, such as shopping

bags, from the multi-function hooks. Only transport heavy luggage in the cargo area if it has been appropriately secured.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical component with a white arrow pointing to a small feature (no visible text or symbols)

The cargo area contains two multi-function hooks.

Enlarging the cargo area

Concept

Depending on the vehicle equipment, the cargo area can be enlarged as follows:

  • The rear seat backrests can be folded down.
  • The rear seat backrests can be moved into an upright loading position using the cargo setting.

General information

The rear seat backrest is divided at a ratio of 40–20–40. The side rear seat backrests and the center section can be folded down separately.

The rear seat backrests can be folded down from the rear.

Safety information

Warning

Danger of jamming with folding down the backrests. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the area of movement of the rear backrest and the of the head restraint is clear prior to folding down.

Warning

If a rear seat backrest is not locked, unsecured cargo can be thrown about the car's interior; for instance, in the event of an accident, braking or an evasive maneuver. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the rear seat backrest is locked after folding it back.

Warning

Unexpected movements of the rear seat backrest while driving may occur due to unintentional unlocking of the rear seat backrests by the straps. There is a risk of injury. Do not fasten any objects to the straps for unlocking the rear backrests.

⚠ Warning

The stability of the child restraint system is limited or compromised with incorrect seat adjustment or improper installation of the child seat. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Make sure that the child restraint system fits securely against the backrest. If possible, adjust the backrest tilt for all affected backrests and correctly adjust the seats. Make sure that seats and backrests are securely engaged or locked. If possible, adjust the height of the head restraints or remove them.

Warning

Body parts can be jammed when moving the head restraint. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement is clear when moving the head restraint.

Folding down the rear seat backrest from the rear

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding down the rear seat backrest from the rear - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car seatbelt mechanism with a white arrow pointing to the side (no text or symbols visible)

Pull the strap. The rear seat backrest folds forward.

Cargo position

Concept

The rear seat backrests can be moved into an upright loading position individually. An adjustment in several tilt stages is possible as needed.

Adjusting

  1. Pull the strap.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjusting - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car seatbelt mechanism with a white arrow pointing to the side (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Set the loading position of the rear seat backrest as required.
  2. Engage the rear seat backrest.

Folding back the backrest

Without a cargo position:

  1. Pull the strap.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding back the backrest - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car seatbelt mechanism with a white arrow pointing to the side (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Return the rear seat backrest to the upright seating position and engage it.

With a cargo position:

  1. Pull the strap.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding back the backrest - 2

natural_image Close-up of a car seatbelt mechanism with a white arrow pointing to the side (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Fold the rear seat backrest rearward. The rear seat backrest first engages in the loading position.
  2. Pull the strap again.
  3. Return the rear seat backrest to the upright seating position and engage it.

Variable cargo area floor

Concept

With the variable cargo area floor, the cargo area can be configured corresponding to transport requirements.

General information

Follow instructions on securing cargo, refer to page 211.

Removing the cargo floor panel

  1. Fold down the rear seat backrest, refer to page 213.
  2. Fold the rear part of the cargo floor panel upward.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Removing the cargo floor panel - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a battery pack and a white arrow pointing to it, no visible text or symbols.
  1. Grasp the cargo floor panel in the rear and fold up above the locking point of the upper position, refer to page 216.
  2. Pull the cargo floor panel backward from the brackets.

Inserting the cargo floor panel

  1. Push the cargo area floor into the supports at a shallow angle. The cargo area floor must engage noticeably.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Inserting the cargo floor panel - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a white plastic tray with two upward-pointing arrows inside, no text or symbols visible.
  1. Fold the cargo area floor over downward.

Folded up position

Safety information

Warning

Improper use of the variable cargo floor panel can lead to a danger of objects flying about during braking and evasive maneuvers. There is a risk of injury and risk of damage to property.

- Do not use the variable cargo floor panel to separate the cargo area and car's interior in the sense of a partition net.

- Only use the variable cargo floor panel in the folded-up position when the backrests are folded up and locked.

- Fold down the variable cargo floor panel before driving off.

- Always secure cargo against shifting, using straps, belts and lashing eyes, for instance.

Fold up the cargo floor panel

Fold the rear part of the cargo floor panel upward.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Fold up the cargo floor panel - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a white plastic tray mounted on a black vehicle trunk (no visible text or symbols)

Fold up the cargo floor panel. You've reached the maximum cargo height.

MINI Picnic Bench

Concept

The MINI Picnic Bench provides a comfortable seating surface on the loading lip of the vehicle.

General information

Only use the MINI Picnic Bench while the vehicle is parked and with the tailgate open. When the MINI Picnic Bench is not in use, fold it together to prevent soiling and damage.

In vehicles with a no-touch opening and closing tailgate:

If the vehicle key is in the sensor area, the tailgate can be opened or closed inadvertently by an unconscious or alleged recognized foot movement.

The sensor has an approximate range of 5 ft/1.50 m extending from the rear of the vehicle.

Safety information

Warning

Body parts can be jammed when operating the tailgate. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement of the tailgate is clear during opening and closing.

Overview

The MINI Picnic Bench is located on the underside of the cargo area floor.

Mounting

  1. Fold the rear part of the cargo floor panel upward.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Mounting - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a white plastic tray with an arrow pointing to it, no visible text or symbols
  1. Place the MINI Picnic Bench on the front part of the cargo floor panel and attach it to the rear part of the cargo floor panel using the four snaps.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Mounting - 2

natural_image Architectural ceiling with four white upward arrows pointing upward (no text or symbols)
  1. Fold down the MINI Picnic Bench toward the rear. The MINI Picnic Bench is fastened with magnets.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Mounting - 3

natural_image Top-down view of a car's rear bumper showing white plastic trim and black buttons (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Fold the rear part of the cargo area floor downward.

To disassemble the MINI Picnic Bench, proceed in reverse order.

Folding down

  1. Lift the rear part of the cargo area floor.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding down - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car trunk with a plastic tray lid (no visible text or symbols)
  1. Grasp the MINI Picnic Bench in the middle and pull it back and up against the force of the magnets.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding down - 2

natural_image Top-down view of a car trunk with a white plastic tray and a white arrow pointing to the side (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Fold the rear part of the cargo area floor downward and place the MINI Picnic

Bench over the loading lip of the cargo area. Place a protective cloth over the bumper.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding down - 3

natural_image Top-down view of a car trunk with a white rectangular grille (no text or symbols visible)

Folding up

Fold rear part of the cargo floor panel upward.

The MINI Picnic Bench swings against the underside of the cargo area floor and is fastened there with magnets.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Folding up - 1

natural_image Three orange and white traffic cones with blue stripes, placed on a gravel surface (no text or symbols visible)

i DRIVING TIPS

Things to remember when driving 222

Saving fuel 227

Things to remember when driving

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Breaking-in period

General information

Moving parts need to begin working together smoothly.

The following instructions will help you to achieve a long vehicle life and good efficiency.

During break-in, do not use the Launch Control, refer to page 123.

Safety information

Warning

Due to new parts and components, safety and driver assistance systems can react with a delay. There is a risk of accident. After installing new parts or with a new vehicle, drive conservatively and intervene early if necessary. Observe the break-in procedures of the respective parts and components.

Engine, transmission, and axle drive

Up to 1,200 miles/2,000 km

Do not exceed the maximum engine and road speed:

- For gasoline engine 4,500 rpm and 100 mph/160 km/h.

Avoid full load or kickdown under all circumstances.

From 1,200 miles/2,000 km

The engine and vehicle speed can gradually be increased.

Tires

Tire traction is not optimal due to manufacturing circumstances when tires are brand-new; they achieve their full traction potential after a break-in time.

Drive conservatively for the first 200 miles/300 km.

Brake system

Brake discs and brake pads only reach their full effectiveness after approx. 300 miles/500 km. Drive moderately during this break-in period.

Clutch

The function of the clutch reaches its optimal level only after a distance driven of approx. 300 miles/500 km. During this break-in period, engage the clutch gently.

Following part replacement

The same break-in procedures should be observed if any of the components mentioned

above have to be renewed in the course of the vehicle's operating life.

General driving notes

Closing the tailgate

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

An open tailgate protrudes from the vehicle and can endanger occupants and other traffic participants or damage the vehicle in the event of an accident, braking or evasive maneuvers. In addition, exhaust fumes may enter the car's interior. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Do not drive with the tailgate open.

Driving with the tailgate open

If driving with the tailgate open cannot be avoided:

- Close all windows and the glass sunroof.

- Greatly increase the air flow from the vents.

- Drive moderately.

Hot exhaust gas system

MINI Countryman (2020) - Hot exhaust gas system - 1

Warning

During driving operation, high temperatures can occur underneath the vehicle body, for instance caused by the exhaust gas system. If combustible materials, such as leaves or grass, come in contact with hot parts of the exhaust gas system, these materials can ignite. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Do not remove the heat shields installed and never apply undercoating to them. Make

sure that no combustible materials can come in contact with hot vehicle parts in driving operation, idle or during parking. Do not touch the hot exhaust gas system.

Mobile communication devices in the vehicle

MINI Countryman (2020) - Mobile communication devices in the vehicle - 1

Warning

Vehicle electronics and mobile phones can influence one another. There is radiation due to the transmission operations of mobile phones. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. If possible, in the car's interior use only mobile phones with direct connections to an exterior antenna in order to exclude mutual interference and deflect the radiation from the car's interior.

Hydroplaning

On wet or slushy roads, a wedge of water can form between the tires and road surface.

This phenomenon is referred to as hydroplaning. It is characterized by a partial or complete loss of contact between the tires and the road surface, ultimately undermining your ability to steer and brake the vehicle.

Driving through water

General information

When driving through water, follow the following:

  • Drive through calm water only.
  • Drive through water only if it is not deeper than maximum 9.8 inches/25 cm.
  • Drive through water no faster than walking speed, up to 3 mph/5 km/h.

Safety information

NOTICE

When driving too quickly through too deep water, water can enter into the engine compartment, the electrical system or the transmission. There is a risk of damage to property. When driving through water, do not exceed the maximum indicated water level and the maximum speed for driving through water.

Braking safely

General information

The vehicle is equipped with ABS as a standard feature.

Perform an emergency stop in situations that require such.

Steering is still responsive. You can still avoid any obstacles with a minimum of steering effort.

Pulsation of the brake pedal and sounds from the hydraulic circuits indicate that ABS is in its active mode.

Objects in the area around the pedals

Warning

Objects in the driver's floor area can limit the pedal distance or block a depressed pedal. There is a risk of accident. Stow objects in the vehicle such that they are secured and cannot enter into the driver's floor area. Use floor mats that are suitable for the vehicle and can be safely attached to the floor. Do not use loose floor mats and do not layer several floor mats. Make sure that there is sufficient clearance for the pedals. Ensure that the floor mats are

securely fastened again after they were removed, for instance for cleaning.

Driving in wet conditions

When roads are wet, salted, or in heavy rain, gently press the brake pedal every few miles.

Ensure that this action does not endanger other traffic.

The heat generated during braking dries brake discs and brake pads and protects them against corrosion.

In this way braking efficiency will be available when you need it.

Hills

General information

Drive long or steep downhill gradients in the gear that requires least braking effort. Otherwise, the brakes may overheat and reduce brake efficiency.

You can increase the engine's braking effect by shifting down, going all the way to first gear, if needed.

Safety information

Warning

Light but consistent brake pressure can lead to high temperatures, brakes wearing out and possibly even brake failure. There is a risk of accident. Avoid placing excessive stress on the brake system.

Warning

In idle state or with the engine switched off, safety functions, for instance engine braking effect, braking assistance and steering assistance, may not be available. There is a risk of accident. Do not attempt

to drive in idle state or with the engine switched off.

Brake disc corrosion

Corrosion on the brake discs and contamination on the brake pads are increased by the following circumstances:

  • Low mileage.
  • Extended periods when the vehicle is not used at all.
  • Infrequent use of the brakes.
  • Aggressive, acidic, or alkaline cleaning agents.

Corrosion buildup on the brake discs will cause a pulsating effect on the brakes in their response - generally this cannot be corrected.

Condensation water under the parked vehicle

When using the automatic climate control, condensation water develops and collects underneath the vehicle.

Ground clearance

MINI Countryman (2020) - Ground clearance - 1

NOTICE

If the ground clearance is insufficient, e.g., curbs or underground garage entrances, contact with vehicle parts, e.g., spoiler, and the underbody may occur. There is a risk of damage to property. Ensure that there is sufficient ground clearance available.

Roof-mounted luggage rack

General information

Installation only possible with roof rack. Roof racks are available as special accessories.

Securing

Follow the installation instructions of the roof rack.

Loading

Because roof-mounted luggage racks raise the vehicle's center of gravity when loaded, they have a major effect on vehicle handling and steering response.

Therefore, note the following when loading and driving:

  • Do not exceed the approved roof/axle loads and the approved gross vehicle weight.
  • Be sure that adequate clearance is maintained for tilting and opening the glass sunroof.
  • Distribute the roof load uniformly.
  • The roof load should not extend past the loading area.
  • Always place the heaviest pieces on the bottom.
  • Secure the roof luggage firmly, for instance using ratchet straps.
  • Do not let objects project into the opening path of the tailgate.
  • Drive cautiously and avoid sudden ac- celeration and braking maneuvers. Take corners gently.

Driving on poor roads

Concept

Because of its greater ground clearance, the vehicle can be driven on a variety of road types and qualities.

All-wheel drive can help improve forward momentum.

Safety information

NOTICE

Objects in unpaved areas, for instance stones or branches, can damage the vehicle. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not drive on unpaved terrain.

When driving on poor roads

For your own safety, for the safety of passengers and of the vehicle, heed the following points:

  • Familiarize yourself with the vehicle before driving.
  • Do not take risks when driving.
  • Adjust the speed to the road surface conditions. The steeper and more uneven the road surface, the slower the speed.
  • When driving on steep uphill or down-hill grades: add engine oil and coolant up to near the MAX mark.
  • Avoid that the chassis bottom coming in contact with the ground. The ground clearance may vary depending on the vehicle load.
  • When wheels continue to spin, depress the accelerator so that driving stability control systems can distribute the driving force to the wheels. Activate DTC Dynamic Traction Control if available.

After a trip on poor roads

Note the following to maintain driving safety:

– Clear heavy soiling from the body.
- Keep the wheels and tires free of mud, snow, ice, etc., and check them for damage.

Driving on racetracks

Higher mechanical and thermal loads during racetrack operation lead to increased wear. This wear is not covered by the warranty. The vehicle is not designed for use in motor sports competition.

Saving fuel

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

General information

The vehicle contains advanced technologies for the reduction of consumption and emission values.

Fuel consumption depends on a number of different factors.

The implementation of certain measures, driving style and regular maintenance can influence fuel consumption and environmental impact.

Remove unnecessary cargo

Additional weight increases fuel consumption.

Remove attached parts following use

Remove auxiliary mirrors, roof-mounted or rear luggage racks which are no longer required following use.

Attached parts on the vehicle impair the aerodynamics and increase the fuel consumption.

Close the windows and glass sunroof

Driving with the glass sunroof and windows open results in increased air resistance and raises fuel consumption.

Tires

General information

Tires can affect consumption in various ways, for instance tire size may influence consumption.

Check the tire inflation pressure regularly

Check and, if needed, correct the tire inflation pressure at least twice a month and before starting on a long trip.

Low tire inflation pressure increases rolling resistance and thus raises fuel consumption and tire wear.

Drive away without delay

Do not wait for the engine to warm-up while the vehicle remains stationary. Start driving right away, but at moderate engine speeds.

This is the fastest way for the cold engine to reach its operating temperature.

Look well ahead when driving

Driving smoothly and proactively reduces fuel consumption.

Avoid unnecessary acceleration and braking.

By maintaining a suitable distance to the vehicle driving ahead of you.

Avoid high engine speeds

Driving at low engine speeds lowers fuel consumption and reduces wear.

If necessary, observe the vehicle's gear shift indicator, refer to page 132.

Use coasting conditions

When approaching a red light, take your foot off the accelerator and let the vehicle coast to a halt.

For going downhill take your foot off the accelerator and let the vehicle roll.

The flow of fuel is interrupted while coasting.

Switch off the engine during longer stops

Switching off the engine

Switch off the engine during longer stops, for instance at traffic lights, railroad crossings or in traffic congestion.

Auto Start/Stop function

The Auto Start/Stop function of the vehicle automatically switches off the engine during a stop.

If the engine is switched off and then re-started rather than leaving the engine running constantly, fuel consumption and emissions are reduced. Savings can begin within a few seconds of switching off the engine.

In addition, fuel consumption is also determined by other factors, such as driving style, road conditions, maintenance or environmental factors.

Switch off any functions that are not currently needed

Functions such as seat heating and the rear window defroster require a lot of energy and consume additional fuel, especially in city and stop-and-go traffic.

Switch off these functions if they are not needed.

Have maintenance carried out

Have the vehicle maintained regularly to achieve optimal vehicle efficiency and service life. MINI recommends that maintenance work be performed by a MINI service center.

Also note the MINI maintenance systems, refer to page 298.

GREEN Mode

Concept

GREEN Mode supports a driving style that saves on consumption. For this purpose, the engine control and comfort features, for instance the climate control output, are adjusted.

For Steptronic transmission:

Under certain conditions the engine is automatically decoupled from the transmission in the D selector lever position. The vehicle continues traveling with the engine idling to reduce consumption. The D selector lever position remains engaged.

In addition, context-sensitive instructions are displayed to assist with an efficient driving style.

The achieved extended range is displayed in the instrument cluster as bonus range.

General information

The system includes the following functions and displays:

  • GREEN bonus range, refer to page 230.
  • GREEN tip, driving instruction, refer to page 230.
  • GREEN climate control, refer to page 229.
  • Coasting driving condition, refer to page 231.

Activating GREEN Mode

MINI Countryman (2020) - Activating GREEN Mode - 1

Press the MINI Driving Modes switch downward until GREEN is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Configuring GREEN

Via MINI Driving Modes switch

  1. Activating GREEN Mode.
  2. "Configure GREEN"
  3. Select the desired setting.

Via the Central Information Display (CID)

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle settings"

  3. If necessary, "Driving mode"

  4. "Configure GREEN"
  5. Select the desired setting.

Activating/deactivating the functions

The following functions can be activated/deactivated:

  • "GREEN speed warning"
  • "GREEN climate control"
  • "Coasting"

Settings are stored for the driver profile currently used.

GREEN Limit

  • Activate the GREEN Limit:
    "GREEN speed warning":
    A GREEN tip is displayed if the speed of the set GREEN Limit is exceeded.
  • Setting the speed for the GREEN Limit: "Tip at:"
    Select the desired speed.

GREEN climate control

Climate control is set to be efficient.

By making a slight change to the set temperature, or adjusting the rate of heating or cooling of the car's interior consumption can be economized.

The power output to the seat heater and exterior mirror is reduced.

Coasting

Efficiency can be optimized by disengaging the engine and coasting, refer to page 231, with the engine idling.

This function is only available in GREEN Mode.

Deactivate the function to use the braking effect of the engine when traveling downhill.

GREEN potential savings

Shows potential savings with the current settings in percentages.

Display in the instrument cluster

GREEN bonus range

MINI Countryman (2020) - GREEN bonus range - 1

A modified driving style helps you extend your driving range.

The range extension can be displayed as the bonus range in the instrument cluster.

The bonus range is shown in the range display.

The bonus range is automatically reset every time the vehicle is refueled.

  • Green display: efficient driving style.
  • Gray display: modify driving style, for instance by backing off the accelerator pedal.

Efficiency display

MINI Countryman (2020) - Efficiency display - 1

A bar display in the instrument cluster indicates your current driving efficiency.

Mark in the left area, arrow 1: display for energy recovered

by coasting or when braking.

Mark in the right area, arrow 2: display when accelerating.

The efficiency of your driving style is shown by the position of the mark:

  • Mark inside the green range: efficient driving style.
  • Mark outside the green range: modify driving style, for example by backing off the accelerator.

GREEN tip, driving instruction

MINI Countryman (2020) - GREEN tip, driving instruction - 1

text_image D GREEN + 46.8 km

The GREEN tip indicates that your driving style can be modified to be more efficient, for example by backing off the accelerator.

Activating/deactivating the display

Activate information relating to the driving style and GREEN tips in the instrument cluster using the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Displays"
  4. "Instrument panel"
  5. "GREEN info"

GREEN tip, symbols

An additional symbol and text instructions are displayed.

Symbol Measure
MINI Countryman (2020) - GREEN tip, symbols - 1

For an efficient driving style, look well ahead when driving, accelerate conservatively, and delay accelerating.

MINI Countryman (2020) - GREEN tip, symbols - 2

Reduce speed to the selected GREEN speed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - GREEN tip, symbols - 3

Steptronic transmission: Switch from M/S to D and avoid manual shift interventions.

Symbol Measure

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Measure - 1

Manual transmission: Follow the shift instructions.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Measure - 2

Manual transmission: Engage neutral for an engine stop.

Coasting

Concept

The function helps to conserve fuel.

To do this, under certain conditions the engine is automatically decoupled from the transmission when selector lever position D is set. The vehicle continues traveling with the engine idling to reduce consumption. Selector lever position D remains engaged.

This driving condition is referred to as coasting.

As soon as you step on the brake or accelerator pedal, the engine is automatically coupled again.

General information

Coasting is a component of the GREEN driving mode.

Coasting is automatically activated when the GREEN driving mode is called via the MINI Driving Modes switch, refer to page 168.

A proactive driving style helps the driver to use the function often and supports the efficient effect of coasting.

Functional requirements

The function is available in the speed range from approx. 15 mph/25 km/h up to 100 mph/160 km/h.

- Accelerator pedal and brake pedal are not operated.

  • The selector lever is in selector lever position D.
  • Engine and transmission are at operating temperature.
  • With a camera in the area of the interior mirror: the system does not detect any vehicles ahead of you.

Operation via shift paddles

Concept

Depending on your vehicle's equipment, the coasting mode can be influenced with the shift paddles.

Activating/deactivating coasting via shift paddles

  1. Shift to the highest gear by pulling the right shift paddle.
  2. To activate coasting mode, actuate the right shift paddle again.

To deactivate, actuate the left shift paddle.

Display

Display in the instrument cluster

MINI Countryman (2020) - Display in the instrument cluster - 1

The bar display below the tachometer is filled in green and the mark appears at the zero point. The tachometer shows the idle speed.

System limits

The function is not available if one of the following conditions applies:

  • DSC OFF and TRACTION are activated.
  • Cruise control is activated.
  • If driving in the dynamic limit range.
  • If driving on steep uphill or downhill grades.

  • The battery charge state is temporarily too low.

  • The vehicle electrical system is drawing excessive current.

MINI Countryman (2020) - System limits - 1

natural_image Yellow Mini Club Top 1302 machine on a workbench, placed on a wooden floor with a white hard hat and orange rope nearby (no visible text or symbols on the device itself)

MINI Countryman (2020) - System limits - 2

ENTERTAINMENT

General information 236

Tone 238

Radio 240

Audio 248

General information

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Control elements

MINI Countryman (2020) - Control elements - 1

text_image 1 2 3 4 BAND MODE 1 2 3 4 5 6 5

1 Waveband/satellite radio
2 Change entertainment sources
3 Sound output on/off, volume
4 Changing the station/track
5 Programmable memory buttons

Sound output

Safety information

Warning

A high sound output volume can damage your hearing. There is a risk of injury. Do not adjust the volume too high.

Volume and sound output

MINI Countryman (2020) - Volume and sound output - 1

- Turn the button to adjust the volume.

- Press the button to switch off the sound output. Pressing the button again restores the previous volume setting.

Audio recording playback is stopped during muting.

Entertainment sources

General information

Possible entertainment sources:

  • Radio, refer to page 240.
  • USB audio, refer to page 248.
  • Bluetooth audio, refer to page 248.

Changing the entertainment source

On the radio:

  1. Press the button.

A list of all currently available entertainment sources is displayed.

  1. Press the button again to select an entertainment source.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "Media/Radio"

A list of all possible entertainment sources is displayed.

  1. Select the desired entertainment source.

Via the button on the Controller:

  1. Press the button.

The most recently selected entertainment source is played.

  1. Press the button again.

A list of all currently available entertainment sources is displayed.

  1. Select the desired entertainment source.

Adjusting the selection list of entertainment sources

It is possible to select which entertainment sources are displayed in the selection list. The entertainment source currently being played cannot be removed from the selection list.

  1. "Media/Radio"

A list of all possible entertainment sources is displayed.

  1. "Personalize menu"

  2. Select the desired setting.

Tone

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

General information

The settings are stored in the currently used driver profile.

Treble, bass, balance, and fader

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Tone"
  3. Select the desired setting:

  4. "Treble": treble adjustment.

  5. "Bass": depth adjustment.
  6. "Balance": left/right volume distribution.
  7. "Fader": front/rear volume distribution.

  8. To adjust: turn the Controller.

  9. To store: press the Controller.

Volume equalization

Concept

An automatic increase of the volume can be set to compensate for the increasing driving noises at higher speeds.

Set automatic volume increase

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Tone"
  3. "Volume settings"
  4. Select the desired setting:

  5. "Speed volume": ratio of entertainment volume to speed.

  6. "PDC": ratio of the volume of the PDC signal tone to the entertainment volume.

The basic setting ensures that the signal tone is audible at any volume.

- "Gong": ratio of the volume of the signal tone, for instance for safety belt reminder, to the entertainment volume.

The basic setting ensures that the signal tone is audible at any volume.

- "Microphone": sensitivity of the microphone during a phone call.

The setting is adjusted while calling and is stored for the mobile phone used.

- "Speakers": volume of the loudspeakers during a phone call.

Audio recording playback is stopped during muting.

The setting is adjusted while calling and is stored for the mobile phone used.

Reset the tone settings

The tone settings are reset to the factory settings.

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Tone"
  3. "Reset"

Radio

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

General information

The settings are stored in the currently used driver profile.

AM/FM station

General information

Depending on the vehicle equipment and country version, it may not be possible to receive AM stations.

Radio Data System RDS

Concept

RDS broadcasts additional information, such as the station name, in the FM waveband.

It is recommended to switch on RDS.

Switching on/off

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "FM"

  3. Press the button.

  4. "RDS"

Selecting a station

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "FM" or "AM"

The last station listened to will be played and the station list displayed.

  1. Select the desired station.

Changing the station

On the radio:

MINI Countryman (2020) - Changing the station - 1

Press the left or right button.

The previous or next station from the list of stations is played.

Storing a station

General information

A symbol on the highlighted channel indicates whether the channel has already been stored.

Symbol Meaning

☆+ Station is not stored.
☆ Station is already stored.

Storing the station being played

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "FM" or "AM"
  3. Move the Controller to the left.
  4. "Save station" The storage list is displayed.
  5. Select the desired memory location.

Storing a station that is not being played

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "FM" or "AM"
  3. Highlight the desired station.
  4. Press the Controller and hold until the storage list is displayed.
  5. Select the desired memory location.

The stations can also be stored on the programmable memory buttons, refer to page 46.

Selecting a station manually

Station selection via the frequency.

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "FM" or "AM"
  3. Move the Controller to the left.
  4. "Manual search"
  5. To select the frequency: turn the Controller.
  6. To store the frequency: press the Controller.

Renaming a station

When storing a station with RDS signal, the RDS information transferred during storing is accepted as the station name. The station name can be changed.

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "FM"
  3. Select the desired station.
  4. Press the button.

  5. "Rename to:"

If necessary, wait until the name of the desired station appears.

  1. Press the Controller to store this name.

Additional station information

Concept

If a radio station broadcasts radio text or radio text plus, this information can be displayed, for instance the track or performer of the music. Availability, content and sequence are set by the radio station.

Displaying additional station information

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "FM"
  3. Select the desired station.
  4. Press the button.
  5. "Station info"

HD Radio™ reception

Concept

Many radio stations broadcast both analog and digital signals.

General information

When setting a station with a digital signal, it may take a few seconds before the station plays in digital quality.

Information about HD Radio stations whose station name ends with ...HD or with ...HD1:

In areas in which the station is not continuously received in digital mode, the playback switches between analog and digital reception. In this case, switch off digital radio reception.

Information about HD Radio multicast stations whose station name ends with ...HD2, ...HD3, ...:

In areas in which the station is not continuously received in digital mode, there may be interruptions of the audible signal lasting

several seconds. The duration of the interruption depends on the reception.

Activating/deactivating digital radio reception

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "FM" or "AM"
  3. Press the button.
  4. "HD Radio reception"

This symbol is displayed in the status line when the audio signal is digital.

Displaying additional information

Some stations broadcast additional information on the current track, such as the name of the artist.

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "FM" or "AM"
  3. Select a station.
  4. Press the button.
  5. "Station info"

License conditions

MINI Countryman (2020) - License conditions - 1

HD Radio Technology manufactured under license from iBiquity Digital Corporation. U. S. and Foreign Patents. HD Radio™ and the HD, HD Radio, and “Arc” logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp.

Satellite radio

General information

Before a channel can be played, you must subscribe to it via telephone. Several channels can be combined into specified packages.

Managing a subscription

General information

In order to enable or unsubscribe from channels, you must have reception. It is usually at its best when you have an unobstructed view of the sky. The channel name is displayed in the status line.

Enabling channels

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"

  3. Press the button.

  4. "Show subscription info" The phone number and identification number of the radio are displayed.

  5. Call the phone number to have the channel enabled.

You can unsubscribe from the channels again via this phone number.

Unsubscribing from channels

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"

  3. Press the button.

  4. "Show subscription info" The phone number and identification number of the radio are displayed.

  5. Call the phone number to cancel your subscription to the channel.

Selecting channels

You can only listen to enabled channels.

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"

The last channel played will be played back and the channel list displayed.

  1. Select the desired channel from the channel list.

To display information about the selected channel:

  1. Highlight a channel.
  2. Press the button.
  3. "Channel information"

Adjusting display of the channel list

The display of the playback list can be adjusted.

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"
  3. Move the Controller to the left.
  4. "Change view"
  5. Select the desired display:

- "Channel"

The name of the channel will be displayed.

- "Artist"

The name of the artist playing will be displayed.

- "Titles"

The name of the track playing will be displayed.

Changing the channel

MINI Countryman (2020) - Changing the channel - 1

Press the button on the radio.

The next and/or previous channel from the channel list is played.

Storing a channel

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"

A symbol on the highlighted channel indicates whether the channel has already been stored.

Symbol Meaning

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 1

Channel is not stored.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Symbol Meaning - 2

Channel is already stored.

To store the channel played:

  1. Move the Controller to the left.
  2. "Save station"

The storage list is displayed.

  1. Select the desired memory location.

Or:

  1. Highlight the played channel.
  2. Press the Controller.

The storage list is displayed.

  1. Select the desired memory location.

To store a channel other than the one played:

  1. Highlight the desired channel.
  2. Press the Controller and hold until the storage list is displayed.
  3. Select the desired memory location.

Or:

  1. Highlight the desired channel.
  2. Press the button.
  3. "Save in presets"

The storage list is displayed.

  1. Select the desired memory location.

The stations can also be stored on the programmable memory buttons.

Selecting a category

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"

  3. Move the Controller to the left.

  4. "Category"
  5. Select the desired category.

The subscribed channels from this category are displayed.

  1. Select the desired channel.

Timeshift

General information

The channel you are currently listening to is stored in a buffer for up to an hour.

Prerequisite: the signal must be available.

The stored audio track can be played with a delay following the live broadcast. When the memory is full, the older tracks are overwritten. The memory is cleared when a new channel is selected or when the vehicle is switched off.

Opening the timeshift function

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"
  3. Move the Controller to the left.
  4. "Time shift"

Time shift forward/reverse

Within the stored recording, it is possible to jump to any point in time.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Time shift forward/reverse - 1

Press the button on the radio or turn the Controller.

You can jump to the next or the previous track.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Time shift forward/reverse - 2

Press and hold the button on the radio.

The recording is spooled forward or back.

Timeshift menu

Symbol Function

Go to the live broadcast.

Automatic timeshift deactivated/activated.

▷ / ||Playback/pause.

Automatic timeshift

With automatic timeshift, audio playback is paused for the following events.

  • Incoming and outgoing telephone calls.
  • Activation of the voice activation system.
  • Muting.

After that, audio playback is continued from the time of the interruption.

  1. Move the Controller to the left.
  2. To activate:

"Automatic time shift"

Deactivate:

"Automatic time shift".

Smart Favorites

General information

A maximum of 6 channels can be stored as Smart Favorites.

If a stored channel is selected, the current track will be played from the beginning.

Adding the current channel to Smart Favorites

  1. Press the button.
  2. "Add to Smart Favorites"

Removing the current channel from Smart Favorites

  1. Press the button.
  2. "Remove from Smart Favorites"

Selecting Smart Favorite

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"
  3. Move the Controller to the left.
  4. "Category"
  5. Select a Smart Favorite.
    The subscribed channels from this category are displayed.
  6. Select the desired channel.

Favorites

General information

A performer, a track, a league or a team can be stored as a favorite. If the stored favorite is played on a channel, a message appears on the Control Display. Up to 30 Favorites can be stored.

Storing the artist or track

It is only possible to store Favorites that are currently being broadcast. The channel information must be available.

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"
  3. Move the Controller to the left.
  4. "Add to favorites"
  5. Highlight the performer or track, and press the Controller.

A symbol indicates whether the artist and track were already stored.

Symbol Meaning

Artist/track is not stored.
❤ Artist/track was already stored.

Storing the league or team

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"
  3. Move the Controller to the left.
  4. "Add to favorites"
  5. "Add sports information"
  6. Select the type of sport desired.
  7. Select the desired team.

Activating/deactivating a notification

A notification can be displayed when a selected favorite is being played.

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"
  3. Press the button.
  4. "Manage favorites" The stored Favorites are displayed.

  5. "Activate alert" Set a check mark to activate notification for the selected Favorites. Remove the check mark to deactivate notification for the selected Favorites.

  6. Select the desired Favorites.

Opening the Favorites

If an activated favorite is played back, the following message is displayed for approx. 20 seconds: "Favorite on air!".

To change to the played Favorites:

Tap on the message on the Control Display. Or:

  1. Move the Controller to the left.

  2. "Favorite alert"

Select the symbol while the message is shown.

The displayed favorite is played.

When the message disappears, the list of channels that is currently playing one of the stored Favorites can be displayed.

  1. Move the Controller to the left.
  2. "Category"
  3. Select the Favorites list.

The channels that are currently playing a favorite are displayed.

  1. Select the channel that you would like to change to.

Deleting Favorites

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"
  3. Pres
  4. "Manage favorites"

The stored Favorites are displayed.

  1. Highlight the desired favorites.
  2. Pres
  3. "Delete entry"

Traffic Jump

General information

Traffic and weather information for a selected region is broadcast every few minutes.

Selecting a region

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"
  3. Press the button.

  4. "Configure jump"

  5. Select the desired region.

Activating/deactivating Traffic Jump

You must have reception in order to activate or deactivate.

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"
  3. Press the button.
  4. "Configure jump"
  5. "Jump to:"

Place a check mark to activate Traffic Jump.

Information for the selected region is broadcast as soon as it is available.

Remove the check mark to deactivate Traffic Jump.

Channel magazine

In the channel magazine, the current and subsequent program for each channel booked is displayed.

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Satellite radio"
  3. Move the Controller to the left.
  4. SiriusXM program guide"

Automatic update

About twice a year, Sirius performs an update of the channel names and positions. The update takes place automatically and may take several minutes.

System limits

- Reception may not be available in some situations, such as under certain environmental or topographical conditions. The satellite radio has no influence on this.

  • Graphical contents can be received under certain circumstances.
  • The signal may not be available in tunnels or underground garages next to tall buildings or near trees, mountains or other powerful sources of radio interference.

Stored stations

General information

Up to 40 stations can be stored.

Selecting a station

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Presets"
  3. Select the desired station.

Deleting a station

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Presets"
  3. Highlight the station you want to delete.
  4. Press the button.
  5. "Delete entry"

Audio

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

General information

Music tracks, audio books, and podcasts can be played back. Sound is played back through the vehicle loudspeakers.

Settings are stored for the driver profile currently used.

Depending on the vehicle equipment, the following audio sources can be used:

Symbol Meaning

USB storage device.

Bluetooth audio.

USB storage device

playable formats

Popular audio formats such as MP3, AAC or WMA can be played.

Apple iPod/iPhone

The music search and playback of Apple iPod/iPhone are supported.

Audio player and storage media with USB port

Information on all music tracks, for instance artist, genre or track, as well as playback lists, are transmitted into the vehicle. This may take some time, depending on the USB storage device, file size, and number of tracks.

During the transfer, the tracks can be called up via the file directory.

The information for approx. 10,000 tracks can be stored in the vehicle.

Music tracks with integrated Digital Rights Management DRM cannot be played.

Selecting the USB storage device

Information on the USB interface, refer to page 206.

  1. Connect the USB storage device to the USB interface.
    The adapter cable supplied with the USB storage device would be ideal.

  2. "Media/Radio"

  3. "USB"

Or:

Select the name of the USB storage device.

Further playback descriptions, refer to page 249.

Bluetooth audio

General information

- Playback of music files on external devices such as audio devices or mobile phones via Bluetooth.

  • The volume of the sound output depends on the device. If necessary, adjust the volume on the device.
  • Up to four external devices can be connected to the vehicle.

Functional requirements

  • Bluetooth device is connected to the vehicle.
  • Bluetooth audio playback was activated.

Selecting the Bluetooth device

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. Select the desired Bluetooth device from the list.

Further playback descriptions, refer to page 249.

If the Bluetooth device is not listed in the device list, Bluetooth audio playback may have not been activated. To activate Bluetooth audio playback, proceed as follows:

  1. "Media/Radio"
  2. "Manage mobile devices"
  3. Select the desired Bluetooth device.
  4. "Bluetooth® audio"

Playback

General information

Once an audio source has been selected, information on playback appears on the Control Display.

Information available for the current track followed by the playback list is shown on the Control Display. Content and scope of the playback list depend on the type of the selected playback source and the search criteria applied.

For USB and Bluetooth devices, the selected playback list is displayed. This can be the result of a search or of a previously stored playback list.

Further functions are displayed by moving the Controller to the left. The scope of these functions depends on the selected audio source.

Depending on the supported Bluetooth version, some Bluetooth device functions may not be available when using the Central Information Display (CID). If necessary, the missing functions can be accessed directly on the device itself.

Selecting a track

Select the desired track from the playlist. Starting with the selected track, all tracks of the playback list are played.

Changing the track

On the radio:

MINI Countryman (2020) - Changing the track - 1

Press the left or right button.

The previous or next track from the playlist is played.

Fast forward/reverse

On the radio:

MINI Countryman (2020) - Fast forward/reverse - 1

Press and hold the left or right button.

Search criteria

General information

The possible search criteria depend on the selected audio source.

Searching for track information

The following search criteria refer to the data stored in the track information.

  1. Move the Controller to the left.

  2. "Media search"

  3. Select the desired setting:

- "Search"

All the tracks containing the search string are displayed. Entering more characters will continue to narrow down the search results.

Tilt the Controller to the right to display the list of results.

- "Genres"

A list of all available genres is displayed.

Select a genre to display all respective artists.

- "Artists"

A list of all available artists is displayed.

Select an artist to display all respective albums and tracks.

- "Albums"

A list of all available albums is displayed.

Select an album to display all respective tracks.

- "Titles"

A list of all available tracks is displayed.

  1. Select album, if needed.

  2. Select the track at which the playback is going to begin.

The search for artists and titles can also be selected directly.

  1. Move the Controller to the left.

  2. "Artists" or "Titles"

Tracks where the selected search criterion is not stored are summarized under "unknown". Tracks without track information can only be found via the directory structure.

Search playlists

  1. Move the Controller to the left.

  2. "Media search"

  3. "Playlists"

A list of all available playback lists is displayed.

  1. Select the playback list.

  2. Select the track at which the playback is going to begin.

Information on playback appears on the Control Display. A playback list is created from the search results.

Search audio books and podcasts

Depending on the USB storage device and equipment, separate audio book and podcast searches are possible.

  1. Move the Controller to the left.

  2. "Media search"

  3. Select the desired setting:

- "Podcasts"

A list of all available podcasts is displayed.

- "Audio books"

A list of all available audio books is displayed.

  1. Select the track at which the playback is going to begin.

Information on playback appears on the Control Display. A playback list is created from the search results.

Search directory structure

It is possible to search the USB storage devices via the directory structure.

The names of folders and tracks correspond to folder and file names. The folder and file names can deviate from the names in the track information.

  1. Move the Controller to the left.
  2. "Media search"
  3. "Browse folder"
  4. Change into a sub folder, if needed.

Select the track at which the playback is going to begin.

Information on playback appears on the Control Display. A playback list is created from the search results.

Random playback

Concept

The current playlist or all tracks of the selected audio source are played back in random order.

Select random

  1. Move the Controller to the left.

  2. "Shuffle"

MINI Countryman (2020) - Select random - 1

natural_image Close-up of a black smartphone with a circular logo on its side, resting on a wooden surface with blurred background items (no text or symbols visible)

COMMUNICATION

Telephone 254

MINI Connected 258

Telephone

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Telephone functions

General information

Mobile phones can be connected to the vehicle via Bluetooth. Pair and connect the mobile phone with the vehicle, refer to page 51.

At high temperatures, the charge function of the mobile phone can be limited where appropriate and functions are no longer executed.

Do not operate a mobile phone that is connected to the vehicle on the mobile phone keypad, as this may lead to a malfunction.

When the mobile phone is used via the vehicle, refer to the owner's manual of the mobile phone.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Operating the integrated information systems and communication devices while driving can distract from traffic. It is possible to lose control of the vehicle. There is a risk of accident. Only use the systems or

devices when the traffic situation allows. As warranted, stop and use the systems and devices while the vehicle is stationary.

Incoming call

If the number of the caller is stored in the phone book and is transmitted by the network, the name of the contact is displayed. Otherwise, only the phone number is displayed.

Accepting a call

Incoming calls can be answered in several ways.

- Via Central Information Display (CID):

MINI Countryman (2020) - Accepting a call - 1

"Accept"

MINI Countryman (2020) - Accepting a call - 2

MINI Countryman (2020) - Accepting a call - 3

Press the corresponding button on the steering wheel.

Rejecting a call

"Reject"

Ending a call

- Via Central Information Display (CID):

MINI Countryman (2020) - Ending a call - 1

"End call"

MINI Countryman (2020) - Ending a call - 2

MINI Countryman (2020) - Ending a call - 3

Press the corresponding button on the steering wheel.

Last calls

The last outgoing, missed, and incoming calls are transferred to the vehicle.

Displays

  1. "Communication"

  2. "Recent calls"

  3. The 20 last calls are displayed.

Filtering call list

  1. "Calls:"
  2. Select the desired setting.

Selecting number from list

Select from list. Call is established via the mobile phone.

To cancel: "End call"

Active calls

Adjusting the volume

Turn the volume button on the radio during the call, until the desired volume is reached. The setting is stored for the driver profile currently used.

Automatic volume equalization

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "System settings"
  3. "Tone"
  4. "Volume settings"
  5. "Microphone" or "Speakers"
  6. To adjust: turn the Controller.
  7. To store: press the Controller.

Dialing a number

  1. "Communication"
  2. "Dial number"
  3. Enter the numbers.
  4. Select the symbol.

Holding, resuming

An active call can be put on hold and resumed later on.

- "Hold/Resume"

Call is put on hold.
- "Hold/Resume"
Call is resumed.

Muting the microphone

When a call is active, the microphone can be muted.

"Microphone"

The muted microphone is automatically activated:

  • When a new connection is established.
  • When switching between call parties.

DTMF suffix dialing

DTMF suffix dialing can be used for gaining access to network services or for controlling devices, for instance to make a remote inquiry of an answering machine. The DTMF code is needed for this purpose.

  1. "Keypad dialing"
  2. Enter DTMF code.

Calls with multiple parties

General information

You can switch between calls or connect two calls to a single conference call. These functions must be supported by the mobile phone and service provider.

Accepting a call while speaking to another party

If a second call comes in during an ongoing call, a call waiting signal sounds where appropriate.

"Accept"

The call is accepted and the existing call is put on hold.

Establishing a second call

An additional call can be established while a call is active.

  1. Contacts"

  2. Select new number.

The call is started and the first call is put on hold.

Switching between two calls, hold call

You can switch between two calls.

  1. Establish two calls.

  2. "Resume"

The call on hold is resumed.

Establishing a conference call

Two calls can be connected to a single telephone conference call. The calls must be made from the same mobile phone.

  1. Establish two calls.

  2. "Conference call"

Hands-free system

General information

Calls that are being made on the hands-free system can be continued on the mobile phone and vice versa.

From the mobile phone to the hands-free system

Calls that were begun outside of the Bluetooth range of the vehicle can be continued on the hands-free system with standby state or the ignition switched on. The vehicle key must be located in the vehicle for this to work.

Depending on the mobile phone, the system automatically switches to the hands-free system.

If the system does not switch over automatically, follow the instructions on the display of the mobile phone. Refer also to the owner's manual of the mobile phone.

From the hands-free system to the mobile phone

Calls that are made on the hands-free system can in some cases be continued on the mobile phone; this depends on the mobile phone.

Follow the instructions on the display of the mobile phone. Refer also to the owner's manual of the mobile phone.

Contacts

General information

Contacts from the mobile phone are transferred and displayed. Contact pictures can be displayed, if the mobile phone supports this function.

Displaying all contacts

  1. "Communication"

  2. "Contacts"

The contacts are listed in alphabetical order. Depending on the number of contacts, contact search and quick search are offered.

Contact search is available with more than 30 contacts.

  1. "Search"

  2. Enter the letters.

The hits are displayed on the right side.

  1. Move the Controller to the right.

  2. Select the contact to display it.

Quick search in lists

Quick search is available starting from 30 contacts. All letters, for which there are entries, are displayed in alphabetical order on the left of the Control Display.

  1. Turn the Controller to the left or right quickly.

All letters, for which contacts are stored, are displayed on the left.

  1. Select the first letter of the desired contact.

The first entry of the selected letter is displayed.

Sorting contacts

Contact names can be displayed in a different order. Depending on how the contacts were stored on the mobile phone, the sorting order of the contacts may differ from the selected sorting order.

  1. Press the button.

  2. "Sort contacts"

  3. "Last name" or "First name"

Voice command response

A connected smartphone can be used via voice operation.

Activate voice command response on the smartphone for this purpose.

Button on the steering wheelFunction
Press the button for at least 3 seconds. Voice command response is activated on the smartphone.

The symbol indicates that the voice command response is active. Depending on your vehicle's optional features, the sym-

bol can be displayed on the Control Display, in the instrument cluster or on the Head-up Display.

MINI Connected

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Safety information

Warning

Operating the integrated information systems and communication devices while driving can distract from traffic. It is possible to lose control of the vehicle. There is a risk of accident. Only use the systems or devices when the traffic situation allows. As warranted, stop and use the systems and devices while the vehicle is stationary.

Teleservices

Concept

Teleservices are services that help to maintain vehicle mobility.

General information

The offering depends on the equipment version of the vehicle and the country-specific variant.

For further information on the available services, the vehicle manufacturer recommends contacting a service center or customer support.

Teleservices can comprise the following services:

– Service Request, refer to page 258.
- Teleservice Report, refer to page 259.
- Teleservice Battery Guard, refer to page 259.
- Your dealer's service center, refer to page 259.
- Roadside Assistance, refer to page 310.

Requirements

  • Active MINI Connected contract or equipment version with intelligent emergency call.
  • Cellular network reception.
  • Ignition or standby state is switched on.

Service Request

Automatic Service Request

The Teleservice data on the vehicle's service requirements is sent automatically to the service center by MINI prior to the service deadline. If feasible, the service center will contact the customer about arranging a service appointment.

This way, the dealer's service center can plan the necessary work in advance. This shortens the duration of the service appointment.

Manual Service Request

Concept

Using a manually initiated Service Request, data on the vehicle's service requirements is directly sent by MINI to the service cen-

ter. If possible, the service center will contact you to arrange a service appointment.

General information

A Service Request can be started via a Check Control message, refer to page 125.

Carry out service registration via the Check Control message: "Service request".

Starting a Service Request

  1. "MINI Connected"
  2. "MINI Assist"
  3. "Teleservice Call"

Last Service Request

Concept

The last Service Request, for instance the last report to the dealer's service center, can be displayed on the Control Display.

Displaying the last Service Request

Check to see when the last Service Request was transmitted.

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle status"
  3. Move the Controller to the left.
  4. "Teleservice Call"

Teleservice Report

Concept

Transmits technical data that is evaluated for the ongoing development of MINI products from the vehicle to MINI in regular intervals, if needed.

General information

The Teleservice Report is free of charge and is activated in vehicles that meet the following requirements:

  • Certain technical requirements are met.
  • Active MINI Connected contract.
  • Equipped with intelligent emergency call.

Neither personal data nor position data is transmitted.

Teleservice Battery Guard

Concept

If the battery charge state falls below certain values, MINI will inform you or your dealer's service center directly in defined cases or the next time the vehicle is started.

General information

If necessary and possible, the dealer's service center will contact you to arrange a service appointment.

The Battery Guard Teleservice is available on a country-specific basis and under the following conditions:

  • Certain technical requirements are met.
  • Active MINI Connected contract.
  • To receive information from the Battery Guard Teleservice, your contact data must be stored in the MINI Connected customer portal.

Your dealer's service center

Concept

The preset service center is displayed and is possible to contact the service center.

General information

To use Service Partner management in the vehicle, log in with the MINI Connected access data in the MINI Connected customer portal. In addition, your vehicle must be assigned to your account in the MINI Connected customer portal.

Displaying service centers

The service center that is currently assigned to the vehicle is displayed as a contact in the vehicle.

  1. "MINI Connected" or "Communication"

  2. "MINI Assist"

  3. "Your service center" or select service partner management if necessary.

The assigned service center is displayed along with all its contact information.

Depending on the vehicle equipment, the following functions are available in a contact:

- Call contact.

Updating MINI Assist

Concept

Starts the manual update of all services available in the vehicle.

Updating services

  1. "MINI Connected"

MINI Countryman (2020) - Updating services - 1

  1. "Update MINI Services"

Customer support

Concept

Contact customer support for information on all aspects of your vehicle.

Calling customer support

  1. "MINI Connected"

  2. "MINI Assist"

  3. "Customer support"

The customer support is displayed and a voice connection is established. If a

voice connection is not established, dial the number manually.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Calling customer support - 1

natural_image Collection of old hand tools including brooch, saw, and pliers displayed on a weathered wooden wall (no text or symbols visible)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Calling customer support - 2

MOBILITY

Refueling 264

Fuel 266

Wheels and tires 268

Engine compartment 289

Engine oil 292

Coolant 296

Maintenance 298

Replacing components 300

Breakdown assistance 310

Care 319

Refueling

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

General information

Follow the fuel recommendation, refer to page 266, prior to refueling.

Safety information

NOTICE

With a driving range of less than 30 miles/50 km the engine may no longer have sufficient fuel. Engine functions are not ensured anymore. There is a risk of damage to property. Refuel promptly.

Fuel cap

Opening

  1. To open the fuel filler flap, press on the rear edge, arrow. The fuel filler flap opens.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's side panel with a white arrow pointing left (no text or symbols)
  1. Turn the fuel cap counterclockwise.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening - 2

natural_image Close-up of a car's side panel showing internal air vent and fuel drop (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Place the fuel cap in the bracket attached to the fuel filler flap.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening - 3

natural_image Close-up of a car's side panel showing internal components and a white arrow pointing to a valve (no text or symbols visible)

Closing

Warning

The retaining strap of the fuel cap can be jammed and crushed during closing. The cap cannot be correctly closed. Fuel or fuel vapors can escape. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. Pay attention that the retaining strap is not jammed or crushed when closing the cap.

  1. Fit the cap and turn it clockwise until you clearly hear a click.
  2. Press on the fuel filler flap until it engages.

Emergency unlocking

It may be necessary in certain situations to unlock the fuel filler flap manually, for instance with an electrical fault.

Have fuel filler flap unlocked by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Follow the following when re-fueling

General information

When refueling, insert the filler nozzle completely into the filler pipe. Lifting up the fuel pump nozzle during refueling causes:

  • Premature switching off.
  • Reduced return of the fuel vapors.

The fuel tank is full when the filler nozzle clicks off the first time.

Make sure that the fuel cap is closed properly after refueling, otherwise the emissions warning light may light up.

Follow safety regulations posted at the gas station.

Safety information

NOTICE

Fuels are toxic and aggressive. Overfilling of the fuel tank can damage the fuel system. Painted surfaces may be damaged by contact with fuel. Escaping fuel can harm the environment. There is a risk of damage to property. Avoid overfilling.

Fuel

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Fuel recommendation

General information

Depending on the region, many gas stations sell fuel that has been customized to winter or summer conditions. Fuel that is available in winter, for instance helps make a cold start easier.

Gasoline

General information

For the best fuel efficiency, the gasoline should be sulfur-free or very low in sulfur content.

Fuels that are marked on the gas pump as containing metal must not be used.

Fuels with a maximum ethanol content of 25 %, i. e. E10 or E25, may be used for refueling.

Ethanol should meet the following quality standards:

US: ASTM 4806-xx

CAN: CGSB-3.511-xx

xx: comply with the current standard in each case.

Safety information

NOTICE

Even small quantities of the wrong fuel or wrong fuel additives can damage the fuel system and engine. Furthermore, the catalytic converter is permanently damaged.

There is a risk of damage to property. Do not refuel or add the following in the case of gasoline engines:

  • Leaded gasoline.
  • Metallic additives, for instance manganese or iron.

Do not press the Start/Stop button after refueling with the wrong fuel. Contact a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

NOTICE

Incorrect fuels can damage the fuel system and the engine. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not use fuels with a higher percentage of ethanol than recommended. Do not refuel with fuels containing methanol, e.g. M5 to M100.

NOTICE

Fuel that does not comply with the minimum quality can compromise engine function or cause engine damage. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not fill with fuel that does not comply with the minimum quality.

CAUTION

The use of poor-quality fuels may result in harmful engine deposits or damage. Additionally, problems relating to drivability, starting and stalling, especially under certain environmental conditions such as high ambient temperature and high altitude, may occur.

If drivability problems are encountered, we recommend switching to a high quality gasoline brand and a higher octane grade — AKI number — for a few tank fills. To avoid harmful engine deposits, it is highly recommended to purchase gasoline from Top Tier retailers.

Failure to comply with these recommendations may result in the need for unscheduled maintenance.

MINI recommends AKI 91.

John Cooper Works:

MINI recommends AKI 93.

Refuel with this gasoline to achieve the rated performance and consumption values.

Minimum fuel grade

MINI recommends AKI 89.

John Cooper Works:

If you use gasoline with this minimum AKI Rating, the engine may produce knocking sounds when starting at high external temperatures. This has no effect on the engine life.

Wheels and tires

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Tire inflation pressure

General information

The tire characteristics and tire inflation pressure influence the following:

  • The service life of the tires.
  • Road safety.
  • Driving comfort.
  • Fuel consumption.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

A tire with too little or no tire inflation pressure may heat up significantly and sustain damage. This will have a negative impact on aspects of handling, such as steering and braking response. There is a risk of accident. Regularly check the tire inflation pressure, and correct it as needed, for instance twice a month and before a long trip.

Tire inflation pressure specifications

In the tire inflation pressure table

The tire inflation pressure table, refer to page 270, contains all tire inflation pressure specifications for the specified tire sizes at the ambient temperature. The tire inflation pressure values apply to tire sizes approved by the manufacturer of the vehicle for the vehicle type.

To identify the correct tire inflation pressure, please note the following:

  • Tire sizes of your vehicle.
  • Maximum permitted driving speed.

Checking the tire inflation pressure

General information

Tires heat up while driving. The tire inflation pressure increases with the tire temperature.

Tires have a natural, consistent loss of tire inflation pressure.

The displays of inflation devices may under-read by up to 0.1 bar/2 psi.

Checking using tire inflation pressure specifications in the tire inflation pressure table

The tire inflation pressure specifications in the tire inflation pressure table only relate to cold tires or tires at the same temperature as the ambient temperature.

Only check the tire inflation pressure levels when the tires are cold, i.e.:

- Driving range of max. 1.25 miles/2 km has not been exceeded.

- If the vehicle has not moved again for at least 2 hours after a trip.

  1. Determine the intended tire inflation pressure levels for the mounted tires.
  2. Check the tire inflation pressure in all four tires, using a pressure gage, for example.
  3. Correct the tire inflation pressure if the actual tire inflation pressure deviates from the intended tire inflation pressure.
  4. Check whether all valve caps are screwed onto the tire valves.

After correcting the tire inflation pressure

For run-flat tires: reinitialize run-flat tires.

For the Tire Pressure Monitor TPM: reset the Tire Pressure Monitor TPM.

Checking the tire inflation pressure of the emergency wheel

Also check the tire inflation pressure of the emergency wheel in the cargo area regularly, and correct it as needed.

Tire inflation pressures up to 100 mph/160 km/h

For speeds of up to 100 mph/160 km/h and for optimum driving comfort, note the pressure values in the tire inflation pressure table, refer to page 270, and adjust as necessary.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Tire inflation pressures up to 100 mph/160 km/h - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's side panel showing the door and seat, with no visible text or symbols.

These pressure values can also be found on the tire inflation pressure label on the driver's door pillar.

Do not exceed a speed of 100 mph/160 km/h.

Tire pressure values up to 100 mph/160 km/h

COOPER, COOPER ALL4

Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
Specifications in bar/PSI with cold tires
MINI Countryman (2020) - COOPER, COOPER ALL4 - 1

text_image Diagram showing human silhouette, car, and delivery box with Chinese text labels

225/55 R 17 97 H A/S
2.2 / 32 2.2 / 32
225/50 R 18 95 V A/S
225/55 R 17 97 W
225/50 R 18 95 W
225/50 R 18 99 W XL
205/65 R 16 95 H M+S
225/55 R 17 97 H M+S
205/55 R 18 96 H XL M+S
225/50 R 18 95 H M+S
Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
225/45 R 19 92 2.4 / 35 2.4 / 35 W
225/45 R 19 96 W XL
225/45 R 19 96 Y XL
205/60 R 17 93 H M+S
Emergency wheel Speed up to a max. of 50 mph / 80 km/h
T 115/95 R 17 4.2 / 60 95 M

COOPER S, COOPER S ALL4

Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
Specifications in bar/PSI with cold tires
MINI Countryman (2020) - COOPER S, COOPER S ALL4 - 1

text_image Diagram showing human silhouette icons and a car with a plus sign, likely illustrating a concept or concept related to vehicle ownership or delivery.

225/50 R 18
95 V A/S
225/50 R 18
95 W
225/55 R 17
97 H M+S
225/50 R 18
95 H M+S
2.2 / 32 2.2 / 32

Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
225/45 R 192.4 / 35 2.4 / 35
96 Y XL
205/60 R 17
93 H M+S
205/55 R 18
96 H XL M+S
225/45 R 19
92 W
225/45 R 19
96 W XL
Emergency wheelSpeed up to a max. of 50 mph / 80 km/h
T 115/95 R 174.2 / 60
95 M

JOHN COOPER WORKS

Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
Specifications in bar/PSI with cold tiresMINI Countryman (2020) - COOPER S, COOPER S ALL4 - 2
225/50 R 1895 V A/S2.2 / 32 2.2 / 32
225/50 R 1895 W
205/55 R 1896 H XL M+S
225/50 R 1895 H M+S
225/45 R 1992 W2.4 / 35 2.4 / 35

Tire inflation pressures at max. speeds above 100 mph/160 km/h

Warning

In order to drive at maximum speeds in excess of 100 mph/160 km/h, please observe, and, if necessary, adjust tire pressures for speeds exceeding 100 mph/160 km/h from the relevant table on the following pages. Otherwise, tire damage and accidents could occur.

For speeds over 100 mph/160 km/h and for optimum driving comfort, note the pressure values in the tire inflation pressure table, refer to page 272, and adjust as necessary.

Tire inflation pressure values over 100 mph/160 km/h

COOPER, COOPER ALL4

Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
Specifications in bar/PSI with cold tires
MINI Countryman (2020) - COOPER, COOPER ALL4 - 1

text_image Diagram showing human silhouette icons and a car with a plus sign, likely illustrating a basic transportation or safety concept.

225/55 R 17 97 H A/S
225/50 R 18 95 V A/S
225/55 R 17 97 W
225/50 R 18 95 W
225/50 R 18 99 W XL
205/65 R 16 95 H M+S
225/55 R 17 97 H M+S
205/55 R 18 96 H XL M+S
225/50 R 18 95 H M+S
Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
225/45 R 19 92 2.6 / 38 2.6 / 38 W
225/45 R 19 96 W XL
225/45 R 19 96 Y XL
205/60 R 17 93 H M+S
Emergency wheel Speed up to a max. of 50 mph / 80 km/h
T 115/95 R 17 4.2 / 60 95 M

COOPER S, COOPER S ALL4

Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
Specifications in bar/PSI with cold tires
MINI Countryman (2020) - COOPER S, COOPER S ALL4 - 1

text_image Diagram illustrating human silhouette representation with a car and a box, indicating addition or replacement of a vehicle.

225/50 R 18 2.6 / 38 2.6 / 38
95 V A/S
225/50 R 18 95 W
225/55 R 17 97 H M+S
225/50 R 18 95 H M+S
225/45 R 19 2.6 / 38 2.6 / 38 96 Y XL
205/60 R 17 93 H M+S
205/55 R 18 96 H XL M+S

Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
225/45 R 192.8 / 41 2.8 / 41
92 W
225/45 R 19
96 W XL
Emergency wheelSpeed up to a max. of 50 mph / 80 km/h
T 115/95 R 174.2 / 60
95 M

JOHN COOPER WORKS

Tire size Pressure specifications in bar/PSI
Specifications in bar/PSI with cold tiresMINI Countryman (2020) - COOPER S, COOPER S ALL4 - 2
225/50 R 1895 V A/S2.6 / 38 2.6 / 38
225/50 R 1895 W
205/55 R 1896 H XL M+S
225/50 R 1895 H M+S
225/45 R 1992 W2.8 / 41 2.8 / 41

Tire identification marks

Tire size

205/45 R 17 84 V

205: nominal width in mm

45: aspect ratio in %

R: radial tire code

17: rim diameter in inches

84: load rating, not for ZR tires

V: speed rating, before the R on ZR tires

Maximum tire load

Maximum tire load is the maximum permissible weight for which the tire is approved. Locate the maximum tire load on the tire sidewall and the Gross Axle Weight Rating - GAWR - on the certification label on the driver's door pillar. Divide the tire load by 1.1. It must be greater than one-half of the vehicle's Gross Axle Weight Rating - GAWR. Note, front vs. rear GAWR and tire loads, respectively.

Speed letter

Designation Maximum speed
Q up to 100 mph/160 km/h
R: up to 106 mph/170 km/h
S up to 112 mph/180 km/h
T up to 118 mph/190 km/h
H up to 131 mph/210 km/h
V up to 150 mph/240 km/h
W up to 167 mph/270 km/h
Y up to 186 mph/300 km/h

Tire Identification Number

DOT-Code: DOT xxxx xxx 2119

xxxx: manufacturer code for the tire brand xxx: tire size and tire design

2119: tire age

Tires with DOT codes meet the guidelines of the U.S. Department of Transportation.

Tire age

Recommendation

Regardless of the tire tread, replace tires at least every 6 years.

Manufacture date

You can find the manufacture date of the tire on the tire's sidewall.

Designation Manufacture date

DOT ... 2119 21st week, 2019

Uniform Tire Quality Grading

Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width.

E.g.: Treadwear 200; Traction AA; Temperature A

DOT Quality Grades

Treadwear

Traction AA A B C

Temperature A B C

All passenger vehicle tires must conform to Federal Safety Requirements in addition to these grades.

Treadwear

The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. E.g., a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half, 1 g, times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate.

Traction

The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C.

Those grades represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.

The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics.

Temperature

The temperature grades are A, the highest, B, and C, representing the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades Band A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.

Warning

The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.

RSC - Run-flat tires

Run-flat tires, refer to page 277, are labeled with a circular symbol containing the letters RSC marked on the sidewall.

M+S

Winter and all-season tires with better cold weather performance than summer tires.

Tire tread

Summer tires

Do not drive with a tire tread of less than 0.12 in/3 mm, otherwise there is an increased risk of hydroplaning.

Winter tires

Do not drive with a tire tread of less than 0.16 in/4 mm, as such tires are less suitable for winter operation.

Minimum tread depth

MINI Countryman (2020) - Minimum tread depth - 1

natural_image Abstract 3D rendering of layered geometric structures with no visible text or symbols

Wear indicators are distributed around the tire's circumference and have the legally required minimum height of 0.063 inches/1.6 mm.

The positions of the wear indicators are marked on the tire sidewall with TWI, Tread Wear Indicator.

Tire damage

General information

Inspect your tires regularly for damage, foreign objects lodged in the tread, and tread wear.

Driving over rough or damaged road surfaces, as well as debris, curbs and other obstacles can cause serious damage to wheels, tires and suspension parts. This is more likely to occur with low-profile tires, which provide less cushioning between the wheel and the road. Be careful to avoid road hazards and reduce your speed, especially if your vehicle is equipped with low-profile tires.

Indications of tire damage or other vehicle malfunctions:

  • Unusual vibrations.
  • Unusual tire or running noises.
  • Unusual handling such as a strong tendency to pull to the left or right.

Damage can be caused by the following situations, for instance:

  • Driving over curbs.
  • Road damage.
    – Tire inflation pressure too low.
  • Vehicle overloading.
  • Incorrect tire storage.

Safety information

Warning

Damaged tires can lose tire inflation pressure, which can lead to loss of vehicle control. There is a risk of accident. If tire damage is suspected while driving, immediately reduce speed and stop. Have wheels and tires checked. For this purpose, drive carefully to the nearest dealer's service center or another qualified service

center or repair shop. Have vehicle towed or transported as needed. Do not repair damaged tires, but have them replaced.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

Tires can become damaged by driving over obstacles, e.g., curbs or road damage, at high speed. Larger wheels have a smaller tire cross-section. The smaller the tire cross-section, the higher the risk of tire damage. There is a danger of accidents and property damage. If possible, avoid driving over objects or road conditions that may damage tires, or drive over them slowly and carefully.

Changing wheels and tires

Mounting and wheel balancing

Have mounting and wheel balancing carried out by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Wheel and tire combination

General information

You can ask the dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop about the correct wheel/tire combination and wheel rim versions for the vehicle.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Wheels and tires which are not suitable for your vehicle can damage parts of the vehicle, for instance due to contact with the body due to tolerances despite the same official size rating. There is a risk of an accident. The manufacturer of your ve-

hicle strongly suggests that you use wheels and tires that have been recommended by the vehicle manufacturer for your vehicle type.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

Incorrect wheel/tire combinations will have a negative impact on the vehicle's handling and on the function of a variety of systems, such as the Anti-lock Brake System or Dynamic Stability Control. There is a risk of accident. To maintain good handling and vehicle response, use only tires with a single tread configuration from a single manufacturer. The manufacturer of the vehicle recommends that you use wheels and tires that have been recommended by the vehicle manufacturer for your vehicle type. Following tire damage, have the original wheel/tire combination remounted on the vehicle as soon as possible.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Recommended tire brands - 1

natural_image Close-up of a weather tire with a star symbol on the side (no text or symbols present)

For each tire size, the manufacturer of the vehicle recommends certain tire brands. The tire brands can be identified by a star on the tire sidewall.

New tires

Tire traction is not optimal due to manufacturing circumstances when tires are brand-

new; they achieve their full traction potential after a break-in time.

Drive conservatively for the first 200 miles/300 km.

Retreaded tires

MINI Countryman (2020) - Retreaded tires - 1

Warning

Retreaded tires can have different tire casing structures. With advanced age the service life can be limited. There is a risk of an accident. The manufacturer of your vehicle does not recommend the use of retreaded tires.

The manufacturer of the vehicle does not recommend the use of retreaded tires.

Winter tires

Winter tires are recommended for operating on winter roads.

Although so-called all-season M+S tires provide better winter traction than summer tires, they usually do not provide the same level of performance as winter tires.

Maximum speed of winter tires

If the maximum speed of the vehicle is higher than the permissible speed for the winter tires, then attach a label showing the permissible maximum speed in the field of view. The label is available from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

With winter tires mounted, observe and do not exceed the permissible maximum speed.

Changing runflat tires

For your own safety, use only runflat tires. No spare tire is available in the case of a flat tire. Further information is available from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Rotating wheels between axles

Different wear patterns can occur on the front and rear axles depending on individual driving conditions. The tires can be rotated in pairs between the axles to achieve even wear. Further information is available from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop. After rotating, check the tire pressure and correct, if needed.

Storing tires

Tire inflation pressure

Do not exceed the maximum tire inflation pressure indicated on the side wall of the tire.

Storage

Store wheels and tires in a cool, dry and dark place.

Always protect tires against all contact with oil, grease, and solvents.

Do not leave tires in plastic bags.

Remove dirt from wheels or tires.

Run-flat tires

Concept

Run-flat tires permit continued driving under restricted conditions even in the event of a complete loss of tire inflation pressure.

General information

The wheels are composed of tires that are self-supporting to a limited degree.

The support of the sidewall allows the tire to remain drivable to a restricted degree in the event of a tire inflation pressure loss.

Follow the instructions for continued driving with a flat tire.

Safety information

Warning

Your vehicle handles differently with a run-flat tire with no or low inflation pressure; for instance, your lane stability when braking is reduced, braking distances are longer and the self-steering properties will change. There is a risk of accident. Drive moderately and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.

Label

MINI Countryman (2020) - Label - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car tire with a circular logo on the wheel (no visible text or symbols)

The tires are marked on the tire sidewall with RSC Run-flat System Component.

Repairing a flat tire

Safety measures

  • Park the vehicle as far away as possible from passing traffic and on solid ground.
  • Switch on the hazard warning system.
  • Secure the vehicle against rolling away by setting the parking brake.
  • Turn the steering wheel until the front wheels are in the straight-ahead position and engage the steering wheel lock.
  • Have all vehicle occupants get out of the vehicle and ensure that they remain out-

side the immediate area in a safe place, such as behind a guardrail.

- If necessary, set up a warning triangle at an appropriate distance.

Mobility System

Concept

With the Mobility System, minor tire damage can be sealed temporarily to enable continued travel. To accomplish this, sealant is pumped into the tires, which seals the damage from the inside.

General information

  • Follow the instructions on using the Mobility System found on the compressor and sealant container.
  • Use of the Mobility System may be ineffective if the tire puncture measures approx. 1/8 inches/4 mm or more.
  • Contact a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop if the tire cannot be made drivable.
  • Do not remove foreign bodies that have penetrated the tire. Only remove foreign objects if they are visibly protruding from the tire.
  • Pull the speed limit sticker off the sealant container and apply it to the steering wheel.
  • The use of a sealant can damage the TPM wheel electronics. In this case, have the TPM wheel electronics replaced at the next opportunity.
  • The compressor can be used to check the tire inflation pressure.

Overview

Storage

The Mobility System is located in a bag on the right side trim in the cargo area.

Sealant container
MINI Countryman (2020) - Storage - 1

natural_image Diagram of a coiled wire with two labeled arrows (1 and 2), no text or symbols present.
  • Sealant container, arrow 1.
  • Filling hose, arrow 2.

Observe use-by date on the sealant container.

Compressor
MINI Countryman (2020) - Storage - 2

text_image 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

1 Sealant container unlocking
2 Sealant container holder
3 Tire pressure gage
4 Reduce tire inflation pressure button
5 On/off switch
6 Compressor
7 Connector/cable for socket
8 Connection hose

Safety measures

  • Park the vehicle as far away as possible from passing traffic and on solid ground.
  • Switch on the hazard warning system.
  • Secure the vehicle against rolling away by setting the parking brake.
  • Turn the steering wheel until the front wheels are in the straight-ahead position and engage the steering wheel lock.
  • Have all vehicle occupants get out of the vehicle and ensure that they remain outside the immediate area in a safe place, such as behind a guardrail.
  • If necessary, set up a warning triangle at an appropriate distance.

Filling the tire with sealant

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

DANGER

If the exhaust pipe is blocked or ventilation is insufficient, harmful exhaust gases can enter into the vehicle. The exhaust gases contain pollutants which are colorless and odorless. In enclosed areas, exhaust gases can also accumulate outside of the vehicle. There is danger to life. Keep the exhaust pipe free and ensure sufficient ventilation.

MINI Countryman (2020) - DANGER - 1

NOTICE

The compressor can overheat during extended operation. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not run the compressor for more than 10 minutes.

Filling

  1. Shake the sealant container.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Filling - 1

natural_image 3D rendering of a cylindrical battery with an upward arrow and vertical stripes on the side (no text or symbols)
  1. Pull filling hose completely out of the cover of the sealant container. Do not kink the hose.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Filling - 2

natural_image Simple diagram of a black cylindrical device with a curved wire and an arrow pointing downward (no text or symbols)
  1. Slide the sealant container into the holder on the compressor housing, ensuring that it engages audibly.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Filling - 3

natural_image Diagram showing a battery connected to a cable with a magnified view of its internal structure (no text or symbols)
  1. Screw the filling hose of the sealant container onto the tire valve of the non-working wheel.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Filling - 4

natural_image Close-up of a car tire connected to a battery and cable, with an arrow pointing to the tire component (no visible text or symbols)
  1. With the compressor switched off, insert the plug into the power socket inside the vehicle.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Filling - 5

natural_image Close-up of a car tire connected to a battery and cable, with a white arrow indicating motion (no text or symbols)
  1. With the ignition switched on or the engine running, switch on the compressor.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Filling - 6

natural_image Close-up of a black cylindrical device with a white arrow pointing downward to a small plug, against a black background (no text or symbols visible)

Let the compressor run for max. 10 minutes to fill the tire with sealant and achieve a tire inflation pressure of approx. 2.5 bar.

While the tire is being filled with sealant, the tire inflation pressure may sporadically reach approx. 5 bar. Do not switch off the compressor at this point.

Checking and adjusting the tire inflation pressure

Checking

  1. Switch off the compressor.
  2. Read the tire inflation pressure on the tire pressure gage.
    To continue the trip, a tire inflation pressure of at least 2 bar must be reached.

Removing and stowing the sealant container

  1. Unscrew the filling hose of the sealant container from the tire valve.
  2. Press the red unlocking device.
  3. Remove the sealant container from the compressor.
  4. Wrap and store the sealant container in suitable material to avoid dirtying the cargo area.

Minimum tire inflation pressure is not reached

  1. Pull the connector out of the power socket inside the vehicle.
  2. Drive 33 ft/10 m forward and back to distribute the sealant in the tire.
  3. Screw the connection hose of the compressor directly onto the tire valve stem.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Minimum tire inflation pressure is not reached - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car wheel connected to a small electronic device (no visible text or symbols)
  1. Insert the connector into the power socket inside the vehicle.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Minimum tire inflation pressure is not reached - 2

natural_image Close-up of a car tire connected to a small electronic device with a cable, showing a white arrow pointing downward (no text or symbols visible)
  1. With the ignition switched on or the engine running, switch on the compressor. If a tire inflation pressure of at least 2 bar cannot be reached, contact your dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop. If a tire inflation pressure of at least 2 bar is reached, see Minimum tire inflation pressure is reached.

  2. Unscrew the connection hose of the compressor from the tire valve.

  3. Pull the connector out of the power socket inside the vehicle.

  4. Stow the Mobility System in the vehicle.

Minimum tire inflation pressure is reached

  1. Unscrew the connection hose of the compressor from the tire valve.
  2. Pull the connector out of the power socket inside the vehicle.
  3. Stow the Mobility System in the vehicle.
  4. Immediately drive approx. 5 miles/10 km to ensure that the sealant is evenly distributed in the tire. Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h. If possible, do not drive at speeds less than 12 mph/20 km/h.

Adjustment

  1. Stop at a suitable location.
  2. Screw the connection hose of the compressor directly onto the tire valve stem.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjustment - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car wheel connected to a small electronic device with cable, against a black background (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Insert the connector into the power socket inside the vehicle.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adjustment - 2

natural_image Close-up of a car tire connected to a small electronic device with a white arrow pointing to it (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Correct the tire inflation pressure to at least 2.0 bar.

  2. Increase tire inflation pressure: with the ignition switched on or the engine running, switch on the compressor.

  3. Reduce tire inflation pressure: press the button on the compressor.

  4. Unscrew the connection hose of the compressor from the tire valve.

  5. Pull the connector out of the power socket inside the vehicle.

  6. Stow the Mobility System in the vehicle.

Continuing the trip

Do not exceed the maximum permissible speed of 50 mph/80 km/h. Reinitialize the Flat Tire Monitor, refer to page 154.

Reset the Tire Pressure Monitor, refer to page 150.

Replace the nonworking tire and the sealant container of the Mobility System promptly.

Snow chains

Safety information

Warning

With the mounting of snow chains on unsuitable tires, the snow chains can come into contact with vehicle parts. There may be a risk of accident or risk of damage to property. Only mount snow chains on tires that are designated by their manufacturer as suitable for the use of snow chains.

Warning

Insufficiently tight snow chains may damage tires and vehicle components. There may be a risk of accident or risk of damage to property. Make sure that the snow chains are always sufficiently tight. Retighten as needed according to the snow chain manufacturer's instructions.

The manufacturer of the vehicle recommends the use of fine-link snow chains. Certain types of fine-link snow chains have been tested by the manufacturer of the vehicle and recommended as road-safe and suitable.

Information regarding suitable snow chains is available from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Use

Use only in pairs on the front wheels, equipped with the tires of the following size:

-205/65 R 16.

-205/60 R 17.

John Cooper Works:

205/60 R 17

Follow the snow chain manufacturer's instructions.

Do not initialize the Flat Tire Monitor after mounting snow chains, as doing so may result in incorrect readings.

Do not reset the Tire Pressure Monitor TPM after mounting snow chains, as doing so may result in incorrect readings.

When driving with snow chains, briefly activate Dynamic Traction Control DTC, if needed.

Maximum speed with snow chains

Do not exceed a speed of 30 mph/50 km/h when using snow chains.

Changing wheels/tires

General information

When using run-flat tires or a flat tire kit, a wheel does not always need to be changed immediately when there is a loss of tire inflation pressure due to a flat tire.

If needed, the tools for changing wheels are available as accessories from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

DANGER

The vehicle jack is only provided for short-term lifting of the vehicle for wheel changes. Even if all safety measures are observed, there is a risk of the raised vehicle falling, if the vehicle jack tips over. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. If the vehicle is raised, do not lie under the vehicle and do not start the engine.

MINI Countryman (2020) - DANGER - 1

DANGER

Supports such as wooden blocks under the vehicle jack reduce the capacity of the vehicle jack to bear weight. They have the potential to exert too much strain on the vehicle jack, causing it to tip over and the vehicle to fall. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Do not place supports under the vehicle jack.

MINI Countryman (2020) - DANGER - 1

Warning

The jack, issued by the vehicle manufacturer, is provided in order to perform a wheel change in the event of a breakdown. The jack is not designed for frequent use; for example, changing from summer to winter tires. Using the jack frequently may cause it to become jammed or damaged. There is a risk of injury and risk of damage to property. Only use the jack to attach an emergency or spare wheel in the event of a breakdown.

Warning

On soft, uneven or slippery ground, for example snow, ice, tiles, etc., the vehicle jack can slip away. There is a risk of injury. If possible, change the wheel on a flat, solid, and slip-resistant surface.

Warning

The vehicle jack is optimized for lifting the vehicle and for the jacking points on the vehicle only. There is a risk of injury. Do not lift any other vehicle or cargo using the vehicle jack.

Warning

If the vehicle jack is not inserted into the jacking point provided for this purpose, the vehicle may be damaged or the vehicle jack may slip when it is being cranked up. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. When cranking up the vehicle jack, ensure that it is inserted in the jacking point next to the wheel housing.

Warning

A vehicle that is raised on a vehicle jack may fall off of the jack if lateral forces are exerted on it. There is a risk of injury and risk of damage to property. While the vehicle is raised, do not exert lateral forces on the vehicle or pull abruptly on the vehicle. Have a stuck wheel removed by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Securing the vehicle against rolling

General information

The vehicle manufacturer recommends to additionally secure the vehicle against rolling away when changing a wheel.

On a level surface

MINI Countryman (2020) - On a level surface - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car wheel and tire mounted on a stand, with a metallic object partially visible (no text or symbols)

Place wheel chocks or other suitable objects in front and behind the wheel that is diagonal to the wheel to be changed.

On a slight downhill gradient

MINI Countryman (2020) - On a slight downhill gradient - 1

natural_image Side-by-side comparison of a car wheel rim and its side profile, showing front and side views (no text or symbols)

If you need to change a wheel on a slight downhill grade, place chocks and other suitable objects, for instance a rock, under the wheels of both the front and rear axles against the rolling direction.

Lug bolt lock

Concept

The wheel lug bolts have a special coding. The lug bolts can only be released with the adapter which matches the coding.

Overview

The adapter of the lug bolt lock is located in the onboard vehicle tool kit, refer to page 300.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image 3D mechanical component diagram showing two parts with arrows indicating assembly or positioning (no text or symbols present)
  • Lug bolt, arrow 1.
  • Adapter, arrow 2.

Unscrewing

  1. Attach the adapter to the lug bolt.
  2. Unscrew the lug bolt.
  3. Remove the adapter after unscrewing the lug bolt.

Screwing on

  1. Attach the adapter to the lug bolt. If necessary, turn the adapter until it fits on the lug bolt.
  2. Screw on the lug bolt. The tightening torque is 140 Nm.
  3. Remove the adapter and stow it after screwing on the lug bolt.

Preparing the vehicle

- Park the vehicle on solid and non-slip ground at a safe distance from traffic.

  • Switch on the hazard warning system.
  • Set the parking brake.
  • Engage a gear or move the selector lever to position P.
  • As soon as permitted by the traffic flow, have all vehicle occupants get out of the vehicle and ensure that they remain outside the immediate area in a safe place, such as behind a guardrail.
  • Depending on the vehicle equipment, get wheel change tools and, if necessary, the emergency wheel from the vehicle.
  • If necessary, set up a warning triangle or portable hazard warning light at an appropriate distance.
  • Secure the vehicle additionally against rolling.
  • Loosen the lug bolts a half turn.

Jacking points for the vehicle jack

MINI Countryman (2020) - Jacking points for the vehicle jack - 1

natural_image Side view of a car wheel rim and side mirror, with two white arrows pointing upward (no text or symbols)

The jacking points for the vehicle jack are located at the marked positions.

Jacking up the vehicle

Warning

Hands and fingers can be jammed when using the vehicle jack. There is a risk of injury. Comply with the described hand position and do not change this position while using the vehicle jack.

  1. Hold the vehicle jack with one hand, arrow 1, and grasp the vehicle jack crank or lever with your other hand, arrow 2.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

natural_image 3D mechanical component diagram with labeled parts 1 and 2 (no text or symbols beyond labels)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 2

natural_image Mechanical linkage diagram with labeled parts (1, 2), no readable text or symbols beyond labels
  1. Insert the vehicle jack into the rectangular recess of the jacking point closest to the wheel to be changed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 3

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical component with internal cavities and mounting bracket (no visible text or symbols)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 4

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical component with a triangular frame structure (no visible text or symbols)
  1. Extend the vehicle jack by turning the vehicle jack crank or lever clockwise.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 5

natural_image 3D rendered mechanical component with articulated arms and mounting bracket against black background (no text or symbols)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 6

natural_image 3D rendered mechanical structure resembling a robotic arm or linkage, with no visible text or symbols
  1. Take your hand away from the vehicle jack as soon as the vehicle jack is under load and continue turning the vehicle jack crank or lever with one hand.

  2. Make sure that the vehicle jack foot stands vertically and at a right angle beneath the jacking point.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 7

natural_image Two identical diagrams showing a person performing a leg exercise with 90-degree angle annotations (no text or symbols present)
  1. Make sure that the vehicle jack foot stands vertically and perpendicularly beneath the jacking point after extending the vehicle jack.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 8

text_image 模拟电机 90°

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 9

natural_image Mechanical robotic arm with 90-degree angle标注 (no other text or symbols)
  1. Crank the vehicle up, until the vehicle jack is with the entire surface on the

ground and the relevant wheel is maximum 1.2 inches/3 cm above ground.

Mounting a wheel

Mount one emergency wheel only, as required.

  1. Unscrew the lug bolts.
  2. Remove the wheel.
  3. Put the new wheel or emergency wheel on and screw in at least two lug bolts in a crosswise pattern until hand-tight.
    If non-original light-alloy wheels of the vehicle manufacturer are mounted, the accompanying lug bolts may have to be used as well.
  4. Hand-tighten the remaining lug bolts and tighten all lug bolts well in a cross-wise pattern.
  5. Turn the vehicle jack crank counterclockwise to retract the vehicle jack and lower the vehicle.
  6. Remove the vehicle jack and stow it securely.

After the wheel change

  1. Tighten the lug bolts crosswise. The tightening torque is 101 lbs ft/140 Nm.

  2. Stow the nonworking wheel in the cargo area, if necessary.

The nonworking wheel cannot be stored under the cargo floor panel because of its size.

  1. Check tire inflation pressure at the next opportunity and correct as needed.

  2. Reinitialize the Flat Tire Monitor. Reset the Tire Pressure Monitor TPM.

  3. Check to make sure the lug bolts are tight with a calibrated torque wrench.

  4. Have the damaged tire replaced at the nearest dealer's service center or an-

other qualified service center or repair shop.

Emergency wheel

Concept

In the event of a flat tire, the emergency wheel can be used in place of the wheel with the defective tire. The emergency wheel is only intended for temporary use until the defective tire/wheel has been replaced.

General information

Mount one emergency wheel only.

Also check the tire inflation pressure of the emergency wheel in the cargo area regularly, and correct it as needed.

Safety information

Warning

The emergency wheel has particular dimensions. When driving with an emergency wheel, changed driving properties may occur, for instance reduced lane stability when braking, longer braking distance, and changed self-steering properties in the limit area. There is a risk of accident. Drive moderately and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car trunk with a circular disc and internal compartments (no visible text or symbols)

The emergency wheel and the wheel change tools are located in the cargo area under the cargo floor panel.

Removing the emergency wheel

  1. Pull up and remove the cargo floor panel.
  2. Unscrew the butterfly screw.
  3. Remove the retaining plate or the cover.
  4. Where applicable, remove the holder and the trailer hitch.
  5. Remove the jacking point and the tool holder on the left next to the emergency wheel.
  6. Slide the emergency wheel to the left and remove it.

Inserting the emergency wheel

  1. Insert the emergency wheel on the left and slide it to the right.
  2. Where applicable, mount the holder and the trailer hitch.
  3. Attach the retaining plate or the cover.
  4. Screw on and tighten the butterfly screw.
  5. Insert and secure the jacking point and the tool holder on the left next to the emergency wheel.
  6. Insert the cargo floor panel.

Engine compartment

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for

instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

text_image 2 3 4 5 6 MINI

1 Filler neck for washer fluid
2 Vehicle identification number
3 Oil filler neck

4 Jump-starting, positive terminal

5 Jump-starting, negative terminal

6 Coolant reservoir

Hood

Safety information

Warning

Improperly executed work in the engine compartment can damage vehicle components and impair vehicle functions. There is a risk of an accident and damage to property. Have work in the engine compartment performed by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Warning

The engine compartment accommodates moving components. Certain components in the engine compartment can also move with the vehicle switched off, for instance the radiator fan. There is a risk of injury. Do not reach into the area of moving parts. Keep articles of clothing and hair away from moving parts.

Warning

There are protruding parts, for instance locking hook, on the inside of the hood. There is a risk of injury. If the hood is open, pay attention to protruding parts and keep clear of these areas.

Warning

An incorrectly locked hood can open while driving and restrict visibility. There is a risk of accident. Stop immediately and correctly close the hood.

Warning

Body parts can be jammed when opening and closing the hood. There is a risk of injury. Make sure that the area of movement of the hood is clear during opening and closing.

NOTICE

Folded-away wipers can be jammed when the hood is opened. There is a risk of damage to property. Make sure that the wipers with the wiper blades mounted are folded down onto the windshield before opening the hood.

NOTICE

When the hood is closed, it must engage on both sides. Pressing again can damage the hood. There is a risk of damage to property. Open the hood again and then close it energetically. Avoid pressing again.

Opening the hood

  1. Pull lever, arrow 1. Hood is unlocked.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Opening the hood - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with numbered arrows indicating directional movement (no text or symbols)
  1. After the lever is released, pull the lever again, arrow 2. Hood can be opened.

Indicator/warning lights

When the hood is opened, a Check Control message is displayed.

Closing the hood

MINI Countryman (2020) - Closing the hood - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's front grille with visible grating and dashboard (no text or symbols)

Energetically close the hood from approx. 20 in/50 cm.

The hood must engage on both sides.

Engine oil

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

General information

The engine oil consumption is dependent on your driving style and driving conditions.

Therefore, regularly check the engine oil level after refueling by taking a detailed measurement.

The engine oil consumption can increase in the following situations, for instance:

  • Sporty driving style.
  • Break-in of the engine.
  • Idling of the engine.
  • With use of engine oil types that are classified as not suitable.

Different Check Control messages appear, depending on the engine oil level.

Safety information

NOTICE

An engine oil level that is too low causes engine damage. There is a risk of damage to property. Immediately add engine oil.

NOTICE

Too much engine oil can damage the engine or the catalytic converter. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not add too much engine oil. When too much engine oil is added, have the engine oil level corrected by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Electronic oil measurement

General information

The electronic oil measurement has two measuring principles:

  • Monitoring.
  • Detailed measurement.

When making frequent short-distance trips or using a dynamic driving style, for instance when taking curves aggressively, regularly perform a detailed measurement.

Monitoring

Concept

The engine oil level is monitored electronically while driving and can be shown on the Control Display.

If the engine oil level is outside its permissible operating range, a Check Control message is displayed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Concept - 1

A red indicator light indicates that the engine oil pressure is too low.

Functional requirements

A current measured value is available after approx. 30 minutes of normal driving.

Displaying the engine oil level

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"

  2. "Vehicle status"

  3. "Engine oil level"

The engine oil level is displayed.

System limits

When making frequent short-distance trips or using a dynamic driving style, it may not be possible to calculate a measured value.

In this case, the measured value for the last, sufficiently long trip is displayed.

Detailed measurement

Concept

The engine oil level is checked when the vehicle is stationary and displayed via a scale.

If the engine oil level is outside its permissible operating range, a Check Control message is displayed.

General information

During the measurement, the idle speed is increased somewhat.

Functional requirements

- Vehicle is parked in a horizontal position.

- Manual transmission: shift lever in neutral position, clutch and accelerator pedals not depressed.

- Steptronic transmission: selector lever in selector lever position N or P and accelerator pedal not depressed.

- Engine is running and is at operating temperature.

Performing a detailed measurement

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "My MINI"
  2. "Vehicle status"
  3. "Engine oil level"
  4. "Measure engine oil level"
  5. "Start measurement"

The engine oil level is checked and displayed via a scale.

Adding engine oil

General information

Only add engine oil when the message is displayed in the instrument cluster. The quantity to be added is indicated in the message displayed in the instrument cluster.

Only add suitable types of engine oil, refer to page 294.

Safely park the vehicle and switch off the ignition before adding engine oil.

Take care not to add too much engine oil.

Safety information

Warning

Operating materials, for instance oils, greases, coolants, fuels, can contain harmful ingredients. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Follow the instructions on the containers. Avoid the contact of articles of clothing, skin or eyes with operating materials. Do not refill operating materials into different bottles. Store operating materials out of reach of children.

NOTICE

An engine oil level that is too low causes engine damage. There is a risk of damage to property. Immediately add engine oil.

NOTICE

Too much engine oil can damage the engine or the catalytic converter. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not add too much engine oil. When too much engine oil is added, have the engine oil level corrected by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Overview

The oil filler neck is located in the engine compartment, refer to page 289.

Adding engine oil

  1. Open the hood, refer to page 290.
  2. Open the lid counterclockwise.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adding engine oil - 1

natural_image Simple diagram showing a circular object with a curved arrow pointing upward, no text or symbols present.
  1. Add engine oil.
  2. Close the lid.

Engine oil types to add

General information

The engine oil quality is critical for the life of the engine.

Only add the types of engine oil which are listed.

Safety information

NOTICE

Oil additives can damage the engine. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not use oil additives.

NOTICE

Incorrect engine oil can cause malfunctions in the engine or damage it. There is a risk of damage to property. When selecting an engine oil, make sure that the engine oil has the correct oil rating.

Suitable engine oil types

Add engine oils that meet the following oil rating standards:

Gasoline engine

BMW Longlife-01 FE.

BMW Longlife-14 FE+.

BMW Longlife-17 FE+.

Alternative engine oil types

If an engine oil suitable for continuous use is not available, up to 1 US quart/liter of an engine oil with the following oil rating can be added:

Oil rating
API SL.
API SM.
API SN.

Viscosity grades

When selecting an engine oil, make sure that the engine oil belongs to one of the following viscosity grades:

Viscosity grades
SAE 0W-20.
SAE 0W-30.

More information about suitable oil ratings and viscosity grades of engine oils can be requested from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Engine oil change

MINI Countryman (2020) - Engine oil change - 1

NOTICE

Engine oil that is not changed in timely fashion can cause increased engine wear and thus engine damage. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not exceed the service data indicated in the vehicle.

The vehicle manufacturer recommends that you have a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop change the engine oil.

MINI recommends MINI Original Engine Oil.

Coolant

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

General information

Coolant consists of water and additives. Not all commercially available additives are suitable for the vehicle. Information about suitable additives is available from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Safety information

Warning

With the engine hot and the cooling system open, coolant can escape and lead to scalding. There is a risk of injury. Only open the cooling system with the engine cooled down.

Warning

Additives are harmful and incorrect additives can damage the engine. There is a risk of injury and risk of damage to property. Do not allow additives to come into

contact with skin, eyes or articles of clothing. Use suitable additives only.

Coolant level

Checking

There are yellow Min and Max marks in the coolant reservoir.

  1. Let the engine cool.
  2. Open the hood, refer to page 290.
  3. Turn the lid of the coolant reservoir slightly counterclockwise to allow any excess pressure to dissipate, then open it.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Checking - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car engine bay with visible internal components and a circular arrow indicating rotation (no text or symbols)
  1. Open the coolant reservoir lid.

  2. The coolant level is correct if it lies between the minimum and maximum marks in the filler neck.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Checking - 2

text_image max min
  1. Close the lid.

Adding

  1. Let the engine cool.
  2. Open the hood, refer to page 290.
  3. Turn the lid of the coolant reservoir slightly counterclockwise to allow any excess pressure to dissipate, then open it.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Adding - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car engine bay with visible structural components and a circular arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols)
  1. Open the coolant reservoir lid.
  2. If the coolant is low, slowly add coolant up to the specified level; do not overfill.
  3. Close the lid.
  4. Have the cause of the coolant loss eliminated as soon as possible.

Disposal

MINI Countryman (2020) - Disposal - 1

Comply with the relevant environmental protection regulations when disposing of coolant and coolant additives.

Maintenance

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

MINI maintenance system

The maintenance system indicates required maintenance measures, and thereby provides support in maintaining road safety and the operational reliability of the vehicle.

In some cases, scopes and intervals of the maintenance system may vary according to the country version. Replacement work, spare parts, fuels and lubricants, and wear materials are calculated separately. Further information is available from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Condition Based Service CBS

Concept

Sensors and special algorithms take into account the driving conditions of the vehicle. CBS uses these to calculate the need for maintenance.

The system makes it possible to adapt the amount of maintenance corresponding to your user profile.

General information

Information on service requirements, refer to page 131, can be displayed on the radio.

Service data in the vehicle key

Information on the required maintenance is continuously stored in the vehicle key. The dealer's service center can read this data out and suggest an optimized maintenance scope for the vehicle.

Therefore, hand the service advisor the vehicle key with which the vehicle was driven most recently.

Storage periods

Storage periods during which the vehicle battery was disconnected are not taken into account.

If this occurs, have a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop update the time-dependent maintenance procedures, such as checking brake fluid and, if necessary, changing the engine oil and the microfilter/activated-charcoal filter.

Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models

Please consult your Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models for additional information on service requirements.

The manufacturer of your vehicle recommends that maintenance and repair be performed by a service center or another qualified service center or repair shop. Records of regular maintenance and repair work should be retained.

Socket for OBD Onboard Diagnosis

General information

Devices connected to the OBD socket trigger the alarm system when the vehicle is locked. Remove any devices connected at the OBD socket before locking the vehicle.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

NOTICE

The socket for Onboard Diagnosis is an intricate component intended to be used in conjunction with specialized equipment to check the vehicle's primary emissions system. Improper use of the socket for Onboard Diagnosis, or contact with the socket for Onboard Diagnosis for other than its intended purpose, can cause vehicle malfunctions and creates risks of personal and property damage. Given the foregoing, the manufacture of your vehicle strongly recommends that access to the socket for Onboard Diagnosis be limited to a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop or other persons that have the specialized training and equipment for purposes of properly utilizing the socket for Onboard Diagnosis.

Position

MINI Countryman (2020) - Position - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)

There is an OBD socket on the driver's side for checking the primary components in the vehicle's emissions.

Emissions

MINI Countryman (2020) - Emissions - 1

- The warning light lights up:

Emissions are deteriorating.

Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible.

- The warning light flashes under certain circumstances:

This indicates that there is excessive misfiring in the engine.

Reduce the vehicle speed and have the system checked immediately; otherwise, serious engine misfiring within a brief period can seriously damage emission control components, in particular the catalytic converter.

Replacing components

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Vehicle tool kit

MINI Countryman (2020) - Vehicle tool kit - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing a white plastic tray on the backrest with an arrow indicating direction (no text or symbols visible)

The bag containing the onboard vehicle tool kit is located beneath the cargo floor panel.

After use, secure the bag with the onboard vehicle tool kit on a lashing eye again.

Wiper blades

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

NOTICE

The window may sustain damage if the wiper falls onto it without the wiper blade installed. There is a risk of damage to property. Hold the wiper firmly when

changing the wiper blade. Do not fold or switch on the wiper without a wiper blade installed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - NOTICE - 1

NOTICE

Folded-away wipers can be jammed when the hood is opened. There is a risk of damage to property. Make sure that the wipers with the wiper blades mounted are folded down onto the windshield before opening the hood.

Replacing the front wiper blades

  1. To change the wiper blades, fold up the wiper arms.
  2. Fold up and hold the wiper arm firmly.
  3. Press the button, arrow 1, and swing out the wiper blade, arrow 2.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Replacing the front wiper blades - 1

text_image 1 2
  1. Attach a new wiper blade. The wiper blade must engage audibly.
  2. Fold down the wiper arm.

Rear wiper blade

  1. Fold up and hold the wiper arm firmly.
  2. Pull the wiper blade out of the wiper arm.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Rear wiper blade - 1

natural_image Mechanical component with a curved arrow indicating left motion (no text or symbols)
  1. Attach a new wiper blade. The wiper blade must engage audibly.
  2. Fold down the wiper arm.

Light and bulb replacement

General information

Lights and bulbs

Lights and bulbs make an essential contribution to vehicle safety.

The manufacturer of the vehicle recommends that you have appropriate work performed by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop if you are unfamiliar with it or if it has not been described here.

A spare light box is available from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Follow the safety information, refer to page 301.

Light-emitting diodes (LEDs)

Some items of equipment use light-emitting diodes installed behind a cover as a light source. These light-emitting diodes are related to conventional lasers and are offi-

cially designated as Class 1 light-emitting diodes.

Follow the safety information, refer to page 301.

Safety information

Lights and bulbs

MINI Countryman (2020) - Lights and bulbs - 1

Warning

Bulbs can get hot during operation. Contact with the bulbs can cause burns. There is a risk of injury. Only change bulbs after they have cooled off.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

Warning

Work on switched-on lighting systems can cause short circuits. There is a risk of injury or risk of damage to property. When working on the lighting system, switch off the lights in question. If necessary, heed the bulb manufacturer's instructions.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

NOTICE

Dirty bulbs have a reduced service life. There is a risk of damage to property. Do not hold new bulbs with your bare hands. Use a clean cloth or something similar, or hold the bulb by its base.

Light-emitting diodes (LEDs)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Light-emitting diodes (LEDs) - 1

Warning

Intensive brightness can irritate or damage the retina of the eye. There is a risk of injury. Do not look directly into the headlights or other light sources. Do not remove the LED covers.

Headlight glass

Condensation can form on the inside of the headlight glass in cool or humid weather. When driving with the lights switched on, the condensation evaporates after a short time. The headlight glass does not need to be changed.

If despite driving with the headlights switched on, increasing humidity forms, for instance water droplets in the light, have the headlights checked.

Headlight setting

The headlight adjustments can be affected by changing lights and bulbs. After the headlight adjustment was changed, have it checked and, if necessary, corrected by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Front halogen lights, bulb replacement

Overview

Halogen headlights
MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

text_image 1 2 3

1 High beams
2 Low beams
3 Turn signal

High beams

Follow the general instructions on lights and bulbs, refer to page 301.

55-watt bulb, H7.

  1. Open the hood, refer to page 290.
  2. Turn the lid counterclockwise and remove.

MINI Countryman (2020) - High beams - 1

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical device with a circular dial indicator and a white arrow pointing to it (no visible text or symbols)
  1. Tilt the bulb holder up, arrow 1, and pull it out of the headlight toward the rear, arrow 2.

MINI Countryman (2020) - High beams - 2

text_image 2 1
  1. Pull the bulb out of the bulb holder.
  2. Install the new bulb with the bulb holder in reverse order of removal. In doing so, ensure that the bulb tab is correctly positioned in the headlight housing and the bulb holder perceptibly engages.
  3. Check the position of the bulb through the headlight glass.
  4. Close the headlight housing with the lid. Make sure that the lid engages.

Low beams

Follow the general instructions on lights and bulbs, refer to page 301.

55-watt bulb, H7.

  1. Turn the steering wheel.
    • On the left facing the driving direction: turn the cover clockwise and remove it.
  2. On the right facing the driving direction: turn the cover counterclockwise and remove it.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Low beams - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car wheel rim with a circular vent component (no visible text or symbols)
  1. Unscrew the inner cover counterclockwise, and remove it.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Low beams - 2

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical component with a circular arrow indicating rotation (no visible text or symbols)
  1. Tilt the bulb holder down, arrow 1, and pull it downward out of the headlight, arrow 2.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Low beams - 3

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical component with a circular dial and arrow indicator (no readable text or symbols)
  1. Pull the bulb out of the bulb holder.

  2. Install the new bulb with the bulb holder in reverse order of removal. In doing so, ensure that the bulb tab is correctly positioned in the headlight housing and the bulb holder perceptibly engages.

  3. Check the position of the bulb through the headlight glass.
  4. Install the covers. Make sure that the covers engage.

Turn signal

Follow the general instructions on lights and bulbs, refer to page 301.

24-watt bulb, PWY24W.

  1. Turn the steering wheel.
    • On the left facing the driving direction: turn the cover clockwise and remove it.
  2. On the right facing the driving direction: turn the cover counterclockwise and remove it.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Turn signal - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car wheel rim with a circular component and battery cover (no visible text or symbols)
  1. Unscrew the inner cover counterclockwise, and remove it.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Turn signal - 2

natural_image Close-up of a car wheel with a circular arrow indicating rotation (no text or symbols)
  1. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise, arrow 1, and remove, arrow 2.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Turn signal - 3

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical component with a circular opening showing internal components and directional arrows (no text or symbols)
  1. Press the bulb gently into the bulb holder, turn counterclockwise and remove.
  2. Insert the new bulb and install the covers in the reverse order. Make sure that the covers engage.

LED front lights, bulb replacement

General information

The following lights feature LED technology:

  • Daytime running lights
  • High beams
  • Low beams
  • Cornering light
  • Parking lights
  • Fog lights

In the case of a malfunction, contact a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Overview

Position of the headlights

MINI Countryman (2020) - Position of the headlights - 1

text_image 1 2 3 4

1 Turn signal
2 Daytime running lights
3 Low beams/high beams
4 Cornering light

LED bug light

MINI Countryman (2020) - LED bug light - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's front wheel and side panel showing internal components (no text or symbols)

1 Parking lights
2 Fog lights

Turn signal

Follow the general instructions on lights and bulbs, refer to page 301.

24-watt bulb, PWY24W.

  1. Open the hood, refer to page 290.
  2. Turn the lid counterclockwise and remove.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Turn signal - 1

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical component with a circular dial indicator and an arrow pointing to it (no visible text or symbols)
  1. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise, arrow 1, and remove, arrow 2.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Turn signal - 2

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical component with a circular opening showing internal components, no visible text or symbols
  1. Press the bulb gently into the bulb holder, turn counterclockwise and remove.
  2. Insert the new bulb and install the cover in the reverse order.

LED front fog lights

These front fog lights are made using LED technology. In the case of a malfunction, contact a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Tail lights, bulb replacement

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

text_image 1 2 3 1

1 Side tail lights
2 Center brake light
3 License plate light

Side tail lights

MINI Countryman (2020) - Side tail lights - 1

text_image 1 2 1 3

1 Brake lights/tail lights
2 Turn signal
3 Reversing lights

Side LED tail lights

MINI Countryman (2020) - Side LED tail lights - 1

text_image 1 2 3 2 4

1 Brake light
2 Tail lights
3 Turn signal
4 Reversing lights

Side tail lights

Follow the general instructions on lights and bulbs, refer to page 301.

  • Bulb, brake lights/rear lights, tail lights: P21W.
  • Bulb, brake lights/LED tail lights: H21W.
  • Bulb, turn signals: P21W.
  • Bulb, reversing lights: P21W.

  • Open the tailgate.

  • Remove left or right cover.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Side tail lights - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car door panel with a white arrow pointing to a button (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Through the opening, loosen the plug connector, arrow 2 on the bulb holder.

Press the latches together, arrows 1, and remove the bulb holder.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Side tail lights - 2

text_image 1 1 2 1 1
  1. Remove the bulb holder from the opening.
  2. Press the nonworking bulb gently into the socket, turn counterclockwise and remove.

  3. Arrow 1: brake lights/tail lights

  4. Arrow 2: turn signal
  5. Arrow 3: reversing light

MINI Countryman (2020) - Side tail lights - 3

flowchart
graph TD
    A["1"] --> B["2"]
    B --> C["3"]
    C --> D["End"]
  1. Proceed in the reverse order to insert the new bulb and attach the bulb holder. Make sure that the bulb holder engages in all fasteners.

Central brake light and license plate lights

Follow the general instructions on lights and bulbs, refer to page 301.

The lights feature LED technology. In the case of a malfunction, contact a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Side turn signal, bulb replacement

Follow the general instructions on lights and bulbs, refer to page 301.

Bulb: WY5W.

  1. Push the side turn signal forward in the driving direction, arrow 1, and swing it outward, arrow 2.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Side turn signal, bulb replacement - 1

text_image Close-up of a car door panel with numbered arrows indicating directional changes or features
    • On the left facing the driving direction: turn the bulb holder clockwise and remove.
  1. On the right facing the driving direction: turn the bulb holder counterclockwise and remove.
  2. Replace the bulb.
  3. Insert the bulb holder.
  4. Insert the rear side turn signal, arrow 1, and swing it forward, arrow 2.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Side turn signal, bulb replacement - 2

natural_image Close-up of a car's front panel corner with directional arrows indicating movement or flow (no text or symbols)

Vehicle battery

General information

The battery is maintenance-free.

More information about the battery can be requested from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Safety information

Warning

Vehicle batteries that are not compatible can damage vehicle systems and impair vehicle functions. There is a risk of an accident and damage to property. Only vehicle batteries that are compatible with your vehicle type should be installed in your vehicle. Information on compatible vehicle batteries is available at your dealer's service center.

Register the battery to the vehicle

The manufacturer of the vehicle recommends that you have a service center or another qualified service center or repair shop register the vehicle battery to the vehicle after the battery has been replaced. Once the battery has been registered again, all comfort features will be available without restriction and any Check Control messages displayed which relate to comfort features will disappear.

Charging the battery

General information

Make sure that the battery is always sufficiently charged to guarantee that the battery remains usable for its full service life.

MINI Countryman (2020) - General information - 1

A discharged battery is indicated by a red indicator light.

Charge the battery in the following situations:

  • When the inspection glass on the top of the battery is black.
  • When the take-off performance is insufficient.

The following circumstances can have a negative effect on the performance of the battery:

  • Frequent short-distance drives.
  • The vehicle is not used for more than a month.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

NOTICE

Battery chargers for the vehicle battery can work with high voltages and currents, which means that the 12 volt on-board network can be overloaded or damaged.

There is a risk of damage to property. Only connect battery chargers for the vehicle battery to the starting aid terminals in the engine compartment.

Charging the battery

Charge the battery only when the engine is off and via the starting aid terminals, refer to page 313, in the engine compartment.

Power failure

After a power loss, some equipment needs to be newly initialized or individual settings updated, for example:

  • Memory function: store the positions again.
  • Time: update.
  • Date: update.
  • Glass sunroof: initialize the system.

Disposing of old batteries

MINI Countryman (2020) - Disposing of old batteries - 1

Have old batteries disposed of by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop or take them to a collection point.

Maintain the filled battery in an upright position for transport and storage. Secure the battery so that it does not tip over during transport.

Fuses

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Incorrect and repaired fuses can overload electrical lines and components. There is a risk of fire. Never attempt to repair a blown fuse. Do not replace a nonworking fuse with a substitute of another color or amperage rating.

Accessing the fuses

The fuses are located in the glove compartment.

  1. Open the glove compartment.
  2. Swing the cover down, arrow.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Accessing the fuses - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing the dashboard and seat area with a white arrow pointing to a component (no text or symbols visible)

Information on the fuse types and locations, as well as the positions of any other fuse

boxes, is available on the Internet: www.mini.com/fusecard.

Where applicable, information on the fuse types and locations is also found on a separate sheet in the fuse box.

Replacing fuses

The vehicle manufacturer recommends that you have a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop replace the fuses.

Breakdown assistance

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Hazard warning flashers

MINI Countryman (2020) - Hazard warning flashers - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and dashboard (no visible text or symbols)

The button is located above the Control Display.

The red light in the button flashes when the hazard warning flashers are activated.

Warning triangle

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning triangle - 1

natural_image Top-down view of a car backrest showing the rear wheel, rear vent, and side compartments (no text or symbols visible)

The warning triangle is located in the tailgate. To remove, loosen the brackets.

First-aid kit

General information

Some of the articles have a limited service life.

Check the expiration dates of the contents regularly and replace any expired items promptly.

Storage

The first-aid kit is located in the cargo area.

MINI Roadside Assistance

Concept

MINI Roadside Assistance can be contacted if assistance is needed in the event of a breakdown.

General information

In the event of a breakdown, data on the vehicle's condition is sent to the vehicle manufacturer.

There are various ways of making contact.

- Via a Check Control message, refer to page 125.

- Calling with a mobile phone.

Requirements

- Active MINI Connected contract or equipment version with intelligent emergency call.

- Cellular network reception.

- The ignition is switched on.

Starting

If the vehicle is equipped with Teleservices, support is offered through Teleservice Diagnosis.

Via the Central Information Display (CID):

  1. "MINI Connected"

  2. "MINI Assist"

  3. "MINI Roadside Assistance"

The contact to the Roadside Assistance of the manufacture is established.

A telephone number is displayed, if needed. Select to dial the telephone number on a connected mobile phone.

Teleservice Diagnosis

Teleservice Diagnosis enables the wireless transmission of detailed vehicle data that is important for vehicle diagnosis. This data is transmitted automatically.

Teleservice Help

Depending on the country, the Teleservice Help enables a more in-depth diagnosis of the vehicle via wireless transmission.

You can launch Teleservice Help by requesting it through the Service Specialist.

  1. Park the vehicle in a safe place.
  2. Set the parking brake.
  3. Control Display is switched on.
  4. "Teleservice Help"

The driving ability of the vehicle can be restored for specific functions.

If this is not possible, further measures will be initiated, for instance Roadside Assistance will be informed.

Emergency Request

Intelligent emergency call

Concept

In case of an emergency, an Emergency Request can be triggered automatically by the system or manually.

General information

Only press the SOS button in an emergency. The Intelligent Assist system establishes a connection with the MINI Response Center. For technical reasons, the Emergency Request cannot be guaranteed under unfavorable conditions.

Overview

MINI Countryman (2020) - Overview - 1

natural_image Top-down view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and control panel (no visible text or symbols)

SOS button in the roofliner

Functional requirements

  • The ignition is switched on.
  • The Assist system is functional.
  • If the vehicle is equipped with intelligent emergency call: the SIM card integrated in the vehicle has been activated.

Automatic triggering

Under certain conditions, for instance if the airbags trigger, an Emergency Request is automatically initiated immediately after an accident of corresponding severity. Automatic Collision Notification is not affected by pressing the SOS button.

Manual triggering

  1. Press the cover briefly to open it.
  2. Press the SOS button until the LED at the button lights up green.
  3. The LED is illuminated green when an Emergency Request has been initiated. If the situation allows, wait in your vehicle until the voice connection has been established.
  4. The LED flashes green when a connection to the MINI Response Center has been established.

The MINI Response Center then makes contact with you and takes further steps to help you.

Even if you are unable to respond, the MINI Response Center can take further steps to help you under certain circumstances.

For this, data is transmitted to the MINI Response Center which serve to determine the necessary rescue measures. For instance, the current position of the vehicle, if it can be established.

If you can no longer hear the MINI Response Center through the loudspeakers, the hands-free system, for instance, may be broken. However, the MINI Response Center may still be able to hear you.

The MINI Response Center ends the Emergency Request.

Jump-starting

General information

If the battery is discharged, the engine can be started using the battery of another vehicle and two jumper cables. Only use jumper cables with fully insulated clamp handles.

Safety information

! DANGER

Contact with live components can lead to an electric shock. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Do not touch any components that are under voltage.

Warning

If the jumper cables are connected in the incorrect order, sparking may occur. There is a risk of injury. Pay attention to the correct order during connection.

NOTICE

In the case of body contact between the two vehicles, a short circuit can occur during jump-starting. There is a risk of damage to property. Make sure that no body contact occurs.

Preparation

  1. Check whether the battery of the other vehicle has a voltage of 12 volts. The voltage information can be found on the battery.
  2. Switch off the engine of the assisting vehicle.
  3. Switch off any electronic systems/power consumers in both vehicles.

Starting aid terminals

MINI Countryman (2020) - Starting aid terminals - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car engine bay with a white arrow pointing to a component on the top (no visible text or symbols)

The starting aid terminal in the engine compartment acts as the battery's positive terminal.

Open the cover of the starting aid terminal.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Starting aid terminals - 2

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical component with a white arrow pointing to a small circular feature (no visible text or symbols)

A special connection on the body acts as the battery negative terminal.

Connecting the cables

To prevent personal injury or damage to both vehicles, adhere strictly to the following procedure.

  1. Pull off the lid of the starting aid terminal.
  2. Attach one terminal clamp of the positive jumper cable to the positive terminal of the battery, or to the corresponding starting aid terminal of the vehicle providing assistance.
  3. Attach the terminal clamp on the other end of the cable to the positive terminal of the battery, or to the corresponding starting aid terminal of the vehicle to be started.
  4. Attach one terminal clamp of the negative jumper cable to the negative terminal of the battery, or to the corresponding engine or body ground of assisting vehicle.
  5. Attach the second terminal clamp to the negative terminal of the battery, or to the corresponding engine or body ground of the vehicle to be started.

Starting the engine

Never use spray fluids to start the engine.

  1. Start the engine of the assisting vehicle and let it run for several minutes at an increased idle speed.
  2. Start the engine of the vehicle that is to be started in the usual way. If the first starting attempt is not successful, wait a few minutes before making another attempt in order to allow the discharged battery to recharge.
  3. Let both engines run for several minutes.
  4. Disconnect the jumper cables in the reverse order.
    Check the battery and recharge, if needed.

Tow-starting and towing

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

Warning

Due to system limits, individual functions can malfunction during tow-starting/towing with the Intelligent Safety systems activated. There is a risk of accident. Switch all Intelligent Safety systems off prior to tow-starting/towing.

Steptronic transmission with driven front axle: transporting the vehicle

General information

The vehicle must not be towed if the front wheels are touching the ground.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

NOTICE

The vehicle can be damaged when towing the vehicle with a lifted rear axle. There is a risk of damage to property. Have vehicle transported only with lifted front axle or on a loading platform.

Pushing the vehicle

To remove a broken-down vehicle from the danger area, it can be pushed for a short distance.

For rolling or pushing the vehicle, refer to page 119.

Tow truck

MINI Countryman (2020) - Tow truck - 1

natural_image Three grayscale line drawings of a flatbed truck with no visible text, numbers, or symbols.

Your vehicle should be transported with a tow truck with a so-called lift bar or on a flat bed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Tow truck - 2

NOTICE

The vehicle can become damaged when lifting and securing it.

There is a risk of damage to property.

  • Lift the vehicle using suitable means.
  • Do not lift or secure the vehicle by its tow fitting, body parts, or suspension parts.

Steptronic transmission with ALL4: transporting the vehicle

General information

The vehicle is not permitted to be towed.

Pushing the vehicle

To remove a broken-down vehicle from the danger area, it can be pushed for a short distance.

For rolling or pushing the vehicle, refer to page 119.

Tow truck
MINI Countryman (2020) - Pushing the vehicle - 1

natural_image Diagram showing three car loading trucks with no visible text or symbols

The vehicle should only be transported on a loading platform.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Pushing the vehicle - 2

NOTICE

The vehicle can become damaged when lifting and securing it.

There is a risk of damage to property.

- Lift the vehicle using suitable means.

- Do not lift or secure the vehicle by its tow fitting, body parts, or suspension parts.

Manual transmission

Towing or pushing the vehicle

A broken-down vehicle can be towed or pushed.

For rolling or pushing the vehicle, refer to page 116.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Towing or pushing the vehicle - 1

NOTICE

If manual unlocking of the parking brake is not possible, the vehicle cannot be moved or towed. There is a risk of damage to property. The vehicle should only be transported on a loading platform.

Follow the following instructions:

  • Make sure that the ignition is switched on; otherwise, the low beams, tail lights, turn signals, and wipers may be unavailable.
  • Do not tow the vehicle with the rear axle tilted, as the front wheels could turn.
  • When the engine is stopped, there is no power assist. Consequently, more force needs to be applied when braking and steering.
  • Larger steering wheel movements are required.
  • The towing vehicle must not be lighter than the vehicle being towed; otherwise, it will not be possible to control the vehicle's response.
  • Do not exceed a towing speed of 30 mph/50 km/h.
  • Do not exceed a towing distance of 30 miles/50 km.

Tow truck

With driven front axle

MINI Countryman (2020) - With driven front axle - 1

natural_image Three grayscale line drawings of a flatbed truck with no visible text, numbers, or symbols.

Your vehicle should be transported with a tow truck with a so-called lift bar or on a flat bed.

NOTICE

The vehicle can become damaged when lifting and securing it.

There is a risk of damage to property.

- Lift the vehicle using suitable means.

- Do not lift or secure the vehicle by its tow fitting, body parts, or suspension parts.

With ALL4

MINI Countryman (2020) - With ALL4 - 1

natural_image Diagram showing three car loading trucks with no visible text or symbols

Have your vehicle transported on a flatbed surface only

NOTICE

The vehicle can be damaged when towing the vehicle with a single lifted axle. There is a risk of damage to property. The vehicle should only be transported on a loading platform.

NOTICE

The vehicle can become damaged when lifting and securing it.

There is a risk of damage to property.

  • Lift the vehicle using suitable means.
  • Do not lift or secure the vehicle by its tow fitting, body parts, or suspension parts.

Towing other vehicles

General information

Switch on the hazard warning system, depending on local regulations.

If the electrical system has failed, clearly identify the vehicle being towed by placing a sign or a warning triangle in the rear window.

Safety information

Warning

If the approved gross vehicle weight of the towing vehicle is lighter than the vehicle to be towed, the tow fitting can tear off or it will not be possible to control the vehicle's response. There is a risk of accident. Make sure that the gross vehicle weight of the towing vehicle is heavier than the vehicle to be towed.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Warning - 1

NOTICE

If the tow bar or tow rope is attached incorrectly, damage to other vehicle parts can occur. There is a risk of damage to property. Correctly attach the tow bar or tow rope to the tow fitting.

Tow bar

The tow fittings used should be on the same side on both vehicles.

Should it prove impossible to avoid mounting the tow bar at an offset angle, please follow the following:

  • Maneuvering capability is limited going around corners.
  • The tow bar will generate lateral forces if it is secured with an offset.

Tow rope

When starting to tow the vehicle, make sure that the tow rope is taut.

Use nylon ropes or straps, which will enable the vehicle to be towed without jerking.

Tow fitting

General information
MINI Countryman (2020) - Tow fitting - 1

natural_image 3D rendered image of a metallic hook with threaded end (no text or symbols)

The screw-in tow fitting should always be carried in the vehicle.

The tow fitting can be screwed in at the front or rear of the vehicle.

The tow fitting and the onboard vehicle tool kit, refer to page 300, are together in the cargo area.

Use of the tow fitting:

  • Use only the tow fitting provided with the vehicle and screw it all the way in.
  • Use the tow fitting for towing on paved roads only.
  • Avoid lateral loading of the tow fitting, for instance do not lift the vehicle by the tow fitting.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

NOTICE

If the tow fitting is not used as intended, there may be damage to the vehicle or to the tow fitting. There is a risk of damage to property. Follow the notes on using the tow fitting.

Screw thread for tow fitting
MINI Countryman (2020) - NOTICE - 1

natural_image Side profile of a car showing front and rear views with no visible text or symbols

Threaded holes for the tow fitting are located in the front and rear of the vehicle on the right side with respect to the direction of travel.

Press on the mark on the edge of the cover to push it out.

Tow-starting

Steptronic transmission

Do not tow-start the vehicle.

Tow-starting the engine is not possible due to the Steptronic transmission.

Have the reasons for the starting difficulties corrected by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Manual transmission

If possible, do not tow-start the vehicle but start the engine by jump-starting, refer to page 312. If the vehicle is equipped with a catalytic converter, only tow-start while the engine is cold.

  1. Switch on the hazard warning system and comply with local regulations.
  2. Switch on the ignition, refer to page 99.
  3. Engage third gear.
  4. Have the vehicle tow-started with the clutch pedal pressed and slowly release the pedal. After the engine starts, immediately press on the clutch pedal again.
  5. Stop at a suitable location, remove the tow bar or rope, and switch off the hazard warning system.
  6. Have the vehicle checked by a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Care

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

Washing the vehicle

General information

Regularly remove foreign objects such as leaves in the area below the windshield when the hood is raised.

Wash your vehicle frequently, particularly in winter. Intense soiling and road salt can damage the vehicle.

Steam jets or high-pressure washers

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Steam jets or high-pressure washers - 1

NOTICE

When cleaning with high-pressure washers, components can be damaged due to the pressure or temperatures being too high. There is a risk of damage to property. Maintain sufficient distance and do not spray too long continuously. Follow the operating instructions for the high-pressure washer.

Distances and temperature

  • Maximum temperature: 140^ / 60^ .
  • Minimum distance from sensors, cameras, seals: 12 inches/30 cm.
  • Minimum distance from glass sunroof: 31.5 in/80 cm.

Automatic vehicle washes

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

NOTICE

Improper use of automatic vehicle washes can cause damage to the vehicle. There is a risk of damage to property. Follow the following instructions:

  • Give preference to cloth vehicle washes or those that use soft brushes in order to avoid paint damage.
  • Avoid vehicle washes with guide rails higher than 4 in/10 cm to avoid damage to the chassis.
  • Observe the tire width of the guide rail to avoid damage to tires and rims.
  • Fold in exterior mirrors to avoid damage to the exterior mirrors.
  • With rod antenna: unscrew the rod antenna to avoid rod antenna breakage.
  • Deactivate the wiper and, if necessary, rain sensor to avoid damage to the wiper system.

Driving into a vehicle wash with a manual transmission

In vehicle washes, the vehicle must be able to roll freely.

Rolling or pushing the vehicle, refer to page 116.

Driving into a vehicle wash with a Steptronic transmission

In vehicle washes, the vehicle must be able to roll freely.

Rolling or pushing the vehicle, refer to page 119.

Some vehicle washes do not permit persons in the vehicle. The vehicle cannot be locked from the outside when in selector lever position N. A signal is sounded when an attempt is made to lock the vehicle.

Driving out of a vehicle wash

Ensure that the vehicle key is in the car.

Start the engine, refer to page 100.

Headlights

Do not rub wet headlights dry and do not use abrasive or acidic cleaning agents.

Soak areas that have been dirtied, for instance from insects, with shampoo and wash off with water.

Thaw ice with de-icing spray; do not use an ice scraper.

After washing the vehicle

After washing the vehicle, apply the brakes briefly to dry them; otherwise, braking action can be reduced. The heat generated during braking dries brake discs and brake pads and protects them against corrosion.

Completely remove all residues on the windows, to minimize loss of visibility due to smearing and to reduce wiper noises and wiper blade wear.

Vehicle care

Vehicle care products

General information

MINI recommends using vehicle care and cleaning products from MINI. Suitable care products are available from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Safety information

Warning

Cleansers can contain substances that are dangerous and harmful to your health. There is a risk of injury. When cleaning the interior, open the doors or windows. Only use products intended for cleaning vehicles. Follow the instructions on the container.

Vehicle paint

General information

Regular care contributes to driving safety and value retention. Environmental influences in areas with elevated air pollution or natural contaminants, such as tree resin or pollen can affect the vehicle's paintwork. Tailor the frequency and extent of your vehicle care to these influences.

Aggressive substances such as spilled fuel, oil, grease or bird droppings, must be removed immediately to prevent the finish from being altered or discolored.

Matte finish

Only use cleaning and care products suitable for vehicles with matte finish.

Leather care

Remove dust from the leather regularly, using a cloth or vacuum cleaner.

Otherwise, particles of dust and road grime chafe in pores and folds, and lead to increased wear and premature degradation of the leather surface.

To guard against discoloration, such as from clothing, clean leather and provide leather care roughly every two months.

Clean light-colored leather more frequently because soiling on such surfaces is substantially more visible.

Use leather care products; otherwise, dirt and grease will gradually break down the protective layer of the leather surface.

Upholstery material care

General information

Vacuum the upholstery regularly with a vacuum cleaner.

If upholstery is very dirty, for instance with beverage stains, use a soft sponge or microfiber cloth with a suitable interior cleaner.

Clean the upholstery down to the seams using large sweeping motions. Avoid rubbing the material vigorously.

Safety information

MINI Countryman (2020) - Safety information - 1

NOTICE

Open Velcro ^® fasteners on articles of clothing can damage the seat covers. There is a risk of damage to property. Ensure that any Velcro ^® fasteners are closed.

Caring for special components

Light-alloy wheels

When cleaning the vehicle, use only neutral wheel cleaners having a pH value from 5 to 9. Do not use abrasive cleaning agents or steam jets above 140 °F/60 °C. Follow the manufacturer's instructions.

Aggressive, acidic or alkaline cleaning agents can destroy the protective layer of adjacent components, such as the brake disc.

After cleaning, apply the brakes briefly to dry them. The heat generated during braking dries brake discs and brake pads and protects them against corrosion.

Chrome surfaces

Carefully clean components such as the radiator grille or door handles with plenty of water, possibly with shampoo added, particularly when they have been exposed to road salt.

Rubber components

Environmental influences can cause surface soiling of rubber parts and a loss of gloss. Use only water and suitable cleaning agents for cleaning.

Treat especially worn rubber parts with rubber care agents at regular intervals. When cleaning rubber seals, do not use any silicon-containing vehicle care products in order to avoid damage or noises.

Fine wood parts

Clean fine wood facing and fine wood components only with a moist rag. Then dry with a soft cloth.

Plastic components

NOTICE

Cleansers that contain alcohol or solvents, such as lacquer thinners, heavy-duty grease removers, fuel, or such, can damage plastic parts. There is a risk of damage to property. Clean with a microfiber cloth. Dampen the cloth lightly with water, if needed.

Clean with a microfiber cloth.

Dampen the cloth lightly with water, if needed.

Do not soak the roofliner.

Safety belts

Warning

Chemical cleansers can destroy the safety belt webbing. Missing protective effect of the safety belts. There is a risk of injuries or danger to life. Use only a mild soapy solution for cleaning the safety belts.

Dirty belt straps impede the reeling action and thus have a negative impact on safety.

Use only a mild soapy solution, with the safety belts clipped into their buckles.

Safety belts should only be allowed to retract if they are dry.

Carpets and floor mats

Warning

Objects in the driver's floor area can limit the pedal distance or block a depressed pedal. There is a risk of accident. Stow objects in the vehicle such that they are secured and cannot enter into the driver's floor area. Use floor mats that are suitable for the vehicle and can be safely attached

to the floor. Do not use loose floor mats and do not layer several floor mats. Make sure that there is sufficient clearance for the pedals. Ensure that the floor mats are securely fastened again after they were removed, for instance for cleaning.

Floor mats can be removed from the car's interior for cleaning.

If the floor carpets are very dirty, clean with a microfiber cloth and water or a textile cleaner. To prevent matting of the carpet, rub back and forth in the direction of travel only.

Sensor/camera lenses

To clean sensors and camera lenses, use a cloth moistened with a small amount of glass detergent.

Displays/Screens

NOTICE

Chemical cleansers, moisture or fluids of any kind can damage the surface of displays and screens. There is a risk of damage to property. Clean with a clean, anti-static microfiber cloth.

NOTICE

The surface of displays can be damaged with improper cleaning. There is a risk of damage to property. Avoid pressure that is too high and do not use any scratching materials.

Clean with a clean, antistatic microfiber cloth.

Long-term vehicle storage

When the vehicle is shut down for longer than three months, special measures must

be taken. Further information is available from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

MINI Countryman (2020) - Long-term vehicle storage - 1

natural_image Desk setup with a desk lamp illuminating a wall, books, and a cube on the table (no visible text or symbols)

MINI Countryman (2020) - Long-term vehicle storage - 2

REFERENCE

Technical data 326

Appendix 329

License Texts and Certifications 330

Everything from A to Z 338

Technical data

Vehicle features and options

This chapter describes all standard, country-specific and optional features offered with the series. It also describes features that are not necessarily available in your vehicle, for

instance, due to the selected options or country versions. This also applies to safety-related functions and systems. When using these functions and systems, the applicable laws and regulations must be observed.

General information

The technical data and specifications in the Owner's Manual are used as guidance values. The vehicle-specific data can deviate from this, for instance due to the selected special equipment, country version or country-specific measurement method. Detailed

values can be found in the approval documents, on labels on the vehicle or can be obtained from a dealer's service center or another qualified service center or repair shop.

Dimensions

The dimensions can vary depending on the model version, equipment or country-specific measurement method.

The specified heights do not take into account attached parts, for instance a roof an-

tenna, roof racks or spoiler. The heights can deviate, for instance due to the selected special equipment, tires, load and chassis version.

MINI Countryman

Width with mirrors in/mm 78.9/2,005
Width without mirrors in/mm 71.7/1,822
Height in/mm 61.3/1,557
Length in/mm 169.8/4,314
Wheelbase in/mm 105.1/2,670
Smallest turning radius diam. ft/m 37.4/11.4

Weights

MINI Cooper Countryman

Approved gross vehicle weight
Manual transmission lbs/kg 4,321/1,960
Steptronic transmission lbs/kg 4,376/1,985
Load
Manual transmission lbs/kg 851/386
Steptronic transmission lbs/kg 851/386
Approved front axle load
Manual transmission lbs/kg 2,260/1,025
Steptronic transmission lbs/kg 2,326/1,055
Approved rear axle load
Manual transmission lbs/kg 2,183/990
Steptronic transmission lbs/kg 2,183/990

MINI Cooper S Countryman

Approved gross vehicle weight lbs/kg 4,542/2,060
Load lbs/kg 968/439
Approved front axle load lbs/kg 2,403/1,090
Approved rear axle load lbs/kg 2,260/1,025

MINI Cooper Countryman ALL4

Approved gross vehicle weight lbs/kg 4,564/2,070
Load lbs/kg 862/391
Approved front axle load lbs/kg 2,403/1,090
Approved rear axle load lbs/kg 2,293/1,040

MINI Cooper S Countryman ALL4

Approved gross vehicle weight lbs/kg 4,696/2,130
Load lbs/kg 902/409
Approved front axle load lbs/kg 2,469/1,120
Approved rear axle load lbs/kg 2,337/1,060

MINI John Cooper Works Countryman ALL4

Approved gross vehicle weight lbs/kg 4,696/2,130
Load lbs/kg 871/395
Approved front axle load lbs/kg 2,502/1,135
Approved rear axle load lbs/kg 2,337/1,060

Capacities

MINI Countryman

Fuel tank, approx. US gal/liters 16.1/61.0

Observe further information on fuel quality, refer to page 266.

Appendix

Any updates to the Owner's Manual of the vehicle are listed here.

Updates made after the editorial deadline

The following chapters were updated in the printed version of the Owner's Manual after the editorial deadline for the Integrated Owner's Manual in the vehicle had closed:

- Replacing components: Light and bulb replacement: Front halogen lights, bulb replacement.

License Texts and Certifications

Headunit

Brazil

MINI Countryman (2020) - Headunit - 1

text_image ANATEL

European Union: Declaration of Conformity

MINI Countryman (2020) - Headunit - 2

Hereby, Alpine Electronics, Inc. declares that the radio equipment type BIS01 is in compliance with Directive 2014/53/EU. The full text of the EU declaration of conformity is available at the following internet address: http://www.alpine.com/e/research/

Technical information

Frequency Band: 2.5 GHz

Output Power : 8 dBm

Manufacturer and Address

Manufacturer: Alpine Electronics, Inc.

Address: 20-1, Yoshima Industrial Park, Iwaki, Fukushima 970-1192 Japan

Phone: +81-246-36-4111

Български

Hereby, Alpine Electronics declares that the radio equipment type BIS01 is in compliance with Directive 2014/53/EU. The full text of the EU declaration of conformity is available at the following internet address: http://www.alpine.com/e/research/

Español

text_image Symbolic logo with a lightning bolt inside a circle and a square containing the letter 'R'

Mexico

MINI Countryman (2020) - Mexico - 1

text_image NOM NYSE

Russia, Kazakhstan, Belarus

EAC

South Korea

MINI Countryman (2020) - South Korea - 1

natural_image Abstract geometric logo design with stylized letter K (no text or symbols)

Low Power radio frequency electric machinery was qualified by Type Approval, not get permission from authority; the company, business or user can't arbitrarily change frequency, increase power or modify feature or function of original design.

2.

Use of low power radio frequency electric machinery can't affect flight safety and interfere with legal communication; once discover the interfered phenomenon, it should stop immediately and improve to no interference and then could continue to use.

The preceding legal communication is radio communication which follows Telecommunication Act to operate.

Low power radio frequency electric machinery must tolerate interference from legal communication or electric machinery apparatus of industry, science and medical radiation.

USA, Canada

USA (FCC) and Canada (IC)

Register model name:BIS01

Product code: RB00010A

FCC CAUTION

Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. This transmitter must not be co-located or operated in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter. This device complies with part 15 of FCC Rules and Industry Canada's licence-exempt RSSs. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

This equipment complies with FCC/IC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment and meets the FCC radio frequency (RF) Exposure Guidelines and RSS-102 of the IC radio frequency (RF) Exposure rules. This equipment has very low levels of RF energy that is deemed to comply without maximum permissive exposure evaluation (MPE). (②)

Information regarding Open Source Software Licenses

The “IwIP – A Lightweight TCP/IP stack” included in some products is licensed under the “BSD licence”. A copy of that license in the English original version with a copy-

right notice, a disclaimer of warranty, and an exclusion of liability is included below. Copyright (c) 2001-2004 Swedish Institute of Computer Science. All rights reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

Remote Control

Mexico

COFETEL: RLVBHEID13-0912

Marca: Hella

Modelo (s): IDGNG1

FCC § 15.19 Labelling requirements

This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and with Industry Canada licence-exempt RSS. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

FCC § 15.21 Information to user

Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.

FCC § 15.19 Labelling requirements

This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and with Industry Canada licence-exempt RSS. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

FCC § 15.21 Information to user

Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.

Tire Pressure Monitoring System

Canada

IC: 7812D-TIS07

Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

(1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

USA

FCC ID: KR5TIS-07

This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

(1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

Transmitter/Receiver

Mexico

IFETEL: RLVCOA213-1447

A2C35029700

Continental Automotive GmbH

Siemensstrasse 12

93055 Regensburg

Germany

This device complies with Industry Canada license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

(1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

Everything from A to Z

Index

A

A/C button, see Air conditioning 195

ABS, Antilock Brake System 166

Acceleration Assistant, see Launch Control 123

Accessories and parts 12

ACC, see Camera-based cruise control 171

Activated-charcoal filter 197

Activation times, parked-car ventilation 199

Active Cruise Control, see Camera-based cruise control 171

Active Guard, see Intelligent Safety 157

Adaptive brake lights, see Brake force display 164

Adaptive chassis 168

Additives, engine oil types 294

Adjustments, steering wheel 92

After washing vehicle 320

Airbags 146

Airbags, indicator and warning light 148

Air circulation, see Recirculated-air mode 192, 196

Air conditioner 191

Air conditioning 192, 195

Air distribution, manual 193, 197

Air flow, air conditioner 193

Air flow, automatic climate control 196

Air pressure, tires 268

Air vents, see Ventilation 197

Alarm system 75

Alarm triggering 75

Alarm, unintentional 76

ALL4 168

All-season tires, see Winter tires 277

All-wheel drive, see ALL4 168

AM/FM station 240

Antifreeze, washer fluid 114

Antilock Brake System, ABS 166

Anti-slip control, see DSC 166

Anti-theft protection, lug bolts 285

Approach control warning with city light braking function 158

Approved axle load 327

Ash tray 205

Assistance when driving off 169

Audio 248

Audio playback, Bluetooth 248

Audio playback, pause 236

AUTO intensity 196

Automatic climate control 194

Automatic Curb Monitor 91

Automatic deactivation, front-seat passenger airbags 148

Automatic headlight control 141

Automatic locking 74

Automatic recirculated-air control 196

Automatic Service Request 258

Automatic transmission with Steptronic 116

Automatic unlocking 74

Automatic vehicle wash 319

AUTO program, automatic climate control 195

AUTO program, intensity 196

Auto Start/Stop function 102

Auto washing 319

Average consumption 135

Average speed 135

Axle loads, weights 327

B

Backrest curvature, see Lumbar support 82, 83

Backrest, seats 81

Balance, sound settings 238

Band-aids, see First-aid kit 310

Bass, sound settings 238

Battery, disposing of 308

Battery Guard, Teleservice 259

Battery, vehicle 307

Being towed, see Tow-starting and towing 314

Belts, safety belts 85

Beverage holder, cup holder 209

Blocking, power window 78

Bluetooth audio 248

Bluetooth connection 51

Bonus range, GREEN Mode 230

Bottle holder, see Cup holder 209

Brake assistant 166

Brake discs, break-in 222

Brake force display 164

Brake lights, brake force display 164

Brake pads, break-in 222

Braking, information 224

Breakdown assistance 310

Break-in 222

Brightness of Control Display 48

Bulb replacement 301

Bulb replacement, front 302, 304

Bulb replacement, rear 305

Bulb replacement, side 307

Bulbs and lights 301

Button, SOS 311

Button, Start/Stop 99

Bypassing, see Jump-starting 312

C

California Proposition 65 Warning 12

Camera-based assistance systems, see Intelligent Safety 157

Camera-based cruise control 171

Camera lenses, care 322

Camera, rearview camera 184

Can holder, see Cup holder 209

Care, displays 322

Care, vehicle 320

Care, washing the vehicle 319

Cargo area 211

Cargo area, adapting size 215

Cargo area, enlarging 213

Cargo area lid 69

Cargo area, loading 212

Cargo area, seating surface 216

Cargo area, storage compartments 213

Cargo cover 212

Cargo position, rear seat backrest 213

Cargo, stowing and securing 212

Cargo straps 212

Carpet, care 322

Catalytic converter, see Hot exhaust gas system 223

CBS Condition Based Service 298

Center armrest 209

Center console 40

Central Information Display (CID) 42

Central instrument cluster, LED ring 138

Central locking system, unlocking, from inside 65

Central screen, see Control Display 43

Changes, technical, see For Your Own Safety 11

Changing parts 300

Changing wheels 283

Changing wheels/tires 276

Chassis number, see Vehicle identification number 16

Check Control 125

Checking the oil level electronically 292

Children, seating position 93

Children, transporting safely 93

Child restraint system 93

Child restraint system LATCH 95

Child restraint systems, mounting 94

Child safety locks 98

Child seat, mounting 94

Child seats 93

Chrome parts, care 321

Cigarette lighter 205

Cleaning, displays 322

Climate control 191, 194

Clothes hooks 210

Coasting 231

Coasting with engine decoupled, coasting 231

Coasting with idling engine 231

Combination switch, see Turn signals 106

Combi switch, see Wiper system 107, 111

Comfort Access 66

Compartments in the doors 209

Compass 203

Compatible devices, see Suitable devices 51

Compressor 278

Computer, see Onboard Computer 134

Condensation on windows 197

Condensation under the vehicle 225

Condition Based Service CBS 298

Conference, see Calls with multiple parties 255

Configuring driving program 169

Confirmation signal 75

Connecting device 50

Connecting mobile phone 50

Connecting smartphone 50

Connecting telephone 50

Connections 50

Consumption, see Average consumption 135

Consumption, see Current consumption 131

Contacts 256

Continued driving with a flat tire 153, 156

Control Display 43

Control Display, settings 47

Controller 44

Control systems, driving stability 166

Convenient closing 62

Convenient opening 61

Coolant 296

Cooling, maximum 195

Cooling system 296

Cornering light 142

Corrosion on brake discs 225

Cosmetic mirror 205

Coupling, see Pairing 50

Courtesy lights during unlocking 61

Courtesy lights with the vehicle locked 62

Cruise control 178

Cruise control, active 171

Cruise control with distance control, see Camera-based cruise control 171

Cruise control without distance control, see Cruise control 178

Cruising range 130

Cup holder 209

Current consumption 131

Customer support 260

D

Damage, tires 275

Data memory 13

Data protection, settings 50

Data, technical 326

Date 47

Date display 130

Daytime pedestrian collision mitigation 162

Daytime running lights 142

DCC, see Cruise control 178

Defrosting, see Defrosting the windows 193

Defrosting, see Windows, defrosting 197

Defrosting the windows 193

Deleting personal data 50

Deletion of personal data 50

Device list 50

Digital clock 130

Digital compass 203

Digital radio, see HD Radio reception 241

Dimensions 326

Dimmable exterior mirrors 91

Dimmable interior mirror 92

Direction indicator, see Turn signals 106

Display and input 42

Display, electronic, instrument cluster 125

Display, engine temperature 136

Display, GREEN Mode 228

Display lighting, see Instrument lighting 144

Displays 124

Displays, care 322

Disposal, coolant 297

Disposal, vehicle battery 308

Distance control, see PDC 180

Drive-off assistant 169

Drive-off assistant, see DSC 166

Driver assistance, see Intelligent Safety 157

Driver profiles 73

Driving Dynamics Control, see MINI Driving Modes switch 168

Driving Excitement, SPORT 137

Driving instructions 0

Driving instructions, break-in 222

Driving mode, GREEN 228

Driving modes 168

Driving notes, general 223

Driving on poor roads 225

Driving on racetracks 226

Driving stability control systems 166

Driving tip, GREEN tip 230

Driving tips 223

Drying air, see Air conditioning 192, 195

DSC Dynamic Stability Control 166

DTC Dynamic Traction Control 167

Dynamic damping, see Adaptive chassis 168

Dynamic Stability Control DSC 166

Dynamic Traction Control DTC 167

E

Easy Opener 68

Electronic displays, instrument cluster 125

Electronic oil measurement 292

Electronic Stability Program ESP, see DSC 166

Emergency release, fuel filler flap 265

Emergency Request 311

Emergency service, see Breakdown assistance 310

Emergency unlocking, transmission lock 122

Emergency wheel, compact wheel, see Emergency wheel 287

Energy control 131

Engine, automatic Start/Stop function 102

Engine, automatic switch-off 102

Engine compartment 289

Engine compartment, working in 290

Engine coolant 296

Engine idling when driving, coasting 231

Engine oil 292

Engine oil, adding 293

Engine oil change 295

Engine oil filler neck 293

Engine oil types to add 294

Engine start, jump-starting 312

Engine start, see Starting the engine 100

Engine stop 101

Engine temperature, display 136

Entering a vehicle wash 319

Entertainment, control elements 236

Entertainment source, changing 236

Equipment, interior 200

Error displays, see Check Control 125

ESP Electronic Stability Program, see DSC 166

Exchanging wheels/tires 276

Exhaust gas system 223

Exiting a vehicle wash 319

Exterior mirror, automatic dimming feature 91

Exterior mirrors 90

Exterior mirrors, Automatic Curb Monitor 91

Exterior mirrors, malfunction 91

External start 312

External temperature display 130

External temperature warning 130

Eyes for securing cargo 212

F

Fader, sound settings 238

Failure message, see Check Control 125

False alarm, see Unintentional alarm 76

Fan, see Air flow 193, 196

Fastening safety belts, see Safety belts 85

Filler neck for engine oil 293

Filter, see Microfilter 193

Filter, see Microfilter/activated-charcoal filter 197

Fine wood, care 321

First-aid kit 310

Flat tire, changing wheels 283

Flat Tire Monitor FTM 154

Flat tire, repairing 278

Flat tire, Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 150

Flat tire, warning light 151, 155

Flooding 223

Floor carpet, care 322

Floor mats, care 322

FM/AM station 240

Fogged up windows 193

Fold-away position, windshield wipers 110, 113

Fold back rear seat backrests 213

Foot brake 224

For Your Own Safety 11

Front airbags 146

Front fog lights 143

Front fog lights, LED, bulb replacement 305

Front-seat passenger airbags, automatic deactivation 148

Front-seat passenger airbags, indicator light 149

Front seats 81

FTM Flat Tire Monitor 154

Fuel 266

Fuel cap 264

Fuel filler flap 264

Fuel gauge 129

Fuel quality 266

Fuel recommendation 266

Fuel, tank capacity 328

Fuse 308

G

Garage door opener, see Integrated Universal Remote Control 200

Gasoline 266

Gear shift indicator 132

General driving notes 223

General settings 47

Glare shield 205

Glass sunroof, initialize the system 80

Glass sunroof, see Panoramic glass sunroof 79

Glove compartment 208

Gong, volume equalization 238

GPS geolocation, vehicle position 48

GREEN bonus range 230

GREEN Mode 228

GREEN - program, driving dynamics 168

GREEN tip, driving tip 230

Gross vehicle weight, approved 327

Ground clearance 225

H

Halogen headlights 302

Handbrake, see Parking brake 105

Hand-held transmitter, alternating code 201

Hands-free system 256

Hazard warning flashers 310

HD Radio 241

Head airbag 147

Headlight control, automatic 141

Headlight courtesy delay feature 141

Headlight flasher 107

Headlight glass 302

Headlights, care 320

Head restraints, front 87

Head restraints, rear 88

Heavy cargo, stowing cargo 212

High-beam Assistant 142

High beams 107

High beams/low beams, see High-beam Assistant 142

Hills 224

Hill start assistant, see Drive-off assistant 169

Holder for beverages 209

HomeLink, see Integrated Universal Remote Control 200

Homepage 10

Hood 290

Horn 38

Hot exhaust gas system 223

Hotline, see Customer support 260

Hydroplaning 223

I

Ice warning, see External temperature warning 130

Icy roads, see External temperature warning 130
Identification marks, tires 273
Identification number, see Vehicle identification number 16
Ignition off 99
Ignition on 99
Illuminated ring, central instrument cluster 138
Indication of a flat tire 151, 155
Indicator light, see Check Control 125
Individual air distribution 193, 197
Individual settings, see Driver profiles 73
Inflation pressure, tires 268
Inflation pressure warning, tires 154
Info Display, see Onboard Computer 134
Information 10
Initialize, Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 150
Initializing, Flat Tire Monitor FTM 155
Input and display 42
Instrument cluster 124
Instrument cluster, electronic displays 125
Instrument lighting 144
Integrated key 64
Integrated Universal Remote Control 200
Intelligent Auto Start/Stop function 104
Intelligent emergency call 311
Intelligent Safety 157
Intended use 11
Intensity, AUTO program 196
Interior equipment 200
Interior lights 144
Interior lights during unlocking 61
Interior lights with the vehicle locked 62
Interior mirror 90
Interior mirror, automatic dimming feature 92
Interior mirror, compass 203
Interior mirror, manually dimmable 91
Interior motion sensor 76
Internet site 10
Interval display, service requirements 131
Interval mode 108, 112
In the vicinity of the center console 40
In the vicinity of the roofliner 41
In the vicinity of the steering wheel 38

iPod/iPhone 248

J

Jacking points for the vehicle jack 285

Jam protection system, glass sunroof 80

Jam protection system, windows 77

Jump-starting 312

K

Keyless Go, see Comfort Access 66

Key, see Integrated key 64

Key, see Vehicle key 60

Kickdown, Steptronic transmission 119

Knee airbag 147

L

Label on recommended tires 276

Label, runflat tires 277

Language, on the Control Display 47

Lashing eyes 212

LATCH child restraint fixing system 95

Launch Control 123

Leather, care 321

LED ring, central instrument cluster 138

LEDs, light-emitting diodes 301

Letters and numbers, entering 46

Light 140

Light-alloy wheels, care 321

Light-emitting diodes, LEDs 301

Lighter 205

Lighting 140

Light replacement 301

Light replacement, front 302, 304

Light replacement, rear 305

Light replacement, side 307

Lights and bulbs 301

Light switch 140

List of all messages 49

Load 212

Loading 211

Loading position 213

Location, vehicle position 48

Locking, automatic 74

Locking, from inside 65

Locking, see Opening and Closing 60

Locking, settings 74

Low beams 140

Low beams, automatic, see High-beam Assistant 142

Lower back support 83

Lower back support, mechanical 82

Lug bolt lock 285

Luggage rack, see Roof-mounted luggage rack 225

Lumbar support 83

Lumbar support, mechanical 82

M

Maintenance 298

Maintenance requirements 298

Maintenance, service requirements 131

Maintenance system, MINI 298

Make-up mirror 205

Malfunction displays, see Check Control 125

Manual air distribution 193, 197

Manual air flow 193, 196

Manual brake, see Parking brake 105

Manual mode, transmission 120

Manual operation, fuel filler flap 265

Manual operation, PDC Park Distance Control 181

Manual operation, rearview camera 184

Manual transmission 115

Manufacturer of the MINI 11

Matte finish 320

Maximum cooling 195

Maximum speed, display 132

Maximum speed, winter tires 277

Measurement, units of 48

Mechanical key 64

Media of the Owner's Manual 56

Medical kit 310

Memory function 89

Menu in instrument cluster 134

Menus, Central Information Display (CID) 45

Messages 49

Messages, see Check Control 125

Microfilter 193, 197

MID - program, driving dynamics 168

MINI driving modes 168

MINI logo projection during unlocking 61

MINI maintenance system 298

Minimum tread, tires 275

MINI Picnic Bench 216

MINI Teleservices 258

Mirrors 90

Mirror, see Memory function 89

Mobile communication devices in the vehicle 223

Mobile phone 254

Mobile phone, operation 254

Mobility System 278

Modifications, technical, see For Your Own Safety 11

Moisture in headlight 302

Monitor, see Control Display 43

Mounting of child restraint systems 94

MP3 player, see Audio 248

Multifunction steering wheel, buttons 38

N

Neck restraints, front, see Head restraints 87

Neck restraints, rear, see Head restraints 88

Neutral cleaner, see Wheel cleaner 321

New wheels and tires 276

No-touch closing of the tailgate 68

No-touch opening of the tailgate 68

0

OBD Onboard Diagnostics 299

Obstacle marking, rearview camera 185

Octane rating, see Recommended fuel grade 267

Odometer 129

Oil 292

Oil, adding 293

Oil change 295

Oil change interval, service requirements 131

Oil filler neck 293

Oil types to add, engine 294

Onboard Computer 134

Onboard Diagnostics OBD 299

Onboard literature, printed 56

Onboard vehicle tool kit 300

On-call service, see Breakdown assistance 310

Opening and Closing 60

Opening, from inside 65

Operating concept Central Information Display (CID) operating concept 42

Operating menus, Central Information Display (CID) 42

Operation via the Controller 45

Optional equipment 11

Outside air, see Automatic recirculated-air control 196

Owner's Manual, printed 56

P

Paint, vehicle 320

Panic alarm, see Panic mode 76

Panic mode 76

Panoramic glass sunroof 79

Parallel parking assistant 186

Park Distance Control PDC 180

Parked-car ventilation 198

Parked vehicle, condensation 225

Parking aid, see PDC 180

Parking assistant 186

Parking brake 105

Parking lights 140

Parts and accessories 12

Passenger's side mirror, tilting 91

Pathway lines, rearview camera 185

Pause, audio playback 236

PDC Park Distance Control 180

Performance Control 168

Personal profile, see Driver profiles 73

Phone conference, see Calls with multiple parties 255

Picnic Bench 216

Plastic, care 322

Poor roads, driving on 225

PostCrash — iBrake 165

Power failure 308

Power windows 77

Pressure, tires 268

Pressure warning, tires 154

Printed onboard literature 56

Profiles, see Driver profiles 73

Programmable memory buttons, Central Information Display (CID) 46

Protective function, glass sunroof 80

Protective function, windows 77

Push-and-turn reel, see Controller 44

R

Racetrack operation 226

Radiator fluid 296

Radio 240

Radio, adjusting the volume 236

Radio, control elements 236

Radio Data System RDS 240

Radio, muting 236

Radio-ready state 100

Radio, see Changing the entertainment source 236

Radio, tone settings 238

Rain sensor 108, 112

Ratchet straps 212

RDS Radio Data System 240

Rear lights 305

Rear seats 84

Rearview camera 183

Rear window defroster 193, 197

Rear window wiper, operation 109, 113

Recirculated-air filter 197

Recirculated-air mode 192, 196

Recommended fuel grade 267

Recommended tire brands 276

Refueling 264

Remaining range 130

Remote control, universal 200

Renaming a station 241

Replacing parts 300

Replacing the battery, vehicle key 63

Replacing wheels/tires 276

Reporting safety malfunctions 17

RES CNCL button, see Camera-based cruise control 171

RES CNCL button, see Cruise control 178

Reserve warning, see Range 130

Reset, Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 150

Retreaded tires 277

Roadside Assistance, see Breakdown assistance 310

Roadside parking lights 141

Rolling code hand-held transmitter 201

RON recommended fuel grade 267

Roofliner 41

Roof-mounted luggage rack 225

RSC Runflat System Component, see Runflat tires 277

Rubber components, care 321

Runflat tires 277

S

Safe braking 224

Safety belt reminder for driver's seat and front passenger seat 87

Safety belts 85

Safety belts, care 322

Safety locks, doors, and windows 98

Safety switch, windows 78

Safety systems, airbags 146

Satellite radio 242

Saving fuel 227

Screen, see Control Display 43

Screwdriver 300

Sealant, see Mobility System 278

Seat heating, front 84

Seating position for children 93

Seat, see Memory function 89

Seats, front 81

Seats, rear 84

Securing cargo 212

Selection list in instrument cluster 134

Sensors, care 322

Service and warranty 13

Service Request 258

Service requirements, Condition Based Service CBS 298

Service requirements, display 131

Servotronic 170

SET button, see Camera-based cruise control 171

SET button, see Cruise control 178

Settings, locking/unlocking 74

Settings, mirrors 90

Settings on the Control Display 47

Shift gate rotary switch 168

Shift paddles on the steering wheel 121

Side airbag 146

Signaling, horn 38

Signals when unlocking 75

Sitting safely 81

Size 326

Slide/tilt glass roof 79

Smartphone, operation 254

SMS text messages, supplementary 129

Snow chains 282

Socket 205

Socket, OBD Onboard Diagnostics 299

SOS button 311

Sound output 236

Spare tire, see Emergency wheel 287

Speed, average 135

Speed Limit Info 132

Speed Limit Info, Onboard Computer 136

Speed limits, display 132

Speed Volume, volume equalization 238

Speed warning 137

Sport displays 137

SPORT program, driving dynamics 169

Sport program, transmission 120

Stability control systems 166

Standard equipment 11

Start/stop, automatic function 102

Start/Stop button 99

Starting the engine 100

Station, AM/FM 240

Stations, stored 247

Station, storing 240

Status information, Central Information Display (CID) 43

Status of Owner's Manual 11

Status, vehicle 139

Steering assistance 170

Steering wheel, adjusting 92

Steptronic Sport transmission, see Steptronic transmission 116

Steptronic Sport transmission with double clutch, see Steptronic transmission 116

Steptronic transmission 116

Steptronic transmission with double clutch, see Steptronic transmission 116

Stopping the engine 101

Storage compartments 208

Storage, tires 277

Storing the vehicle 322

Stowing and securing cargo 212

Suitable devices 51

Suitable mobile phones 51

Summer tires, tread 275

Sun visor 205

Supplementary Owner's Manuals 56

Supplementary SMS text messages 129

Switch for driving dynamics 168

Switching calls, see Calls with multiple parties 255

Switch, see Cockpit 38

Symbols 10

T

Tachometer 129

Tailgate 69

Tailgate, closing with no-touch activation 68

Tailgate, opening with no-touch activation 68

Tailgate via remote control 62

Tail lights 305

Technical changes, see For Your Own Safety 11

Technical data 326

Telephone 254

Telephone conference, see Calls with multiple parties 255

Telephone, operation 254

Teleservice Battery Guard 259

Teleservice Report 259

Teleservices 258

Temperature, air conditioner 192

Temperature, automatic climate control 194

Temperature display for external temperature 130

Temperature, engine 136

Terminal, starting aid 313

Theft alarm system, see Alarm system 75

Thigh support 84

Tilt alarm sensor 76

Tilting, passenger's side mirror 91

Time 47

Tire damage 275

Tire identification marks 273

Tire inflation pressure 268

Tire inflation pressure monitor, see FTM 154

Tire pressure 268

Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 150

Tire repair kit, see Mobility System 278

Tires, changing 276

Tire sealant, see Mobility System 278

Tires, everything on wheels and tires 268

Tires, runflat 277

Tire tread 275

Tone 238

Tools 300

Total vehicle weight 327

Towing 314

Tow-starting 314

TPM Tire Pressure Monitor 150

Traction control 167

TRACTION driving mode, driving dynamics 167

Transmission lock, electronic unlocking 122

Transmission lock, releasing manually 122

Transmission, manual transmission 115

Transmission, see Steptronic transmission 116

Transporting children safely 93

Tread, tires 275

Treble, sound settings 238

Trip computer 136

Triple turn signal activation 107

Trip odometer 129

Trip recorder, see Trip odometer 129

Turning radius lines, rearview camera 185

Turn signal, front 302, 304

Turn signal, indicator light 128

Turn signal, side 307

Turn signals, operation 106

Turn signals, rear, bulb replacement 305

U

Unintentional alarm 76

Units of measurement 48

Universal remote control 200

Unlocking, automatic 74

Unlocking, see Opening and Closing 60

Unlocking, settings 74

Updates made after the editorial deadline 11

Upholstery care 321

USB audio interface 248

USB connection 53

USB interface, position in vehicle 206

USB port, see USB interface 206

Used battery, disposing of 308

Use, intended 11

V

Vanity mirror 205

Vehicle battery 307

Vehicle, break-in 222

Vehicle care 320

Vehicle care products 320

Vehicle features and options 11

Vehicle identification number 16

Vehicle jack 285

Vehicle key, additional 63

Vehicle key, loss 63

Vehicle key, malfunction 63

Vehicle key, opening/closing 60

Vehicle key, replacing the battery 63

Vehicle key, see Vehicle key 60

Vehicle paint 320

Vehicle position, vehicle location 48

Vehicle status 139

Vehicle storage 322

Vehicle wash 319

Vehicle wash, automatic 319

Vehicle, washing 319

Ventilation 197

Ventilation, see Parked-car ventilation 198

VIN, see Vehicle identification number 16

Voice command response 257

Volume equalization 238

W

Warning and indicator lights, see Check Control 125

Warning displays, see Check Control 125

Warning messages, see Check Control 125

Warning triangle 310

Warranty 11

Washer fluid 114

Washer nozzles, windshield 109, 113

Washing the vehicle 319

Water on roads 223

Weights 327

Welcome lights 141

Welcome lights during unlocking 61

Wheel cleaner 321

Wheels, changing 276

Wheels, everything on wheels and tires 268

Wheels, Flat Tire Monitor FTM 154

Wheels, Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 150

Windows, powered 77

Windshield cleaning system 107, 111

Windshield defroster 193, 197

Windshield washer fluid 114

Windshield washer nozzles 109, 113

Windshield wipers, fold-away position 110, 113

Windshield wipers, see Wiper system 107, 111

Winter storage, care 322

Winter tires, suitable tires 277

Winter tires, tread 275

Wiper blades, replacing 300

Wiper fluid 114

Wiper system 107, 111

Wood, care 321

Word match concept, navigation 42

Wrench 300

Y

Your dealer's service center 259

California Proposition 65 Warning

For vehicles sold in California:

California Proposition 65 Warning

MINI Countryman (2020) - California Proposition 65 Warning - 1

WARNING

Operating, servicing and maintaining a passenger vehicle or off-high-way motor vehicle can expose you to chemicals including engine exhaust, carbon monoxide, phthalates, and lead, which are known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. To minimize exposure, avoid breathing exhaust, do not idle the engine except as necessary, service your vehicle in a well-ventilated area and wear gloves or wash your hands frequently when servicing your vehicle. For more information go to www.P65Warnings.ca.gov/passenger-vehicle.

MINI MOTORER'S GUIDE APP.

Your customized information about the vehicle in an app. Optimized for smartphones & tablets. Can be used offline.

MINI Countryman (2020) - MINI MOTORER'S GUIDE APP. - 1

Download on the App Store

MINI Countryman (2020) - MINI MOTORER'S GUIDE APP. - 2

GET IT ON Google Play

MINI Countryman (2020) - MINI MOTORER'S GUIDE APP. - 3

natural_image Street-level view of a paved sidewalk with concrete pavement and greenery in the background (no visible text or symbols)

01402667330 ue

MINI Countryman (2020) - MINI MOTORER'S GUIDE APP. - 4

Table of contents Click a title to access it
Manual assistant
Powered by Anthropic
Waiting for your message
Product information

Brand : MINI

Model : Countryman (2020)

Category : Automotive